Академический Документы
Профессиональный Документы
Культура Документы
HOW IT WORKS
The conveyor is made up of drive, intermediate and tail sections on which two strands of #60 single-pitch chain travel. Each strand is a continuous loop and driven by a common drive shaft.
SIZE TO ORDER FRAME WIDTH 19 7/8” 22 7/8” 25 7/8” 28 7/8” 31 7/8” 34 7/8” 37 7/8” 40 7/8” 43 7/8” 46 7/8” 49 7/8”
OVERALL STRAND
18” 21” 24” 27” 30” 33” 36” 39” 42” 45” 48”
LENGTH “A” CENTERS
7’ 433 450 466 483 499 517 534 551 567 581 600
Per Foot 37 39 41 43 45 47 49 51 53 55 57
Weight
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
INTERMEDIATE 6O”
12”
SECTION DRIVE SECTION
18” MIN.
“X” “X”
FILL PLATE
#60 SINGLE
PITCH CHAIN
12”
MIN.
SECTION X-X
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS DC-62
CHAIN – #60 single pitch conveyor chain (straight sidebar). BEARINGS – Sealed, pre-lubricated, self aligning, ball bearings on drive.
FRAME – 6 in. x 7 ga. powder painted formed steel angle with 1 1/2 in. x 3/16 wall, chain support CAPACITY–6000 lbs. maximum at 35 FPM (1 1/2 HP maximum). NOT TO EXCEED CAPACITY IN
tube. 4 ga. formed coupling channels located at infeed and discharge ends of each module. CHART.
MOTOR –1 1/2 HP – 208/230/460/575V– 3 PH. 60 HZ. gearmotor, located underneath in 5 ft. long FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
module.
DRIVE SPROCKETS – Hardened #60 with 1 3/8 in. dia. steel shaft.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–DCS and DCDS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. CLOSED TAIL–Overall length will be affected.
Specify top of chain elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes
in feet for lagging to floor. CONVEYING SPEED–Speeds other than 35 FPM will require gear box change (contact factory).
CATALOG | 08312018
DC-63
The Model DC-63 is a three strand drag chain conveyor
Drag Chain Conveyor
• 11 Widths
designed to handle pallets. • Modular Assembly
• Adjustable DC3S and DCDS-Type Floor Supports vailable
HOW IT WORKS
The conveyor is made up of drive, intermediate and tail sections on which three strands of #60 single-pitch chain travel. Each strand is a continuous loop and driven by a common drive shaft.
SIZE TO ORDER FRAME WIDTH 37 7/8” 43 7/8” 49 7/8” 55 7/8” 61 7/8” 67 7/8” 73 7/8” 79 7/8” 85 7/8” 91 7/8” 99 7/8”
OVERALL STRAND
18” 21” 24” 27” 30” 33” 36” 39” 42” 45” 48”
LENGTH “A” CENTERS
7’ 650 675 699 724 748 775 801 826 850 871 900
Per Foot
Weight 55 58 61 64 67 70 73 76 79 82 85
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
INTERMEDIATE 6O”
12”
SECTION DRIVE SECTION
18" MIN.
18" MIN.
18" MIN.
18" MIN.
“X” “X”
FILL PLATE
#60 SINGLE
PITCH CHAIN
12”
MIN.
SECTION X-X
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS DC-63
CHAIN – #60 single pitch conveyor chain (straight sidebar). BEARINGS – Sealed, pre-lubricated, self aligning, ball bearings on drive.
FRAME – 6 in. x 7 ga. powder painted formed steel angle with 1 1/2 in. x 3/16 wall, chain support CAPACITY–5800 lbs. maximum at 30 FPM (1 1/2 HP maximum). NOT TO EXCEED CAPACITY IN
tube. 4 ga. formed coupling channels located at infeed and discharge ends of each module. CHART.
MOTOR –1 1/2 HP – 208/230/460/575V– 3 PH. 60 HZ. gearmotor, located underneath in 5 ft. long FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
module.
DRIVE SPROCKETS – Hardened #60 with 1 3/8 in. dia. steel shaft.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–DC3S and DCDS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of CLOSED TAIL–Overall length will be affected.
adjustment. Specify top of chain elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of
conveyor. Holes in feet for lagging to floor. CONVEYING SPEED–Speeds other than 30 FPM will require gear box change (contact factory).
CATALOG | 08312018
DC-82
The Model DC-82 is a two strand drag chain conveyor
Drag Chain Conveyor
• 10 Widths
designed to handle pallets. • Modular Assembly
• Adjustable DCS and DCDS-Type Floor Supports Available
HOW IT WORKS
The conveyor is made up of drive, intermediate and tail sections on which two strands of #80 single-pitch chain travel. Each strand is a continuous loop and driven by a common drive shaft.
FRAME WIDTH 26 1/2” 29 1/2” 32 1/2” 35 1/2” 38 1/2” 41 1/2” 44 1/2” 47 1/2” 50 1/2” 53 1/2”
SIZE TO ORDER
OVERALL STRAND
24” 27” 30” 33” 36” 39” 42” 45” 48” 51”
LENGTH “A” CENTERS
7’ 583 604 625 646 667 688 709 730 751 772
Per Foot
Weight 52 55 58 61 64 67 70 73 76 79
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
INTERMEDIATE 6O”
12”
SECTION DRIVE SECTION
24” MIN.
“X” “X”
FILL PLATE
#80 SINGLE
PITCH CHAIN
14”
MIN.
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS DC-82
CHAIN – #80 single pitch conveyor chain (straight sidebar).
BEARINGS – Sealed, pre-lubricated, self aligning, ball bearings on drive.
CHAIN GUIDE – UHMW polyethylene.
CONVEYING SPEED –30 FPM.
FRAME – 6 in. x 4 ga. powder painted formed steel angle with 2 in. x 1/4 in. thick wall, chain
support tube. 4 ga. formed coupling channels located at infeed and discharge ends of each CAPACITY–5800 lbs. maximum at 30 FPM (2 HP maximum). NOT TO EXCEED CAPACITY IN CHART.
module.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
MOTOR –2 HP – 208/230/460/575V– 3 PH. 60 HZ. gearmotor, located underneath in 5 ft. long
module.
DRIVE SPROCKETS – Hardened #80 with 1 1/2 in. dia. steel shaft.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–DCS and DCDS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. CLOSED TAIL–Overall length will be affected.
Specify top of chain elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes
in feet for lagging to floor. CONVEYING SPEED–Speeds other than 30 FPM will require gear box change (contact factory).
MOTORS–3 HP maximum.
CATALOG | 08312018
DC-83
The Model DC-83 is a three strand drag chain conveyor
Drag Chain Conveyor
• 10 Widths
designed to handle pallets. • Modular Assembly
• Adjustable DC3S and DCDS-Type Floor Supports vailable
HOW IT WORKS
The conveyor is made up of drive, intermediate and tail sections on which three strands of #80 single-pitch chain travel. Each strand is a continuous loop and driven by a common drive shaft.
SIZE TO ORDER FRAME WIDTH 50 1/2” 56 1/2” 62 1/2” 68 1/2” 74 1/2” 80 1/2” 86 1/2” 92 1/2” 98 1/2” 104 1/2”
OVERALL STRAND
LENGTH “A” 24” 27” 30” 33” 36” 39” 42” 45” 48” 51”
CENTERS
7’ 874 905 936 967 998 1029 1060 1091 1122 1153
Per Foot
Weight 77 80 83 86 89 92 95 98 101 104
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
INTERMEDIATE 6O”
12”
SECTION DRIVE SECTION
24”
18"MIN.
MIN.
24”
18"MIN.
18" MIN.
MIN.
#80 SINGLE
PITCH CHAIN
12”
14”MIN.
MIN.
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS DC-83
CHAIN –#80 single pitch conveyor chain (straight sidebar). BEARINGS – Sealed, pre-lubricated, self aligning, ball bearings on drive.
FRAME – 6 in. x 4 ga. powder painted formed steel angle with 2 in. x 1/4 in. thick wall, chain CAPACITY–6000 lbs. maximum at 30 FPM (2 HP maximum). NOT TO EXCEED CAPACITY IN CHART.
support tube. 4 ga. formed coupling channels located at infeed and discharge ends of each
module. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
DRIVE SPROCKETS – Hardened #80 with 1 1/2 in. dia. steel shaft.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–DC3S and DCDS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of CLOSED TAIL–Overall length will be affected.
adjustment. Specify top of chain elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of
conveyor. Holes in feet for lagging to floor. CONVEYING SPEED–Speeds other than 30 FPM will require gear box change (contact factory).
CATALOG | 08312018
DCEZ-62
The Model DCEZ-62 is a two strand drag chain conveyor
Drag Chain Conveyor
• 2 Strand Design
designed to handle pallets. With EZLogic® Zone Controller, • EZLogic® Accumulation System (Diffuse)
pallets are accumulated with zero pressure, reducing the • 11 Widths
possibility of collision that may result in product damage. • Modular Assembly
• Adjustable DCS and DCDS-Type Floor Supports Available
FRAME WIDTH 19 7/8” 22 7/8” 25 7/8” 28 7/8” 31 7/8” 34 7/8” 37 7/8” 40 7/8” 43 7/8” 46 7/8” 49 7/8”
OVERALL
LENGTH “A” STRAND
18” 21” 24” 27” 30” 33” 36” 39” 42” 45” 48”
CENTERS
U.S. Patent Numbers
12’ 615 641 667 694 720 748 774 801 827 851 880 7,243,781 • 7,591,366
17’ 797 832 868 905 941 979 1014 1051 1087 1121 1160 7,905,345
Other Patents Pending.
22’ 979 1023 1069 1116 1162 1210 1254 1301 1347 1391 1440
27’ 1161 1214 1270 1327 1383 1441 1494 1551 1607 1661 1720
32’ WEIGHTS 1343 1405 1471 1538 1604 1672 1734 1801 1867 1931 2000
37’ (Lbs.) 1525 1596 1672 1749 1825 1903 1974 2051 2127 2201 2280
42’ weights based 1707 1787 1873 1960 2046 2134 2214 2301 2387 2471 2560
47’ on 60” Inter. 1889 1978 2074 2171 2267 2365 2454 2551 2647 2741 2840
52’ Frame Lengths 2071 2169 2275 2382 2488 2596 2694 2801 2907 3011 3120
62’ 2435 2551 2677 2804 2930 3058 3174 3301 3427 3551 3680
HOW IT WORKS
72’ 2799 2933 3079 3226 3372 3520 3654 3801 3947 4091 4240
82’ 3163 3315 3481 3648 3814 3982 4134 4301 4467 4631 4800
92’ 3527 3697 3883 4070 4256 4444 4614 4801 4987 5171 5360 The conveyor is made up of drive, intermediate and tail sections
102’ 3891 4079 4285 4492 4698 4906 5099 5301 5507 5711 5920 on which two strands of #60 single pitch chain travel. Each
strand is a continuous loop and driven by a common drive shaft.
60" 12" Hytrol’s EZLogic® Zone Controllers sense product presence and
DRIVE ZONE control the accumulation and release of product from the zones.
To accumulate products accumulation lift pads are activated
which lift the product off of chain strands.
EZLOGIC®
DIFFUSE 18" MIN.
ZONE FILTER REGULATOR
CONTROLLER
“X” EZLOGIC®
EZLOGIC®
IOP ACCUMULATION DIFFUSE
ZONE DIFFUSE
LIFT PAD ZONE FILTER REGULATOR
CONTROLLER
CONTROLLER
“X” FILL PLATE “X”
IOP
1"
IOP #60 SINGLE
PITCH CHAIN
~
12" MIN. 1"
IOP #60 SINGLE
OPTIONAL SUPPORT W/ADJ. FILTER REGULATOR PITCH CHAIN
FOOT PAD SHOWN ~
CENTER DRIVE SECTION 12" MIN.
OPTIONAL DCDS SUPPORT SHOWN
VIEW X-X OPTIONAL SUPPORT W/ADJ. FILTER REGULATOR
FOOT PAD SHOWN
CENTER DRIVE SECTION
OPTIONAL DCDS SUPPORT SHOWN
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS DCEZ-62
CHAIN –#60 single pitch conveyor chain (straight sidebar).
AIR REQUIREMENTS– Recommended working pressure 60 P.S.I. Free air consumption at 75 P.S.I.
CHAIN GUIDE – UHMW polyethylene. - .50 cu. ft. per actuation for 18” & 21” strand centers - 1.0 cu. ft. per actuation for 24 - 28 strand
centers.
FRAME – 6 in. x 7 ga. powder painted formed steel angle with 1 1/2 in. x 3/16 wall, chain support
tube. 4 ga. formed coupling channels located at infeed and discharge ends of each module. FILTER, REGULATOR–Supplied for main air supply line (1/2 in. NPT port). Includes pressure
sensor.
DRIVE SPROCKETS – Hardened #60 with 1 3/8 in. dia. steel shaft.
MOTOR –1 1/2 HP – 230/460V– 3 PH. 60 HZ. gearmotor, located underneath in 5 ft. long module.
BEARINGS – Sealed, pre-lubricated, self aligning, ball bearings on drive.
CONVEYING SPEED –35 FPM.
EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone (Diffuse). NEMA 1, 2, IP62. UL Approved.
CAPACITY–12,000 lbs. maximum at 30 FPM (1 1/2 HP maximum). NOT TO EXCEED CAPACITY IN
ACCUMULATION ZONES–36 in., 42 in., 48 in., 54 in., 60 in., and 66 in. long intermediate sections CHART.
with EZLogic® Accumulation (Diffuse). Contact factory for other lengths. (Drive Section minimum
60 in. long.) FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
input/output boards. Requires 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry contact
switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always used at the discharge
end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the length of the
product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from a removed load,
preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are routinely removed from the conveyor
with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and stops the zone from
driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering loading area.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–DCDS and DCS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. CONVEYING SPEED–Speeds other than 30 FPM will require gearmotor change (contact factory).
Specify top of chain elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes
. in feet for lagging to floor. ELECTRICAL MOTOR CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starter – push-button stations.
CLOSED TAIL–Overall length will be affected. EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 08312018
DCEZ-63
The Model DCEZ-63 is a three strand drag chain conveyor
Drag Chain Conveyor
• 3 Strand Design
designed to handle pallets. With EZLogic® Zone Controller, • EZLogic® Accumulation System (Diffuse)
pallets are accumulated with zero back pressure reducing the • 11 Widths
possibility of collision that may result in product damage. • Modular Assembly
• Adjustable DC3S and DCDS-Type Floor Supports Available
12’ 925 965 1004 1044 1083 1125 1166 1206 1245 1281 1325
WEIGHTS
Per Foot
55 58 61 64 67 70 73 76 79 82 85
Weight
HOW IT WORKS
The conveyor is made up of drive, intermediate and tail sections
on which three strands of #60 single-pitch chain travel. Each
strand is a continuous loop and driven by a common drive shaft.
Hytrol’s EZLogic® Zone Controller sense product presence and
control the accumulation and release of product from the zones.
To accumulate products accumulation lift pads are activated
which lift the product off of chain strands.
60" 12"
DRIVE ZONE IMPORTANT NOTE:
Do not operate DCEZ in sleep or slug mode.
12" ZONE24"LENGTH
MIN. 60" 12"
INTERMEDIATE DRIVE ZONE
24" MIN.
24" MIN.
24" MIN.
FILTER REGULATOR
“X”
IOP
ACCUMULATION
LIFT PAD FILTER REGULATOR
FILL PLATE
“X” “X”
IOP
1"
IOP #60 SINGLE
PITCH CHAIN
12" MIN.
1"
IOP #80 SINGLE
OPTIONAL SUPPORT W/ADJ. FILTER REGULATOR PITCH CHAIN
FOOT PAD SHOWN
CENTER DRIVE SECTION ~
OPTIONAL DCDS SUPPORT SHOWN 14" MIN.
VIEW X-X
OPTIONAL SUPPORT W/ADJ. FILTER REGULATOR
FOOT PAD SHOWN CATALOG | 08312018
CENTER DRIVE SECTION
OPTIONAL DCDS SUPPORT SHOWN
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS DCEZ-63
CHAIN –#60 single pitch conveyor chain (straight sidebar). AIR REQUIREMENTS– Recommended working pressure 60 P.S.I. Free air consumption at 75 P.S.I.
- .50 cu. ft. per actuation for 18” & 21” strand centers - 1.0 cu. ft. per actuation for 24 - 28 strand
CHAIN GUIDE – UHMW polyethylene. centers.
FRAME – 6 in. x 7 ga. powder painted formed steel angle with 1 1/2 in. x 3/16 wall, chain support FILTER, REGULATOR–Supplied for main air supply line (1/2 in. NPT port). Includes pressure
tube. 4 ga. formed coupling channels located at infeed and discharge ends of each module. sensor.
DRIVE SPROCKETS – Hardened #60 with 1 3/8 in. dia. steel shaft. MOTOR –1 1/2 HP – 208/230/460/575V– 3 PH. 60 HZ. gearmotor, located underneath in 5 ft. long
module.
BEARINGS – Sealed, pre-lubricated, self aligning, ball bearings on drive.
CONVEYING SPEED –35 FPM.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–36 in., 42 in., 48 in., 54 in., 60 in., and 66 in. long intermediate sections
with EZLogic® Accumulation (Diffuse). Contact factory for other lengths. (Drive Section minimum CAPACITY–11,000 lbs. maximum at 30 FPM (1 1/2 HP maximum). NOT TO EXCEED CAPACITY IN
60 in. long.) CHART.
EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone (Diffuse). NEMA 1, 2, IP62. UL Approved. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
input/output boards. Requires 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
LOAD CAPACITY CHART (Accumulated or Live)* @ 30 FPM
TOTAL LOAD (Lbs.)
HP UP TO 50’ UP TO 102’
*Load capacities in accumulation mode are calculated assuming no more than half
of the load will be moving at any time.
Hytrol’s EZLogic®, or “Electronic Zero-pressure Logic” Accumulation System, combines the sensing accuracy of photo-
electronics with discrete electronic logic control without the use of a PLC or pneumatic logic components. The EZLogic®
Accumulation System provides many features including:
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry contact
switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always used at the discharge end
of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the length of the
product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from a removed load,
preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are routinely removed from the conveyor
with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and stops the zone from
driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering loading area.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–DCDS and DC3S Type floor supports are available with a wide range of CONVEYING SPEED–Speeds other than 30 FPM will require geamotor change (contact factory).
adjustment. Specify top of chain elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of
conveyor. Holes in feet for lagging to floor. ELECTRICAL MOTORS CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starter – push-button stations.
CLOSED TAIL–Overall length will be affected. EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 08312018
DCEZ-82
The Model DCEZ-82 is a two strand drag chain conveyor
Drag Chain Conveyor
• 2 Strand Design
designed to handle pallets. With EZLogic® Zone Controller, • EZLogic® Accumulation System (Diffuse)
pallets are accumulated with zero pressure, reducing the • 10 Widths
possibility of collision that may result in product damage. • Modular Assembly
• Adjustable DCS and DCDS-Type Floor Supports Available
FRAME WIDTH 26 1/2” 29 1/2” 32 1/2” 35 1/2” 38 1/2” 41 1/2” 44 1/2” 47 1/2” 50 1/2” 53 1/2”
OVERALL
LENGTH “A” STRAND
24” 27” 30” 33” 36” 39” 42” 45” 48” 51”
CENTERS U.S. Patent Numbers
7,243,781 • 7,591,366
12’ WEIGHTS 834 868 902 936 970 1004 1038 1072 1106 1144 7,905,345
(Lbs.) based Other Patents Pending.
PER FOOT on 60” Frame
Lengths 52 55 58 61 64 67 70 73 76 79
WEIGHT
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
HOW IT WORKS
60" The conveyor is made up of drive, intermediate and tail sections
12" on which two strands of #80 single-pitch chain travel. Each
VE ZONE strand is a continuous loop and driven by a common drive shaft.
Hytrol’s EZLogic® Zone Controllers sense product presence and
control the accumulation and release of product from the zones.
To accumulate products accumulation lift pads are activated
which lift the product off of chain strands.
18" MIN.
12" ZONE LENGTH 60" 12"
INTERMEDIATE DRIVE ZONE IMPORTANT NOTE:
Do not operate DCEZ in sleep or slug mode.
LOGIC®
IFFUSE
ZONE FILTER REGULATOR
ROLLER
24”
18" MIN.
“X”
EZLOGIC®
DIFFUSE EZLOGIC®
ACCUMULATION DIFFUSE
LIFT PAD ZONE
CONTROLLER ZONE FILTER REGULATOR
CONTROLLER
“X” FILL PLATE “X”
IOP
C-2080-H DOUBLE
1"
IOP #80 SINGLE
PITCH CHAIN
PITCH CHAIN
~
12"
14” MIN.
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS DCEZ-82
CHAIN – #80 single pitch conveyor chain (straight sidebar). AIR REQUIREMENTS– Recommended working pressure 60 P.S.I. Free air consumption at 75 P.S.I.
- 1.0 cu. ft. per actuation for 24 in. & 27 in. strand centers - 1.5 cu. ft. per actuation for 30 in. - 51
CHAIN GUIDE – UHMW polyethylene. in. strand centers.
FRAME – 6 in. x 4 ga. powder painted formed steel angle with 2 in. x 1/4 in. wall, chain support FILTER, REGULATOR–Supplied for main air supply line (1/2 in. NPT port). Includes pressure
tube. 4 ga. formed coupling channels located at infeed and discharge ends of each module. sensor.
DRIVE SPROCKETS – Hardened #80 with 1 1/2 in. dia. steel shaft. MOTOR –2 HP – 208/230/460/575V– 3 PH. 60 HZ. gearmotor, located underneath in 5 ft. long
module.
BEARINGS – Sealed, pre-lubricated, self aligning, ball bearings on drive.
CONVEYING SPEED –30 FPM.
EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone (Diffuse). NEMA 1, 2, IP62. UL Approved.
CAPACITY–12,000 lbs. maximum at 30 FPM (2 HP maximum). NOT TO EXCEED CAPACITY IN
ACCUMULATION ZONES–36 in., 42 in., 48 in., 54 in., 60 in., and 66 in. long intermediate sections CHART.
with EZLogic® Accumulation (Diffuse). Contact factory for other lengths. (Drive Section minimum
60 in. long.) FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
input/output boards. Requires 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
2 12,000 11,000
*Load capacities in accumulation mode are calculated assuming no more than half
EZLOGIC® ACCUMULATION SYSTEM
of the load will be moving at any time.
Hytrol’s EZLogic®, or “Electronic Zero-pressure Logic” Accumulation System, combines the sensing
accuracy of photo-electronics with discrete electronic logic control without the use of a PLC
or pneumatic logic components. The EZLogic® Accumulation System provides many features MAXIMUM UNIT LOAD - 4000 lbs.
including:
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting
a dry contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature
is always used at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location
where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate
the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from
a removed load, preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are
routinely removed from the conveyor with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck
and stops the zone from driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from
entering loading area.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–DCDS and DCS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. CONVEYING SPEED–Speeds other than 30 FPM will require gearmotor change (contact factory).
Specify top of chain elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes
. in feet for lagging to floor. ELECTRICAL MOTOR CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starter – push-button stations.
CLOSED TAIL–Overall length will be affected. EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 08312018
DCEZ-83
The Model DCEZ-83 is a three strand drag chain conveyor
Drag Chain Conveyor
• 3 Strand Design
designed to handle pallets. With EZLogic® Zone Controller, • EZLogic® Accumulation System (Diffuse)
pallets are accumulated with zero pressure reducing the • 10 Widths
possibility of collision that may result in product damage. • Modular Assembly
• Adjustable DC3S and DCDS-Type Floor Supports Available
FRAME WIDTH 50 1/2” 56 1/2” 62 1/2” 68 1/2” 74 1/2” 80 1/2” 86 1/2” 92 1/2” 98 1/2” 104 1/2”
OVERALL
LENGTH “A” STRAND
24” 27” 30” 33” 36” 39” 42” 45” 48” 51”
CENTERS
U.S. Patent Numbers
12’ WEIGHTS 1255 1305 1355 1405 1455 1505 1555 1605 1655 1705 7,243,781 • 7,591,366
(Lbs.) based 7,905,345
on 60” Frame Other Patents Pending.
Per Foot
Lengths 77 80 83 86 89 92 95 98 101 104
Weight
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
HOW IT WORKS
The conveyor is made up of drive, intermediate and tail sections
60" on which three strands of #80 single-pitch chain travel. Each
60" 12" ZONE LENGTH 12"
12"INTERMEDIATE DRIVE ZONE strand is a continuous loop and driven by a common drive shaft.
DRIVE ZONE Hytrol’s EZLogic® Zone Controller sense product presence and
control the accumulation and release of product from the zones.
To accumulate products accumulation lift pads are activated
which lift the product off of chain strands.
24" MIN.
24" MIN.
IMPORTANT NOTE:
Do not operate DCEZ in sleep or slug mode.
24" MIN.
24" MIN.
ACCUMULATION
LIFT PAD FILTER REGULATOR
FILTER REGULATOR
FILL PLATE
E “X” “X”
“X” IOP
IOP
1"
1" IOP #80 SINGLE
#80 SINGLE PITCH CHAIN
IOP
PITCH CHAIN ~
~
14" MIN.
14" MIN.
OPTIONAL SUPPORT W/ADJ. FILTER REGULATOR
OPTIONAL SUPPORT W/ADJ. FOOT
FILTER PAD SHOWN
REGULATOR CENTER DRIVE SECTION
FOOT PAD SHOWN OPTIONAL DCDS SUPPORT SHOWN
CENTER DRIVE SECTION
OPTIONAL DCDS SUPPORT SHOWN
VIEW X-X
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS DCEZ-83
CHAIN –#80 single pitch conveyor chain (straight sidebar). AIR REQUIREMENTS– Recommended working pressure 60 P.S.I. Free air consumption at 75 P.S.I.
- 1.0 cu. ft. per actuation for 24 in. & 27 in. strand centers - 1.5 cu. ft. per actuation for 30 in. - 51
CHAIN GUIDE – UHMW polyethylene. in. strand centers.
FRAME – 6 in. x 4 ga. powder painted formed steel angle with 2 in. x 1/4 in. wall, chain support FILTER, REGULATOR–Supplied for main air supply line (1/2 in. NPT port). Includes pressure
tube. 4 ga. formed coupling channels located at infeed and discharge ends of each module. sensor.
DRIVE SPROCKETS – Hardened #80 with 1 1/2 in. dia. steel shaft. MOTOR –2 HP – 208/230/460/575V– 3 PH. 60 HZ. gearmotor, located underneath in 5 ft. long
module.
BEARINGS – Sealed, pre-lubricated, self aligning, ball bearings on drive.
CONVEYING SPEED –30 FPM.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–36 in., 42 in., 48 in., 54 in., 60 in., and 66 in. long intermediate sections
with EZLogic® Accumulation (Diffuse). Contact factory for other lengths. (Drive Section minimum CAPACITY–12,000 lbs. maximum at 30 FPM (2 HP maximum). NOT TO EXCEED CAPACITY IN
60 in. long.) CHART.
EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone (Diffuse). NEMA 1, 2, IP62. UL Approved. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
input/output boards. Requires 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a
dry contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is MAXIMUM UNIT LOAD - 4000 lbs.
always used at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where
a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the
length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from
a removed load, preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are
routinely removed from the conveyor with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and
stops the zone from driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering
loading area.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–DCDS and DC3S Type floor supports are available with a wide range of CONVEYING SPEED–Speeds other than 30 FPM will require geamotor change (contact factory).
adjustment. Specify top of chain elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of
conveyor. Holes in feet for lagging to floor. ELECTRICAL MOTOR CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starter – push-button stations.
CLOSED TAIL–Overall length will be affected. EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 08312018
DCEZD-62
The Model DCEZD-62 is a two strand drag chain conveyor •
Drag Chain Conveyor
2 Strand Design
designed to handle pallets. With EZLogic® Zone Controller, • EZDriveTM System (Individual zone drive)
pallets are accumulated with zero pressure, reducing the • EZLogic® Accumulation System
possibility of collision that may result in product damage. • Modular Assembly
• Adjustable DCS-Type Floor Supports Available
FRAME WIDTH 19 7/8” 22 7/8” 25 7/8” 28 7/8” 31 7/8” 34 7/8” 37 7/8” 40 7/8” 43 7/8” 46 7/8” 49 7/8”
OVERALL
LENGTH “A” STRAND
18” 21” 24” 27” 30” 33” 36” 39” 42” 45” 48”
CENTERS
U.S. Patent Numbers
10’ 615 641 667 694 720 748 774 801 827 851 880 7,243,781 • 7,591,366
WEIGHTS
7,905,345 • 6,860,381
Per Foot (Lbs.) Other Patents Pending.
62 64 67 69 72 75 78 80 83 85 88
Weight
HOW IT WORKS
The conveyor is made up of
accumulation zones. Each zone
contains an individual zone drive
interfaced to Hytrol’s EZLogic® Zone
Controllers which sense product
presence and control the accumulation
and release of the zones by starting
and stopping the zone drives.
18" MIN.
DISCONNECT BOX
STARTER BOX OPTIONAL SUPPORT
IOP W/ADJ FOOT PAD SHOWN
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS DCEZD-62
CHAIN –#60 single pitch conveyor chain (straight sidebar). IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
input/output boards. Requires 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
CHAIN GUIDE – UHMW polyethylene.
MOTOR – 3/4 HP – 230/460/575V– 3 PH. 60 HZ. gearmotor, shaft mounted at discharge end of
FRAME – 11 1/8 in. x 7 ga. powder painted formed steel angle. 7 ga. formed coupling channels zone.
located at infeed and discharge ends of each module.
CONVEYING SPEED –30 FPM.
DRIVE SPROCKETS – Hardened #60 with 1 7/16 in. dia. steel shaft.
CAPACITY–3,000 lbs. maximum per zone at 30 FPM.
BEARINGS – Sealed, pre-lubricated, self aligning, ball bearings on drive.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone. NEMA 1, 2, IP62. UL Approved.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–60 in. long sections with EZLogic® Accumulation. DISCONNECT 230V 460V
PANEL 3 Ph. 60 Hz 3 Ph. 60 Hz
EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER
SINGLE OUTPUT 1-4 ZONES 1-8 ZONES
INFEED EYE IOP
DUAL OUTPUT 5-8 ZONES 9-16 ZONES
ZONE GEARMOTOR
EZDRIVE™ ZONE STARTER BOX
SINGLE OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL
INFEED EYE IOP EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER
DUAL OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL ZONE GEARMOTOR EZDRIVE™ ZONE STARTER BOX
(MUST BE LOCATED AT THE CENTER OF CONVEYOR)
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always used
at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Sleep Feature – Stops chains from running when no product is present, reducing noise, reducing energy consumption and extending chain life.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from a removed load, preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are routinely removed
from the conveyor with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and stops the zone from driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering loading
area.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–DCS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify CONVEYING SPEED–Speeds other than 30 FPM will require gearmotor change (contact factory).
top of chain elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in feet
for lagging to floor. EZDriveTM System–Variable Frequency Drive for adjusting conveying speed or adjusting acceleration
and deceleration time.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–48 in., 54 in., and 66 in. intermediate sections with EZLogic® Accumulation.
Contact factory for other lengths. EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 08312018
DCEZD-63
The Model DCEZD-63 is a three strand drag chain conveyor •
Drag Chain Conveyor
3 Strand Design
designed to handle pallets. With EZLogic® Zone Controller, • EZDriveTM System (Individual zone drive)
pallets are accumulated with zero pressure, reducing the • EZLogic® Accumulation System
possibility of collision that may result in product damage. • Modular Assembly
• Adjustable DCS-Type Floor Supports Available
OVERALL FRAME WIDTH 37 7/8” 43 7/8” 49 7/8” 55 7/8” 61 7/8” 67 7/8” 73 7/8” 79 7/8” 85 7/8” 91 7/8” 97 7/8”
LENGTH STRAND
“A” 18” 21” 24” 27” 30” 33” 36” 39” 42” 45” 48”
CENTERS
U.S. Patent Numbers
10’ 925 965 1004 1044 1083 1125 1166 1206 1245 1281 1325 7,243,781 • 7,591,366
WEIGHTS 7,905,345 • 6,860,381
Per Foot Other Patents Pending.
93 97 100 104 108 113 117 121 125 128 133
Weight
HOW IT WORKS
The conveyor is made up of accumulation zones. Each zone contains
an individual zone drive interfaced to Hytrol’s EZLogic® Zone Controllers
which sense product presence and control the accumulation and release
of the zones by starting and stopping the zone drives.
18" MIN
18" MIN
#60 SINGLE
FILL PLATE EZLOGIC® RETRO- PITCH CHAIN
PALLET GUIDE REFLECTIVE ZONE
12" MIN
CONTROLLER
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS DCEZD-63
CHAIN –#60 single pitch conveyor chain (straight sidebar). IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
input/output boards. Requires 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
CHAIN GUIDE – UHMW polyethylene.
MOTOR – 3/4 HP – 230/460/575V– 3 PH. 60 HZ. gearmotor, shaft mounted at discharge end of
FRAME – 11 1/8 in. x 7 ga. powder painted formed steel angle. 7 ga. formed coupling channels zone.
located at infeed and discharge ends of each module.
CONVEYING SPEED –30 FPM.
DRIVE SPROCKETS – Hardened #60 with 1 7/16 in. dia. steel shaft.
CAPACITY–3,000 lbs. maximum per zone at 30 FPM.
BEARINGS – Sealed, pre-lubricated, self aligning, ball bearings on drive.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone. NEMA 1, 2, IP62. UL Approved.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–60 in. long sections with EZLogic® Accumulation. DISCONNECT 230V 460V
PANEL 3 Ph. 60 Hz 3 Ph. 60 Hz
EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER
SINGLE OUTPUT 1-4 ZONES 1-8 ZONES
INFEED EYE IOP
DUAL OUTPUT 5-8 ZONES 9-16 ZONES
ZONE GEARMOTOR
EZDRIVE™ ZONE STARTER BOX
SINGLE OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL
INFEED EYE IOP EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER
DUAL OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL ZONE GEARMOTOR EZDRIVE™ ZONE STARTER BOX
(MUST BE LOCATED AT THE CENTER OF CONVEYOR)
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always used
at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Sleep Feature – Stops chains from running when no product is present, reducing noise, reducing energy consumption and extending chain life.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from a removed load, preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are routinely removed
from the conveyor with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and stops the zone from driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering loading
area.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–DCS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify CONVEYING SPEED–Speeds other than 30 FPM will require gearmotor change (contact factory).
top of chain elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in feet
for lagging to floor. EZDriveTM System–Variable Frequency Drive for adjusting conveying speed or adjusting acceleration
and deceleration time.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–48 in., 54 in., and 66 in. intermediate sections with EZLogic® Accumulation.
Contact factory for other lengths. EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 08312018
DCEZD-82
The Model DCEZD-82 is a two strand drag chain conveyor •
Drag Chain Conveyor
2 Strand Design
designed to handle pallets. With EZLogic® Zone Controller, • EZDriveTM System (Individual zone drive)
pallets are accumulated with zero pressure, reducing the • EZLogic® Accumulation System
possibility of collision that may result in product damage. • Shaft Mounted Drives
• Adjustable DCS-Type Floor Supports Available
FRAME WIDTH 26 1/2” 29 1/2” 32 1/2” 35 1/2” 38 1/2” 41 1/2” 44 1/2” 47 1/2” 50 1/2” 53 1/2”
OVERALL
LENGTH “A” STRAND
24” 27” 30” 33” 36” 39” 42” 45” 48” 51”
CENTERS
U.S. Patent Numbers
10’ 834 868 902 936 970 1004 1038 1072 1106 1144 7,243,781 • 7,591,366
WEIGHTS
7,905,345 • 6,860,381
Per Foot (Lbs.) Other Patents Pending.
52 55 58 61 64 67 70 73 76 79
Weight
HOW IT WORKS
The conveyor is made up of accumulation zones. Each zone contains
an individual zone drive interfaced to Hytrol’s EZLogic® Zone Controllers
which sense product presence and control the accumulation and release
of the zones by starting and stopping the zone drives.
18" MIN.
DISCONNECT BOX
STARTER BOX OPTIONAL SUPPORT
IOP W/ADJ FOOT PAD SHOWN
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS DCEZD-82
CHAIN –#80 single pitch conveyor chain (straight sidebar). IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
input/output boards. Requires 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
CHAIN GUIDE – UHMW polyethylene.
MOTOR –1 HP – 230/460/575V– 3 PH. 60 HZ. gearmotor, shaft mounted at discharge end of
FRAME – 12 in. x 4 ga. powder painted formed steel angle. 7 ga. formed coupling channels located zone.
at infeed and discharge ends of each module.
CONVEYING SPEED –30 FPM.
DRIVE SPROCKETS – Hardened #80 with 1 11/16 in. dia. steel shaft.
CAPACITY–4,000 lbs. maximum per zone at 30 FPM.
BEARINGS – Sealed, pre-lubricated, self aligning, ball bearings on drive.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone. NEMA 1, 2, IP62. UL Approved.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–60 in. long sections with EZLogic® Accumulation. DISCONNECT 230V 460V
PANEL 3 Ph. 60 Hz 3 Ph. 60 Hz
EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER
SINGLE OUTPUT 1-3 ZONES 1-6 ZONES
INFEED EYE IOP
DUAL OUTPUT 4-6 ZONES 7-12 ZONES
ZONE GEARMOTOR
EZDRIVE™ ZONE STARTER BOX
SINGLE OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL
INFEED EYE IOP EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER
DUAL OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL ZONE GEARMOTOR EZDRIVE™ ZONE STARTER BOX
(MUST BE LOCATED AT THE CENTER OF CONVEYOR)
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always used
at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Sleep Feature – Stops chains from running when no product is present, reducing noise, reducing energy consumption and extending chain life.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from a removed load, preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are routinely removed
from the conveyor with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and stops the zone from driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering loading
area.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–DC82S Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. CONVEYING SPEED–Speeds other than 30 FPM will require gearmotor change (contact factory).
Specify top of chain elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes
in feet for lagging to floor. EZDriveTM System–Variable Frequency Drive for adjusting conveying speed or adjusting acceleration
and deceleration time.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–48 in., 54 in., and 66 in. intermediate sections with EZLogic® Accumulation.
Contact factory for other lengths. EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 08312018
DCEZD-83
The Model DCEZD-83 is a three strand drag chain conveyor •
Drag Chain Conveyor
3 Strand Design
designed to handle pallets. With EZLogic® Zone Controller, • EZDriveTM System (Individual zone drive)
pallets are accumulated with zero pressure, reducing the • EZLogic® Accumulation System
possibility of collision that may result in product damage. • Shaft Mounted Drives
• Adjustable DCS-Type Floor Supports Available
OVERALL FRAME WIDTH 50 1/2” 56 1/2” 62 1/2” 68 1/2” 74 1/2” 80 1/2” 86 1/2” 92 1/2” 98 1/2” 104 1/2”
LENGTH STRAND
“A” 24” 27” 30” 33” 36” 39” 42” 45” 48” 51”
CENTERS
U.S. Patent Numbers
10’ 1255 1305 1355 1405 1455 1505 1555 1605 1655 1705 7,243,781 • 7,591,366
WEIGHTS 7,905,345 • 6,860,381
Per Foot Other Patents Pending.
77 80 83 86 89 92 95 98 101 104
Weight
HOW IT WORKS
The conveyor is made up of accumulation zones. Each zone contains
an individual zone drive interfaced to Hytrol’s EZLogic® Zone Controllers
ZONE LENGTH ZONE which
LENGTH sense product presence and control the accumulation and release
of the zones by starting and stopping the zone drives.
18" MIN
18" MIN
#80 SINGLE
FILL PLATE EZLOGIC® RETRO- PITCH CHAIN
12 5/8 " MIN
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS DCEZD-83
CHAIN –#80 single pitch conveyor chain (straight sidebar). IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
input/output boards. Requires 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
CHAIN GUIDE – UHMW polyethylene.
MOTOR –1 HP – 230/460/575V– 3 PH. 60 HZ. gearmotor, shaft mounted at discharge end of
FRAME – 12 in. x 4 ga. powder painted formed steel angle. 4 ga. formed coupling channels located zone.
at infeed and discharge ends of each module.
CONVEYING SPEED –30 FPM.
DRIVE SPROCKETS – Hardened #80 with 1 11/16 in. dia. steel shaft.
CAPACITY–4,000 lbs. maximum per zone at 30 FPM.
BEARINGS – Sealed, pre-lubricated, self aligning, ball bearings on drive.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone. NEMA 1, 2, IP62. UL Approved.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–60 in. long sections with EZLogic® Accumulation. DISCONNECT 230V 460V
PANEL 3 Ph. 60 Hz 3 Ph. 60 Hz
EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER
SINGLE OUTPUT 1-3 ZONES 1-6 ZONES
INFEED EYE IOP
DUAL OUTPUT 4-6 ZONES 7-12 ZONES
ZONE GEARMOTOR
EZDRIVE™ ZONE STARTER BOX
SINGLE OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL
INFEED EYE IOP EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER
DUAL OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL ZONE GEARMOTOR EZDRIVE™ ZONE STARTER BOX
(MUST BE LOCATED AT THE CENTER OF CONVEYOR)
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always used
at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Sleep Feature – Stops chains from running when no product is present, reducing noise, reducing energy consumption and extending chain life.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from a removed load, preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are routinely removed
from the conveyor with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and stops the zone from driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering loading
area.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–DC83S Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. CONVEYING SPEED–Speeds other than 30 FPM will require gearmotor change (contact factory).
Specify top of chain elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes
in feet for lagging to floor. EZDriveTM System–Variable Frequency Drive for adjusting conveying speed or adjusting acceleration
and deceleration time.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–48 in., 54 in., and 66 in. intermediate sections with EZLogic® Accumulation.
Contact factory for other lengths. EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 08312018
TA Horizontal Belt Conveyor
A very versatile conveyor, the Model TA can be used in many •
•
10 Belt Widths
Reversible (with center drive)
types of material handling situations such as assembly line
operations, sorting, packing, and inspection. Conveyor sets • Smooth, Slim Bed
up quickly and easily to save on installation time. • Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available Conveyor shown
with optional floor
supports.
52 ½
68 1 3”
Conveyor shown with featured ALLOW 6-1/2”
82 1 option - shaft mounted end drive 11-1/4" 13-1/4"
MAX.
16"
4-7/8”
REF
24" 4”
103 1 MIN ELEV
37-1/4"
138 1 MAX.
OPTIONAL MS-D SUPPORT FEATURED OPTION:
206 1 SHOWN SHAFT MOUNTED DRIVE
274
412
1
1
8” END DRIVE SHOWN MOUNTED HORIZONTAL
2-1/8" DIA.
SECTION “X-X”
SNUB IDLER OVERALL LENGTH "A"
6"
4" DIA.
DRIVE PULLEY
BED LENGTH "L" BED
NIP POINT TAKE-UP 4" DIA. WIDTH
GUARD TAIL PULLEY FORMED
1.9" DIA. 4" STEEL BED
6" RETURN IDLER "X" BELT
FLOW NIP POINT
GUARD
WIDTH
4-9/16"
15-5/8"
MAX. 4"
11-1/16"
2" 2"
13-1/4"
22" MAX. 2-1/8" DIA.
SNUB IDLER
ALLOW
35-1/4" 16" 2-1/8" DIA.
TOTALLY ENCLOSED SNUB IDLER
OPTIONAL "X"
MS SUPPORT SHOWN CHAIN GUARD
4” END DRIVE
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS TA
BELT–Ultimate 140 BBS–Nitrile.
TAKE-UP–Take-ups at tail pulley. Provides 4 in. of belt take-up.
BED–4 in. deep x 12 ga. formed steel slider bed- powder painted. Standard 5 ft. & 10 ft. long sections
bolt together with splice plates. BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive and tail pulleys.
END DRIVE–Located on discharge end of conveyor, chain guard on left hand side. SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive pulley.
DRIVE PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings or 8 in. dia. with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bear- MOTOR–½ HP–208/230/460V/575–3 Ph.–60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
ings, machine crowned and fully lagged. See chart.
BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned.
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 75 lbs. NOT TO EXCEED capacity in charts.
SNUB IDLER–Adjustable 2 1/8 in. dia. for 4 in. pulley–2 ½ in. dia. for 8 in. pulley. Pre-lubricated ball
bearings. Guards included. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes
GUARD RAILS–Universal adjustable universal channel, solid side guards, PC side guards with
in feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
formed top. Fixed Channel overlapping, one direction (use with systems ends only). Fixed Channel
non-overlapping, reversing (use with system ends only).
BELT*–White Polymate 100 RMP-COS (cover one side), Black Trackmate 120 Roughtop with PVC
cover, Brown Polymate Roughtop w/Nitrile cover, Black Trackmate 533 COS-PVC, Tan Glidetop,
NOSEOVER*–Adjustable, single (0° to 15°), double (0° to 30°).
Pure Gum Rubber Roughtop. Incline units: Black Trackmate 120 High Grip Longitudinal Groove.
LOWER POWERED FEEDER*–Chain type driven from tail pulley of inclined conveyor. Underside
BELT SPEED*–Other constant and variable speeds. V-belt drive supplied under 17 FPM.
take-up required when end drive is used. MS-Type floor supports now supplied as optional
equipment. 8 in. dia. drive recommended on conveyor when feeder exceeds 44 ½ in. OAL–50 ½
SHAFT MOUNTED END DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted on extended drive pulley shaft. Can
in. OAL with system end.
be mounted with motor horizontal for 4 7/8 in. minimum elevation. Mounting bracket and torque
arm allows for multiple mounting positions. 4 in. drive only. See chart page 5 for speeds.
GRAVITY BRACKETS–Adjustable bars with 1 in. dia. pop-out transfer roller to attach wheel or
1 3/8 in. roller conveyor. Available 12 in. to 28 in. bed widths only.
OVERHEAD END DRIVE–Motor-reducer unit mounted 9 ½ in. above belt. Other clearances
available, specify. (Chain guard right hand side). Minimum elevation 6 in. with 4 in. drive, 10 in.
BUTT COUPLINGS–Provides connection to SB, RB, LR, ACC, ACZ, ABEZ, 190-NSP, 190-NSPEZ, 1.9
with 8 in. drive.
in. & 2.0 in. gravity conveyors. Includes 1 in. dia. pop-out roller. Center drive or underside take-up
recommended.
SIDE MOUNTED END DRIVE–Motor-reducer unit mounted on left hand side of conveyor.
Minimum elevation 7 in. with 4 in. drive, 10 in. with 8 in. drive.
SYSTEM END ROLLER–12 in. long tail sections provide connection to SB, RB, LR, ACC, ACZ, ABEZ,
190-NSP, 190-NSPEZ, 1.9 in. & 2.0 in. gravity conveyors. Includes 1.9 in. dia. pop-out transfer
CENTER DRIVE–Provides 16 in. of belt take-up. Minimum elevation 16 in. with 4 in. drive, 17 in.
roller. Belt width is 6 in. less than bed width. (Center drive or underside take-up required.) Not
with 8 in. drive. Specify location. Minimum OAL without modification–66 in. with 4 in. drive, 66
available on 10 in. bed.
in. with 8 in. drive. Belt width is 6 in. less than bed width.
PULLEYS–6 in. tail with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, or 8 in. drive with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at
LOW ELEVATION SIDE MOUNTED CENTER DRIVE–Motor-reducer unit mounted to side of
bearings.
conveyor. Minimum elevation 13 ½ in. with 4 in. or 8 in. drive. Belt width is 6 in. less than bed
width.
CASTERS–See Accessory section.
STACKED END DRIVE–Minimum elevation 27 3/4 in. with V-belt drive, 33 3/4 in. with C-Face drive.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
V-BELT DRIVE–V-Belt supplied between motor and reducer. Minimum overall drive width 14
CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and
in. Allow 65 in.
galvanized rods available.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not
MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
permit regular lubrication).
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–One direction manual start switch, reverse drum switch, non-reversing
UNDERSIDE TAKE-UP–Provides 16 in. of belt take-up. Extends down 13 1/8 in. from top of belt.
and reversible magnetic starters, push button stations. AC variable frequency drive.
Belt width is 6 in. less than bed width.
* NOTE: Capacity affected with these options.
SIDE TABLES–Powder painted 14 ga. formed steel table, 10 in., 16 in., or 22 in. wide from side
of bed. One or both sides.
CATALOG | 08312018
GAPPER-D
The Model Gapper is designed for feeding sawtooth • 2-Stage
Horizontal Belt Gapping Conveyor
(Slider Bed)
Belt
12" 18" 24" 30" 36"
SIZE TO Width
ORDER Between
15" 21" 27" 33" 39"
Overall Rail Width
Length Overall
18" 24" 30" 36" 42"
Frame Width
12' Weights 761 1015 1269 1523 1777
Weight Per Foot 63 85 106 127 148
12'-0"
Totally Enclosed
Chain Guard
CATALOG | 03202019
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS GAPPER-D
BELT–High grip longitudinally grooved belt; NSL-11ESBV-U2 Endless Splice. DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 11/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, lat-faced and non-lagged.
BED–12 ga. galvanized slider pan mounted on a 17 in. x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel BEARINGS –Sealed, pre-lubricated, ball bearings on drive. Precision bearings on tail shafts.
frame.
MOTOR – 208/230/460/575V - 3 PH. - 60 HZ. Premium Energy Efficient C-Face.
SPRING TENSION TAKE-UP– 2 1/4" dia. take-up pulley; provides 16" of belt take-up.
SPEED REDUCTION – Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No 60 roller chain to drive pulley.
NOTE: Maximum operational speed will be limited to carton sizes being conveyed in NOTE: As cartons pass from the infeed belt to the higher speed discharge belt,
order to prevent carton tumbling or sliding. Contact Factory for specific application a gap is created between cartons according to the following formula:
limits.
SGR FORUMLA
1.25 Length of Box + Final Gap
--------------------------- = Speed Gap Ratio (SGR)
1.50 Length of Box + Initial Gap
1.75
2.00 Gaps are then measured and speed altered during release of cartons to create
desired final gap or pitch. This process is required at each transition where there
2.25 is a speed change.
2.50
Discharge Belt Speed
SGR = -------------------------------
Infeed Belt Speed
LENGTH
FINAL INITIAL
OF
GAP GAP
BOX
FLOW
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
LENGTH–Optional 10’-0” long bed section with 60” long infeed and discharge segments.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
MOTORS–Single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, overlapping fixed channel (one direction).
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–One direction manual start switch, non-reversing starters, push button
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
stations. AC variable frequency drive.
regular lubrication).
CATALOG | 03202019
GAPPER-O
The Model Gap Optimizer is designed for feeding sawtooth • 3-Stages
Horizontal Belt Gapping Conveyor
with Controls
Belt
12" 18" 24" 30" 36"
SIZE TO Width
ORDER Between
15" 21" 27" 33" 39"
Overall Rail Width
Length Overall
18" 24" 30" 36" 42"
Frame Width
12' Weights 1227 1636 2045 2454 2863
Weight Per Foot 102 136 170 204 239
12'-0"
Optional MS Supports
CATALOG | 03202019
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS GAPPER-O
BELT–High grip longitudinally grooved belt; NSL-11ESBV-U2 Endless Splice.
DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 11/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, lat-faced and non-lagged.
BED–12 ga. galvanized slider pan mounted on a 17 in. x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel
frame. BEARINGS –Sealed, pre-lubricated, ball bearings on drive. Precision bearings on tail shafts.
SPRING TENSION TAKE-UP– 2 1/4" dia. take-up pulley; provides 16" of belt take-up. MOTOR – 2HP Eurodrive Gearmotor with encoder ES7C.
NOTE: As cartons pass from the infeed belt to the higher speed discharge
belt, a gap is created between cartons according to the following formula:
FORUMLA
Length of Box + Final Gap
--------------------------- = Speed Gap Ratio (SGR)
Length of Box + Initial Gap
Gaps are then measured and speed altered during release of cartons to
create desired final gap or pitch. This process is required at each transition
where there is a speed change.
Discharge Belt Speed
SGR = -------------------------------
Infeed Belt Speed
LENGTH
FINAL INITIAL
OF
GAP GAP
BOX
FLOW
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, overlapping fixed channel (one direction).
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
LENGTH–Optional 10'0" long bed section available with 40 in. bed segments.
CATALOG | 03202019
SB Horizontal Belt Conveyor
(Slider Bed)
The Model SB is a slider bed conveyor designed with channel • 15 Belt Widths
frames and bolt in pans. Frame design makes it ideal for • Center Drive
matching up with roller bed conveyors. • Reversible Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
• System Ends
• Pop-Out Roller
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
SIZE TO Belt Width 10” 12” 14” 16” 18” 20” 22” SIZE TO 24” 28” 30” 34" 36” 42" 48" 54"
ORDER Between ORDER
Overall Bed 13” 15” 17” 19” 21” 23” 25” Overall 27” 31” 33” 37" 39” 45" 51" 57"
Rail Width
Length Length Length
“A” “L” Overall “A”
4” Dia. Frame 16” 18” 20” 22” 24” 26” 28” 6” Dia. 30” 34” 36” 40" 42” 48" 54" 60"
Pulley Width Pulley
12' 10' 561 593 625 657 689 721 753 12' 791 865 940 1014 1088 1162 1237 1312
17' 15' 660 696 732 768 804 840 876 17' 919 1002 1085 1167 1250 1333 1415 1497
22' 20' 760 800 840 880 920 960 1000 22' 1047 1138 1230 1321 1412 1503 1594 1682
27' 25' 859 903 947 991 1035 1079 1123 27' 1175 1275 1375 1474 1574 1673 1773 1867
32' 30' 959 1007 1054 1102 1150 1198 1246 32' 1304 1412 1520 1627 1735 1844 1952 2052
37' 35' 1058 1110 1162 1214 1266 1317 1369 37' 1432 1548 1665 1781 1897 2014 2130 2237
42' 40' 1158 1213 1269 1325 1381 1437 1492 42' 1560 1685 1810 1934 2059 2184 2309 2422
47' 45' 1257 1317 1377 1436 1496 1556 1616 47' 1688 1821 1955 2088 2221 2355 2488 2607
52' 50' 1357 1420 1484 1548 1612 1675 1739 52' 1816 1958 2100 2241 2383 2525 2667 2792
Weights
57' 55' 1456 1524 1592 1659 1727 1794 1862 57' 1944 2094 2245 2395 2545 2695 2845 2977
(Lbs.)
62' 60' 1556 1627 1699 1771 1842 1914 1985 62' 2072 2231 2390 2548 2707 2865 3024 3162
67' 65' 1655 1731 1806 1882 1957 2033 2109 67' 2200 2367 2535 2702 2869 3036 3203 3347
72' 70' 1755 1834 1914 1993 2073 2152 2232 72' 2328 2504 2680 2855 3031 3206 3382 3532
77' 75' 1854 1938 2021 2105 2188 2272 2355 77' 2456 2640 2825 3009 3193 3376 3560 3717
82' 80' 1954 2041 2129 2216 2303 2391 2478 82' 2585 2777 2970 3162 3354 3547 3739 3902
87' 85' 2053 2145 2236 2327 2419 2510 2601 87' 2713 2914 3115 3315 3516 3717 3918 4087
92' 90' 2153 2248 2343 2439 2534 2629 2725 92' 2841 3050 3260 3469 3678 3887 4097 4272
97' 95' 2252 2352 2451 2550 2649 2749 2848 97' 2669 3187 3405 3622 3840 4058 4275 4457
102' 100' 2352 2455 2558 2662 2765 2868 2971 102' 3097 3323 3550 3776 4002 4228 4454 4642
All weights in catalog are CONVEYOR WEIGHTS ONLY. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
17-3/4"
SECTION “X-X”
10-3/4"
8" OVERALL FRAME WIDTH
6-1/2"
CHANNEL
BOLT IN
2-1/8" DIA. SNUB IDLER/
SLIDER PAN
1.9" RETURN IDLER
TOTALLY ENCLOSED
CHAIN GUARD
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS SB
BELT–Ultimate 140 BBS–Nitrile. TAKE-UP–Take-up in center drive provides 16 in. of belt take-up.
BED–12 ga. galvanized slider pan mounted in 6 1/2 in. x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive and tail pulleys.
channel frame bolted together with splice plates.
SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive pulley.
CENTER DRIVE–Provides 16 in. of belt take-up. Minimum elevation– 17 3/4 in. Specify location.
Minimum OAL without modification-120 in. Chain guard located on left hand side. MOTOR–1 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph.–60 Hz. Premium Energy Efficient C-Face.
DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 7/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, fully lagged. BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings or 6 in. dia. with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 100 lbs. NOT TO EXCEED capacity in charts.
bearings, machine crowned.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
SNUB IDLER–Adjustable 2 1/8 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings. Guards included.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. section.
BELT*–Black Trackmate 120 High Grip Longitudinal Groove, White Polymate 100 RMP-COS (cover PULLEYS–6 in. tail pulley with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings in place of 4 in. when not furnished
one side), Black Trackmate 533 COS-PVC, Tan Glidetop. as standard.
BELT SPEED*–Other constant and variable speeds. V-belt drive supplied on speeds under 17 FPM. CASTERS–See Accessory section.
END DRIVE–8 in. end drive mounted on end of unit. Requires underside take-up. POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
LOW ELEVATION SIDE MOUNTED CENTER DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor. CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
Minimum elevation 16 1/2 in. rods available.
V-BELT DRIVE–V-Belt supplied between motor and reducer. Minimum overall drive width 14 in. MOTORS–Single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
Allow 65 in.
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–One direction manual start switch, reverse drum switch, non-reversing
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit and reversible magnetic starters, push button stations. AC variable frequency drive.
regular lubrication).
* NOTE: Capacity affected with these options.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, fixed channel, type A & B angle. Fixed
Channel overlapping, one direction. Fixed Channel non-overlapping, reversing. See Accessory
CATALOG | 08312018
SBI Floor-to-Floor Incline Conveyor
equipped with an adjustable double nose-over at the • Center Drive • Powered Feeder
discharge end to insure a smooth transfer from the incline to • Reversible • Ceiling Hangers Available
horizontal plane. Inclines are easily adjusted up to 30°. This • Brake Motor • Adjustable MS-Type Floor
conveyor can also be used as a booster conveyor in gravity Supports Available
• System Ends
flow systems. • Undertrussing (18”, 24”, &
• Double Nose-over
30”OAW From Stockyard Only)
SECTION X-X
1.9" DIA ROLLER 2-1/8" SNUB IDLER
OVERALL FRAME WIDTH
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS SBI
BELT–Black Trackmate 120 High Grip Longitudinal Groove with PVC cover. Clipper lacing. TAKE-UP–Take-ups in center drive provides 16 in. of belt take-up.
BED–12 ga. galvanized slider pan mounted in 6 1/2 in. x 12 ga. powder painted, formed steel SNUB IDLER/NOSE-OVER ROLLERS–Adjustable 2 1/8 in. dia. or 2 1/2 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball
channel frame. Standard 4 ft., 6 ft., 8 ft., and 10 ft. long sections bolt together with splice plates. bearings. Snub guards included.
DOUBLE NOSE-OVER–A 26 in. long horizontal and a 12 in. long nose-over section provides a RETURN IDLER–Adjustable 1.9 in. dia., pre-lubricated ball bearings.
two-step transition of product from incline to horizontal. Provides up to 30° incline adjustment.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive, tail and take-up pulley.
LOWER POWERED FEEDER–Chain type driven from tail pulley of inclined conveyor. Supports
not included in base price. SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive pulley.
CENTER DRIVE–Located on the incline section. Chain guard located on left hand side. MOTOR–1 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face “SSB” Brake Motor (6 ft./
lb.).
DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 7/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned and fully lagged.
BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings or 6 in. dia. with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at
bearings, machine crowned. CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 100 lbs. NOT TO EXCEED capacity in charts.
TAKE-UP PULLEY–6 in. dia. with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify non-overlapping fixed channel (bi-directional).
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes
in feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-3 support. PULLEYS–6 in. dia. tail pulley with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings in place of 4 in. when not
furnished as standard.
BELT–Black Trackmate 120 Roughtop with PVC Cover, Brown Polymate Roughtop w/Nitrile cover,
Pure Gum Rubber Roughtop. CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and
galvanized rods available.
BELT SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds V-belt drive supplied on speeds under 20 FPM (1
HP), 46 FPM (2 HP). NOTE: Capacity affected with speed change. UNDERTRUSSING–Available in place of ceiling hangers. Maximum bed length 40 ft. Maximum
overall width 30 in.
V-BELT DRIVE–V-belt supplied between motor and reducer. Allow 65 in.
MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
regular lubrication). ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing and reversible magnetic starters and push button stations.
AC variable frequency drive.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, overlapping fixed channel (one direction),
CATALOG | 08312018
TH Trash Belt Conveyor
Designed to handle empty cardboard boxes and paper trash. • 8 Belt Widths
• Center Drive
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
• Integral Side Guards Conveyor shown
• Underside Bed Cover Full Length with optional floor
supports
Belt
11 1/2" 17 1/2" 23 1/2" 29 1/2" 35 1/2" 41 1/2" 47 1/2" 53 1/2"
SIZE TO Width
Bed
ORDER Between
Length 13" 19" 25" 31" 37" 43" 49" 55"
Overall Rail Width
"L"
Length "A" Overall
16" 22" 28" 34" 40" 46" 52" 58"
Frame Width
12' 10' 732 867 1002 1137 1272 1408 1542 1676
22' 20' 974 1152 1330 1508 1686 1865 2042 2219
32' 30' 1216 1437 1658 1879 2100 2322 2542 2762
42' 40' 1458 1722 1986 2250 2514 2779 3042 3305
52' 50' 1700 2007 2314 2621 2928 3236 3542 3848
62' 60' 1942 2292 2642 2992 3342 3693 4042 4391
72' 70' 2184 2577 2970 3363 3756 4150 4542 4934
WEIGHTS
82' 80' 2426 2862 3298 3734 4170 4607 5042 5477
(Lbs.)
92' 90' 2668 3147 3626 4105 4584 5064 5542 6020
102' 100' 2910 3432 3954 4476 4998 5521 6042 6563
112' 110' 3152 3717 4282 4847 5412 5978 6542 7106
122' 120' 3394 4002 4610 5218 5826 6435 7042 7649
132' 130' 3636 4287 4938 5589 6240 6892 7542 8192
142' 140' 3878 4572 5266 5960 6654 7349 8042 8755
152' 150' 4120 4857 5594 6331 7068 7806 8542 9278
ADD TO ABOVE WEIGHTS FOR THE FOLLOWING ACCESSORIES:
• Noseover with 2 pulley hitch 138 172 206 240 274 308 342 376
• Other guard rails - pair - 6" high x 10' lg. 32 32 32 32 32 32 32 32
• Per 10' Int. section with support & belt 242 285 328 371 414 457 500 543
Above weights include 6" high guards, MS-6 supports, and 8" center drive.
Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
OVERALL
OVERALL LENGTH "A" FRAME WIDTH
BETWEEN
BED LENGTH "L" 12"
RAIL WIDTH
6"
PREFERRED
FLOW TAKE-UP 8" DIA. DRIVE PULLEY 4" & 6" DIA.
PULLEY TAIL PULLEY BELT
WIDTH
"X" 3-1/8" 1/2"
8-1/2"
6"
14"
ALLOW
21" 38-1/4" 16"
2-1/2" SNUB IDLER 10-3/4”
62 "
(ALLOW 65” WITH V-BELT DRIVE)
TOTALLY 2-1/2" SNUB IDLER OPTIONAL
ENCLOSED "X" MS-SUPPORTS TOTALLY ENCLOSED UNDERSIDE
BELT GUARD SHOWN CHAIN GUARD BED COVER
SECTION “X-X”
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS TH
BELT–Horizontal units: Ultimate 140 BBS–Nitrile.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, cast-iron ball bearings on drive and tail pulleys.
BED–14 ga. formed steel slider bed bolted between two 7 1/2 in. deep x 12 ga. formed steel side
channels with 6 in. high guards. Standard 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, and 10 ft. long sections. SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50, 60 or 80 roller chain to drive
pulley depending on speed and length.
CENTER DRIVE–Minimum elevation–16 11/16 in. Can be placed on any section of conveyor length.
Minimum OAL without modification 12 ft. 0 in. Chain guard located on left hand side. MOTOR–1 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph.–60 Hz. Premium Energy Efficient C-Face.
DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 7/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, fully lagged. BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned 13 in., 19 in., and 25 CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 10 lbs.
in. BR up to 150 ft. long. 6 in. dia. with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned all other
applications. DUST PANS–Solid 16 ga. underside dust covers held in place by 1/4 turn screws for easy removal.
SNUB IDLER–Adjustable 2 1/8 in. dia. with HD pre-lubricated ball bearings. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
rods available.
BELT–Inclined units: Black Trackmate 120 High Grip Longitudinal Groove with PVC cover.
Recommended but not required. Contact Factory for Application Information. MOTORS–Single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
BELT SPEED–Others constant or variable. ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–One direction manual start switch, non-reversing starters, push button
stations. AC variable frequency drive.
END DRIVE–8 in. side mounted end drive with underside takeup.
SIDE GUARDS–Available 12 in. to 24 in. high vertical. Flared guards
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit available on 6 in. and 12 in. high only.
regular lubrication).
MANUAL UNDERSIDE TAKE–UP–Provides 16 in. of belt take-up up to 150 ft..
NOSEOVER–(10°, 12 1/2°, 15°) Fixed single nose for transition of product from incline to horizontal.
PNEUMATIC UNDERSIDE TAKE–UP–Provides 60 in. of belt take-up for conveyors over 151 ft.
TWO-PULLEY HITCH–For transition of product from horizontal to incline (10°, 12 1/2 °, 15 °).
NOSEOVER
GUARD RAILS
BELT
FLOOR SUPPORTS
TWO-PULLEY HITCH
CATALOG | 08312018
TL Heavy Duty Horizontal
Belt Conveyor
The Model TL with its rugged, heavy duty construction is • 6 Belt Widths
ideally used for long assembly line operations, inspections, • Reversible (with center drive)
testing, sorting, and packing. Can be floor supported or • Rugged Construction
ceiling hung. • Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
SIZE TO
ORDER Overall Belt Width 24" 30" 36" 42" 48" 52"
Bed
Overall Length
Length
Length "A" with
"L"
6" Dia. Center Drive Bed Width 30" 36" 42" 48"* 54"* 58"*
Tail Pulley
7'-1" 5’ 6'-4" 375 N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
12'-1" 10’ 11'-4" 475 555 615 888 974 1060
17'-1" 15’ 16'-4" 625 686 752 1084 1191 1298
22'-1" 20’ 21'-4" 725 796 867 1280 1408 1536
27'-1" 25’ 26'-4" 875 967 1065 1476 1625 1774
32'-1" 30’ 31'-4" 975 1077 1180 1672 1842 2012
37'-1" 35’ 36'-4" 1125 1248 1377 1868 2059 2250
42'-1" 40’ 41'-4" 1225 1358 1492 2064 2276 2488
47'-1" 45’ 46'-4" 1375 1529 1690 2260 2493 2726
52'-1" 50’ 51'-4" WEIGHTS 1475 1639 1805 2456 2710 2964
57'-1" 55’ 56'-4" (Lbs.) 1625 1810 2002 2652 2927 3202
62'-1" 60’ 61'-4" 1725 1920 2117 2848 3144 3440
67'-1" 65’ 66'-4" 1875 2091 2315 3044 3361 3678
72'-1" 70’ 71'-4" 1975 2201 2430 3240 3578 3916
77'-1" 75’ 76'-4" 2125 2372 2627 3436 3795 4154
82'-1" 80’ 81'-4" 2225 2482 2742 3632 4012 4392
87'-1" 85’ 86'-4" 2375 2653 2940 3828 4229 4630
92'-1" 90’ 91'-4" 2479 2763 3055 4024 4446 4868
97'-1" 95’ 96'-4" 2625 2934 3252 4220 4663 5106
102'-1" 100’ 101'-4" 2725 3044 3367 4416 4880 5334
NOTE: • All weights in catalog are CONVEYOR WEIGHTS ONLY. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
• *5’-0” Bed, V-Belt Drive Only
• 36” Bed Width - 1 Week Stockyard .
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS TL
BELT–Ultimate 140 BBS–Nitrile. TAKE-UP–Take-ups at tail pulley. Provides 4 in. of belt take-up.
BED–6 5/8 in. deep x 12 ga. formed steel slider bed powder painted. Reinforced with 3/4 in. pipe which BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive and tail pulleys.
forms sockets for guard rails. Standard 5 ft. & 10 ft. long sections bolt together with splice plates. 48 in.
and 51 in. bed widths are available in 5 ft. lengths only. SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive pulley.
END DRIVE–Located on discharge end of conveyor, chain guard on left hand side. MOTOR–1 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph.–60 Hz. Premium Energy Efficient C-Face.
DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned and fully lagged. BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
TAIL PULLEY–6 in. dia. with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned. CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 100 lbs. NOT TO EXCEED capacity in charts.
SNUB IDLER–Adjustable 2 1/8 in. dia. for tail end 2 1/2 in. dia. for drive end. Pre-lubricated ball bearings. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
Guards included.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes LOWER POWERED FEEDER*–Chain type driven from tail pulley of inclined conveyor. Underside
in feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. take-up required when end drive is used. MS-Type floor supports now supplied as optional
equipment. 8 in. dia. drive recommended on conveyor when feeder exceeds 44 1/2 in. OAL–50 1/2
BELT*–White Polymate 100 RMP-COS (cover one side), Black Trackmate 120 Roughtop with PVC in. OAL with system end.
cover, Brown Polymate Roughtop w/Nitrile cover, Black Trackmate 533 COS-PVC, Tan Glidetop,
Pure Gum Rubber Roughtop. Incline units: Black Trackmate 120 High Grip Longitudinal Groove. BUTT COUPLINGS–Provides connection to SB, RB, LR, ACC, ACZ, ABEZ, 190-NSP, 190-NSPEZ, 20-
CR, 1.9 in. & 2.0 in. gravity conveyors. Includes 1 in. dia. pop out roller. Center drive or underside
BELT SPEED*–Other constant and variable speeds. V-belt drive supplied on speeds under 17 take-up recommended.
FPM.
SYSTEM END ROLLER–12 in. long tail sections provide connection to: SB, RB, LR, ACC, ACZ, ABEZ,
OVERHEAD END DRIVE–Motor-reducer unit mounted 9 1/2 in. above belt. Other clearances 190 NSP, 190-NSPEZ, 1.9 in. & 2.0 in. gravity conveyors. Includes 1.9 in. dia. pop-out transfer
available, specify. (Chain guard right hand side). Minimum elevation–10 in. roller. Belt width is 6 in. less than bed width. Center drive or underside take-up required.
SIDE MOUNTED END DRIVE–Motor-reducer unit mounted left hand side of conveyor. Minimum GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, solid side guards, PC side guards with
elevation 10 in. formed top.. Fixed Channel overlapping, one direction (use with systems ends only). Fixed
Channel non-overlapping, reversing (use with system ends only).
CENTER DRIVE–Provides 16 in. of belt take-up. Minimum elevation 20 in. Specify location.
Minimum OAL 66 in. CASTERS–See Accessory section.
LOW ELEVATION SIDE MOUNTED CENTER DRIVE–Motor-reducer unit mounted to side of POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces
conveyor. Minimum elevation 16 1/2 in. supplied.
STACKED END DRIVE–Contact factory for minimum elevations. CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and
galvanized rods available.
V-BELT DRIVE–V-Belt supplied between motor and reducer. Minimum overall drive width 14
in. Allow 65 in. MOTORS–Single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–One direction manual start switch, reverse drum switch, non-reversing
permit regular lubrication). and reversible magnetic starters, push button stations. AC variable frequency drive.
UNDERSIDE TAKE-UP–Provides 16 in. of belt take-up. Extends down 15 3/4 in. from top of belt. *NOTE: Capacity affected with these options.
CATALOG | 08312018
TR Horizontal Belt Conveyor
(Troughed Bed)
The Model TR, with built-in guard rails, is ideal for overhead • 10 Belt Widths
conveying applications. It easily conveys boxes, cartons, • Reversible (with center drive)
cases, bags, etc., as well as loose parts. • Troughed Bed
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
16-1/2" 9-1/2"
MAX. 11-15/16"
MAX.
15-5/8"
2" 11-1/16" 2"
2-1/8" DIA. 5-1/4"
13-1/4" SNUB IDLER 13-1/4"
22" 26"
MAX. MAX.
ALLOW
35-1/4" 39-1/4" ALLOW
16"
MAX. 16"
OPTIONAL MS "X"
SUPPORT SHOWN OPTIONAL MS
SUPPORT SHOWN
4"
2-1/8" DIA.
TOTALLY ENCLOSED SNUB IDLER
CHAIN GUARD
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS TR
BELT–Ultimate 140 BBS–Nitrile. TAKE-UP–Take-ups at tail pulley. Provides 4 in. of belt take-up.
BED–4 in. deep x 12 ga. formed steel slider bed with 2 1/2 in. deep guards, powder painted. Standard 5 BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated ball bearings, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive and tail pulleys.
ft. & 10 ft. long sections bolt together with splice plates.
SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive pulley.
END DRIVE–Located on discharge end of conveyor, chain guard on left hand side.
MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph.–60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
DRIVE PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings or 8 in. dia. with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at
bearings, machine crowned and fully lagged. See chart. BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned. CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 75 lbs. NOT TO EXCEED capacity in charts.
SNUB IDLER–Adjustable 2 1/8 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings. Guards included. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. UNDERSIDE TAKE-UP–Provides 16 in. of belt take-up. Extends down 13 1/4 in. from top of belt.
BELT*–White Polymate 100 RMP-COS (cover one side), Black Trackmate 120 High Grip Longitudinal NOSEOVER*–Adjustable, single (0 ° to 15 °), double (0 ° to 30 °).
Groove with PVC cover, Brown Polymate Roughtop w/Nitrile cover, Black Trackmate 533 COS-PVC, Tan
Glidetop, Brown Nitrile Roughtop. LOWER POWERED FEEDER*–Chain type driven from tail pulley of inclined conveyor. Underside take-
up required when end drive is used. MS-Type floor supports now supplied as optional equipment. 8
BELT SPEED*–Other constant and variable speeds. V-belt drive supplied under 17 FPM. in. dia. drive recommended on conveyor when feeder exceeds 44 1/2 in.OAL.
HIGHER SIDES–4 in., 6 in., 9 in., and 12 in. high vertical sides (12 in. Maximum). GRAVITY BRACKETS–Adjustable bars with 1 in. dia. pop-out transfer roller to attach wheel or 1 3/8
in. roller conveyor. Available 11 in. to 25 in. bed widths only.
OVERHEAD END DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted 9 1/2 in. above belt. Other clearances available,
specify. Chain guard RH side. Minimum elevation 6 in. with 4 in. drive, 10 in. with 8 in. drive. BUTT COUPLINGS–Provides connection to SB, RB, LR, ACC, ACZ, ABEZ, 190-NSP, 190-NSPEZ, 1.9
in. & 2.0 in. gravity conveyors. Includes 1 in. dia. pop-out roller. Center drive or underside take-up
SIDE MOUNTED END DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted to LH side of conveyor. Minimum recommended.
elevation 7 in. with 4 in. drive, 10 in. with 8 in. drive.
PULLEYS–6 in. tail with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings or 8 in. drive with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at
CENTER DRIVE–Provides 16 in. of belt take-up. Minimum elevation 16 in. with 4 in. drive, 17 in. bearings.
with 8 in. drive. Specify location. Minimum OAL without modification-63 in. with 4 in. drive, 66 in.
with 8 in. drive. CASTERS–See Accessory section.
LOW ELEVATION SIDE MOUNTED CENTER DRIVE–Motor-reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor. POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
Minimum elevation 13 1/2 in. with 4 in. or 8 in. drive.
CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
STACKED END DRIVE–Minimum elevation 27 3/4” with V-belt drive, 33 3/4” with C-Face drive. rods available.
SHAFT MOUNTED END DRIVE–Contact Factory MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
V-BELT DRIVE–V-Belt supplied between motor and reducer. Minimum overall drive width 14 in. ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–One direction manual start switch, reverse drum switch, non-reversing
Allow 65 in. and reversible magnetic starters, push button stations. AC variable frequency drive.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit *NOTE: Capacity affected with these options.
regular lubrication).
CATALOG | 08312018
C Cleated Incline Belt Conveyor
The Model C handles bags, boxes, cartons and parts. It may • 4 Belt Widths
be set at any angle from horizontal to 45o for various uses, • Reversible Conveyor shown
including floor-to-floor conveying and the transportation of • Cleated Roughtop Belt with optional floor
materials from building to truck or box car. supports
• Gravity Conveyor Brackets
• Pop-out Roller
• Undertrussed Bed
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS C
END DRIVE–Located on discharge end of conveyor.
SNUB IDLER–Adjustable 2 1/2 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings.
BELT–Black Trackmate 120 High Grip Longitudinal Groove with PVC cover. Clipper
lacing. RETURN IDLER–Adjustable 4 in. dia. spooled idler to provide clearance for cleats. Pre-lubricated
ball bearings.
CLEATS–Two 1 1/2 in. dia. x 1 in. high hardwood cleats, fastened to belt by 5/16 in. elevator bolts
spaced every 60 in. Can be supplied less cleats. Specify. TAKE-UP–Take-ups at tail pulley. Provides 4 in. of belt take-up.
BED–6 5/8 in. deep x 12 ga. powder painted, formed steel slider bed. Reinforced with 3/4 in. pipe GRAVITY BRACKETS–Adjustable bars with 1 in. dia. pop-out transfer roller to attach wheel or 1
which forms sockets for guard rails. Standard 6 ft., 8 ft., and 10 ft. long sections bolt together 3/8 in. dia. roller conveyor.
with splice plates.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings at tail pulley. Re-lube roller
UNDERTRUSSED BED–Undertrussing provided on beds from 20 ft. through 40 ft. long. Others bearings on drive pulley.
supported by either MS type floor supports or ceiling hangers. Unsupported bed joints are
reinforced by joint support angles. MOTOR–Energy efficient motor with brake. See chart.
DRIVE PULLEY–14 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. removable shaft for 20 in. wide bed; 1 1/4 in. dia. CAPACITY–See Load Capacity Chart.
removable shaft for 24 and 30 in. wide beds. Crowned and fully lagged.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearing, machine crowned.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes FLOOR SUPPORTS–Infeed end (MS type) heights other than standard available , specify elevation.
in feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-3 support. Discharge end (C-22) higher than standard to 48 in., specify elevation.
BELT–Black Polymate 120 Roughtop with PVC Cover, Brown Polymate Roughtop w/Nitrile cover. CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and
galvanized rods available.
BELT SPEED–Other constant speeds available, contact factory.
*NOTE: Capacity affected with speed change. REMOTE SWITCH CONTROL–Rod running length of conveyor to operate reverse drum switch from
both ends. Switch regularly furnished on left side, looking up with drive at top. Specify if required
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail. on other side.
LOWER POWERED FEEDER–Chain type driven from pulley of inclined conveyor. NOTE: Conveyor MOTORS–1 1/2 HP maximum.
tail pulley is used for belt take-up. When belt tension is adjusted, feeder will have to be moved
along with the take-up. NOTE: Capacity affected with this option. CONVEYING SPEED–Speeds other than 65 FPM will require gear box change (contact factory).
PULLEYS–6 in. dia. tail pulley with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearing. ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–One direction manual start switch, reverse drum switch, non-reversing
and reversible magnetic starters, push button stations. AC variable frequency drive.
CATALOG | 08312018
RB Horizontal Belt Conveyor
(Roller Bed)
The Model RB is designed to move heavier loads. Roller bed • 15 Belt Widths
design reduces belt friction and provides greater capacity. • Reversible
Applications include: assembly, inspection and packing • Moves Heavier Loads
operations. • Center Drive Conveyor shown with
• System Ends optional floor supports
• Pop-Out Roller
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
6" DIA. TAKE-UP PULLEY 1.9" DIA. 8" DIA. DRIVE PULLEY
TREAD ROLLER 4" OR 6" DIA. TAIL PULLEY
TAKE-UP
1.9" DIA.
2-1/8" DIA. SNUB IDLER RETURN IDLER
1.9" DIA.
PREFERRED
POP OUT ROLLER
FLOW
"X"
17-3/4"
10-3/4" OVERALL FRAME WIDTH
8"
BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH
3-1/8" 1-1/2"
21" 38-1/4" ALLOW
BELT WIDTH
62" 16" TREAD
(ALLOW 65” WITH V-BELT DRIVE)
"X"
ROLLER 3/8"
OPTIONAL
2-1/2" DIA. SNUB IDLER
MS SUPPORT
SHOWN
6-1/2"
CHANNEL
FRAME
2-1/8" DIA. SNUB IDLER/
SPACER
1.9" RETURN IDLER
TOTALLY ENCLOSED
CHAIN GUARD
SECTION “X-X”
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS RB
BELT–Ultimate 140 BBS–Nitrile.
RETURN IDLER–Adjustable 1.9 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings.
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube spaced every 6 in. Mounted in 6 1/2
in. x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame bolted together with splice plates. TAKE-UP–Take-ups in center drive provides 16 in. of belt take-up.
CROSS BRACING–Rods with turnbuckles are fastened to underside of bed to provide proper BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive and tail pulleys. Pre-
alignment of bed rollers and insure correct product tracking. Supplied to section adjoining drive lubricated ball bearings in tread rollers.
and every other section, 20 ft bed lengths and over. Supplied on bed lengths 9 ft and over.
SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive pulley.
CENTER DRIVE–Minimum elevation–17 3/4 in. Can be placed on any section of conveyor length.
Minimum OAL without modification 120 in. Chain guard located on left hand side. MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph.–60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 7/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, fully lagged. BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings or 6 in. dia. with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 225 lbs. NOT TO EXCEED capacity in charts.
bearings, machine crowned.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
SNUB IDLER–Adjustable 2 1/8 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings. Guards included.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, fixed channel, type A & B angle. Fixed
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. Channel overlapping, one direction. Fixed Channel nonoverlapping, reversing. See Accessory section.
BELT*–Black Trackmate 120 Highgrip Longitudinal Groove, White Polymate 100 RMP-COS (cover one ROLLER CENTERS*–Tread rollers spaced on 3 in., 9 in., or 12 in. centers.
side), Black Trackmate 533 COS-PVC, Tan Glidetop.
PULLEYS–6 in. dia. tail with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings in place of 4 in. when not furnished as
BELT SPEED*–Other constant and variable speeds. V-belt drive supplied on speeds under 17 FPM. standard.
END DRIVE–8 in. end drive mounted on end of unit. Requires underside take-up. POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
LOW ELEVATION SIDE MOUNTED CENTER DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor. CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
Minimum 16 in. rods available.
V-BELT DRIVE–V-Belt supplied between motor and reducer. Allow 65 in. MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brake motors, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing or reversible magnetic starter, and push-button stations.
regular lubrication). AC variable frequency drive.
UNDERSIDE TAKE-UP–Provides 16 in. of belt take-up. Extends down 15 7/8 in. from top of belt. * NOTE: Capacity affected with these options.
CATALOG | 0726019
RBI Floor-to-Floor Incline Conveyor
equipped with an adjustable double nose-over at the • Center Drive • Powered Feeder
discharge end to insure a smooth transfer from the incline to • Reversible • Ceiling Hangers Available
horizontal plane. Inclines are easily adjusted up to 30°. This • Brake Motor • Adjustable MS-Type Floor
conveyor can also be used as a booster conveyor in gravity Supports Available
• System Ends
flow systems. • Undertrussing (18”, 24”, &
• Double Nose-over
30”OAW From Stockyard Only)
SECTION X-X
OVERALL FRAME WIDTH
3-1/8" BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH 1-1/2" 1.9" DIA ROLLER 2-1/8" SNUB IDLER
TREAD
BELT WIDTH
2-1/2" NOSE OVER ROLLERS
ROLLER 9/16"
SLIDER PLATE
6-1/2" 40" 4" OR 6" DIA.
CHANNEL 26" TAIL PULLEY
2-1/8" SNUB ROLLER
12" 1.9" DIA
12" POP-OUT ROLLER
"A"
G TH
LEN
BED
30-1/2" TO 33-5/8"
L "L"
SPACER
2-1/8" DIA.
AL
GTH
COMBINED ADJUSTMENT
SNUB IDLER/
VER 2"
O LEN
TOP OF BELT
1.9" RETURN
IDLER
BED E BED 28" "
RIV -5/8
10'
D
3/4" 15
10-
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS RBI
BELT–High Grip Longitudinal Grooved. Clipper lacing. Clipper lacing.
TAKE-UP PULLEY–4 6 in. dia. with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned.
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube spaced every 6 in. Mounted in 6
1/2 in. x 12 ga. powder painted, formed steel channel frame. Standard 4 ft., 6 ft., 8 ft., and 10 ft. TAKE-UP–Take-ups in center drive provides 16 in. of belt take-up.
long sections bolt together with splice plates.
SNUB IDLER/NOSE-OVER ROLLERS–Adjustable 2 1/8 in. dia. or 2 1/2 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball
CROSS BRACING – Rods with turnbuckles are fastened to underside of bed to provide proper bearings. Snub guards included.
alignment of bed rollers and insure correct product tracking. Supplied to section adjoining drive
and every other section, 20 ft bed lengths and over. Supplied on bed lengths 9 ft and over. RETURN IDLER–Adjustable 1.9 in. dia., pre-lubricated ball bearings.
DOUBLE NOSE-OVER–A 26 in. long horizontal and a 12 in. long nose-over section provides a BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive, tail and take-up pulley.
two-step transition of product from incline to horizontal. Provides up to 30° incline adjustment.
SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive pulley.
LOWER POWERED FEEDER–Chain type driven from tail pulley of inclined conveyor. Supports
not included in base price. MOTOR–1 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face “SSB” Brake Motor (6 ft./
lb.).
CENTER DRIVE–Located on the incline section. Chain guard located on left hand side.
BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 7/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, fully lagged.
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 225 lbs. NOT TO EXCEED capacity in charts.
TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings or 6 in. dia. with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at
bearings, machine crowned. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify non-overlapping fixed channel (bi-directional).
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes ROLLER CENTERS–Tread rollers spaced on 3 in., 9 in., or 12 in. centers.
in feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-3 support.
PULLEYS–6 in. dia. tail pulley with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings in place of 4 in. when not
BELT–Black Trackmate 120 Roughtop with PVC Cover, Brown Polymate Roughtop w/Nitrile cover, furnished as standard.
Pure Gum Rubber Roughtop.
CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and
BELT SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds V-belt drive supplied on speeds under 20 FPM (1 galvanized rods available.
HP)–46 FPM ( 2 HP). *NOTE: Capacity affected with speed change.
UNDERTRUSSING–Available in place of ceiling hangers. Maximum bed length 40 ft. Maximum
V-BELT DRIVE–V-belt supplied between motor and reducer. Allow 65 in. overall width 30 in.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
regular lubrication).
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing and reversible magnetic starters and push button stations.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, overlapping fixed channel (one direction), AC variable frequency drive.
CATALOG | 07262019
RB Horizontal Belt Conveyor
(Roller Bed)
The Model RB is designed to move heavier loads. Roller bed • 15 Belt Widths
design reduces belt friction and provides greater capacity. • Reversible
Applications include: assembly, inspection and packing • Moves Heavier Loads
operations. • Center Drive Conveyor shown with
• System Ends optional floor supports
• Pop-Out Roller
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
6" DIA. TAKE-UP PULLEY 1.9" DIA. 8" DIA. DRIVE PULLEY
TREAD ROLLER 4" OR 6" DIA. TAIL PULLEY
TAKE-UP
1.9" DIA.
2-1/8" DIA. SNUB IDLER RETURN IDLER
1.9" DIA.
PREFERRED
POP OUT ROLLER
FLOW
"X"
17-3/4"
10-3/4" OVERALL FRAME WIDTH
8"
BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH
3-1/8" 1-1/2"
21" 38-1/4" ALLOW
BELT WIDTH
62" 16" TREAD
(ALLOW 65” WITH V-BELT DRIVE)
"X"
ROLLER 3/8"
OPTIONAL
2-1/2" DIA. SNUB IDLER
MS SUPPORT
SHOWN
6-1/2"
CHANNEL
FRAME
2-1/8" DIA. SNUB IDLER/
SPACER
1.9" RETURN IDLER
TOTALLY ENCLOSED
CHAIN GUARD
SECTION “X-X”
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS CRB
BELT–Black Trackmate 533 COS. Clipper lacing. RETURN IDLER–Adjustable–1.9 in. dia. Pre-lubricated ball bearings.
BED–Roller bed with 2 in. dia. x 12 ga. unplated tread rollers spaced every 6 in., or 12 in. mounted TAKE-UP–Screw take-ups at tail pulley. Provides 4 in. of belt take-up.
in 10 ga. painted formed steel channel frame with 12 ga. painted side guards extending 8 1/2” above
belt. Sections bolt together with splice plates. BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, cast-iron ball bearings on drive and tail pulley.
Sealed, pre-lubricated ball bearings in tread rollers.
END DRIVE–Located on discharge end of conveyor, chain guard on left hand side.
SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear “C” face speed reducer. No 50 roller chain to drive pulley.
BELT SCRAPER–Mounted in bed section to clean underside of return belt.
MOTOR–1 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph.–60 Hz.– Premium Energy Efficient C-Face.
DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings–machine crowned and fully lagged.
BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
TAIL PULLEY–6 in. dia. with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings–self-cleaning, crowned
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor–25 lbs. NOT TO EXCEED capacity in chart.
SNUB IDLER–Adjustable–2 1/8 in. dia. Pre-lubricated ball bearings.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
regular lubrication).
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
END CAP–A formed steel end cap is bolted to inside of conveyor at tail end to keep material from
NOTE: Drive end support non-adjustable up to 16 in. elevation.
falling off end of conveyor (not available with 7 in. extended guard rail.)
BELT SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. V-Belt drive supplied on speeds under 17 FPM.
CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
Note: Capacity affected with speed changes.
rods available.
CENTER DRIVE–Provides 16 in. of belt take-up. Minimum elevation 20 in. Specify location.
MOTORS–Single phase, brakemotor–other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
Minimum OAL 66 in.
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starters and push-button stations. AC variable
V-BELT DRIVE–V-belt supplied between motor and reducer.
frequency drive.
CATALOG | 08312018
25-RBM
The Model RBM is designed for merge applications. Roller
Horizontal Belt Conveyor
•
(Roller Bed)
12 Belt Widths
bed design reduces belt friction and provides greater • Reversible
capacity. • Moves Heavier Loads
• Center Drive
• System Ends Conveyor shown
with optional floor
• Pop-Out Roller
supports
• Adjustable MHS Type Floor Supports Available
OAW 22 24 26 28 30 34 36 40 42 48 54 60
OAL 3" R/C 791 837 884 930 977 1070 1117 1210 1257 1396 1536 1677
12'
6" R/C 791 837 884 930 977 1070 1117 1210 1257 1396 1536 1677
All weights in catalog are CONVEYOR WEIGHTS ONLY. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
6" DIA. TAKE-UP PULLEY 2.5" DIA. 8" DIA. DRIVE PULLEY
TREAD ROLLER 3 1/4" DIA. TAIL PULLEY
TAKE-UP
1.9" DIA.
2-1/8" DIA. SNUB IDLER RETURN IDLER
1.9" DIA.
PREFERRED
POP OUT ROLLER
FLOW
"X"
17-3/4"
10-3/4"
OVERALL FRAME WIDTH
8"
BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH
3-1/8" 1-1/2"
21" 38-1/4" ALLOW BELT WIDTH
62" 16" TREAD
(ALLOW 65” WITH V-BELT DRIVE)
ROLLER 3/8"
"X"
OPTIONAL
2-1/2" DIA. SNUB IDLER
MS SUPPORT
SHOWN
6-1/2"
CHANNEL
FRAME
2-1/8" DIA. SNUB IDLER/
SPACER
1.9" RETURN IDLER
TOTALLY ENCLOSED
CHAIN GUARD
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 25-RBM
BELT–Green 2-ply PVC cover with clipper lacing. RETURN IDLER–Adjustable 1.9 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings.
BED–Roller bed with 2.5 in. dia. roller x 11 ga. unplated tube spaced every 3 in. Mounted in 6 1/2 in. TAKE-UP–Take-ups in center drive provides 16 in. of belt take-up.
x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame bolted together with splice plates.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive and tail pulleys. Pre-
CROSS BRACING–Rods with turnbuckles are fastened to underside of bed to provide proper lubricated ball bearings in tread rollers.
alignment of bed rollers and insure tracking. (1) supplied in first 50' of bed section lengths and (1)
per 50' of bed section length thereafter. Supplied in approximate center of lengths. SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive pulley.
CENTER DRIVE–Minimum elevation–17 3/4 in. Can be placed on any section of conveyor length. MOTOR–1 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph.–60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
Minimum OAL without modification 120 in.
BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 7/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, fully lagged.
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 225 lbs. NOT TO EXCEED capacity in charts.
TAIL PULLEY–3 1/4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings .
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
SNUB IDLER–Adjustable 2 1/8 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings. Guards included.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MHS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes ROLLER CENTERS*–Tread rollers spaced on 6 in. centers.
in feet for lagging to floor.
PULLEYS–6 in. dia. tail with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings in place of 3 1/4 in. when not furnished
BELT*–Black ultimate 140 BBS, White Polymate 100 RMP-COS (cover one side), Black Trackmate 533 as standard.
COS-PVC, Tan Glidetop.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
BELT SPEED*–Other constant and variable speeds. V-belt drive supplied on speeds under 17 FPM.
CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
SHAFT MOUNTED CENTER DRIVE rods available.
V-BELT DRIVE–V-Belt supplied between motor and reducer. Allow 65 in. MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brake motors, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing or reversible magnetic starter, and push-button stations.
regular lubrication). AC variable frequency drive.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, fixed channel, type A & B angle. Fixed * NOTE: Capacity affected with these options.
Channel overlapping, one direction. Fixed Channel nonoverlapping, reversing. See Accessory section.
CATALOG | 08312018
SBC Slider Bed Curve
The Model SBC provides a positive flow of products by means • 9 Belt Widths
of a belt, driven by tapered pulleys. Conveyor is versatile in • Endless Splice Belt
that it can transport a wide variety of products. Available in • Quick Belt Change
45°, 60° and 90° turns. • Full Length Window
Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
All weights in catalog are CONVEYOR WEIGHTS ONLY. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
Left Hand Curve Right Hand Curve
Outside
Radius
Centerline
Radius
OAW
Standard Type A
90° Guard Rail
10 3/4
Optional Type B 8 7/8
Guard Rail
Conveying Surface Inside Radius
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
BELT–Endless splice PUR belt with guide profile.
BEARINGS–Sealed, self-aligning, ball bearings.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
BED–8 7/8" top of belt inside, outside guard 10 3/4", BELT–Types and styles other than standard
12 ga stainless steel slider bed. ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Not furnished as standard are avialable (contact factory).
equipment. See below. MOTOR–Other HP available 3 HP max.
SHAFT MOUNTED DRIVE–Nord right angle helical GUARD RAILS–3-1/2" - 12" tall available
bevel gearmotor BELT SPEED– 24 fpm to 235 fpm. POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36" to 120". heights
for all sizes.
in 6" increments knee braces supplied. Note:
PULLEYS–Tapered pulleys with 1 7/16" diameter shaft CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot (measured Clearance must be allowed for belt removal.
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–One direction
at bearings. Infeed pulley is adjustable to control belt at center line of conveying surface) 40 lbs. magnetic starters and push button stations.
tension. CEILING HANGERS–5/8" diameter x 8'
AC variable frequency drive.
GUARD RAILS–6.5” inside and outside supplied long unplated rods fully threaded. Other
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS type supports are available in standard. lengths and galvanized rods available. Note:
CUSTOM COLORS–Available (contact
a wide range of adjustments, holes in feet for lagging Clearance must be allowed for belt removal.
factory). Paint chip must be provided.
to floor knee braces recommended above MS-6 MOTOR–1 hp shaft mounted right angle gearmotor
supports. 208/230/460 – 3 PH 60 HZ (Specify Voltage).
CATALOG | 08312018
TS1500-140
The Model TS1500-140 provides a positive flow of products •
Transnorm Belt Curve Conveyor
20 Belt Widths
by means of a belt, driven by tapered pulleys. Conveyor is • Adjustable FSK-Type Floor Supports Available
versatile in that it can transport a wide variety of products. • Clipper Lacing
Available in 45°,60°, 90°, and 180° turns. Other degrees F.O.B. Arlington, Texas
available. Contact Transnorm.
"A" OAW
1-1/2" 4"
11" CONVEYING
SURFACE
" 9.45"
"CL" OR" TOP OF BELT
(CSW)
"A"
90˚
OW OW
FL FL
W
O
O
FL
FL
CONVEYING
SURFACE "IR"
WIDTH
TYPE A TYPE B TYPE C TYPE D
LEFT HAND CURVE RIGHT HAND CURVE LEFT HAND CURVE RIGHT HAND CURVE
OUTSIDE DRIVE OUTSIDE DRIVE INSIDE DRIVE INSIDE DRIVE
Applies to all degree of curves. All locations are standard for Transnorm. Specify location.
Conveying "CL" 45° 60° 90° 180°
OAW Belt
Surface "IR" Radius "OR" Weight Weight Weight Weight
Frame Width
16 1/2"
Width
11" 10" 34"
(CS)
39 1/2"
(Lbs.) (Lbs.) (Lbs.) (Lbs.)
361 386 411 552
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
18 1/2" 13" 12" 32" 38 1/2" 365 390 414 567 BELT–Black Rough Top (Inverted Pyramid) Self MOTOR– 3/4 HP Shaft Mounted Right Angle
20 1/2" 15" 14" 30" 37 1/2" 45" 365 390 415 572 Extinguishing Belt with Guide Strip Gearmotor 208/230/460/575V-3Ph. 60 Hz (Specify
Exact Voltage).
22 1/2" 17" 16" 28" 36 1/2" 367 392 417 577
FRAME–9.45 in. deep x 40 mm x 40 mm aluminum
24 1/2" 19" 18" 26" 35 1/2" 369 394 419 581 extrusion. BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM at center line of
26 1/2" 21" 20" 36" 46 1/2" 380 423 466 626 conveying surface.
28 1/2" 23" 22" 34" 45 1/2" 57" 388 438 487 DRIVE
659 OUTSIDE
PULLEYS–Tapered with 1 7/16 in. dia. shaft through
30 1/2" 25" 24" 32" 44 1/2" 390 440 490 665 DRIVE OUTSIDE
bearings. Adjustable to control belt tension. CAPACITY–Maximum load perOUTSIDE
DRIVE linear foot (measured
32 1/2" 27" 26" 54" 67 1/2" 426 520 591 868 at center line of conveying surface) 40 lbs.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball
34 1/2" 29" 28" 52" 66 1/2" 428 524 596 877 bearings on drive and tail pulley. Re-lube type. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional
36 1/2" 31" 30" 50" 65 1/2" 431 530 601 887 equipment. See chart below for available elevations.
81"
38 1/2" 33" 32" 48" 64 1/2" 434 533 606 896
40 1/2" 35" 34" 46" 63 1/2" 437 538
RIGHT
611
HAND
905
LEFT HAND RIGHT HAND LEFT HAND RIGHT HAND LEFT HAND
42 1/2" 37" 36" 44" 62 1/2" 439 542 616 90˚
913 CURVES • OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT 60˚ CURVES 45˚ CURVES
44 1/2" 39" 38" 66" 85 1/2" 481 621 706 1103 DRIVE OUTSIDE
46 1/2" 41" 40" 64" 84 1/2" 485 627 713 1116 FLOOR SUPPORTS–FSK Type floor supports are BELTS–Types and styles other than standard are
available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify available (contact factory).
48 1/2" 43" 42" 62" 83 1/2" 488 633 720 1129
105” top of belt elevation. Supports required at each end
50 1/2" 45" 44" 60" 82 1/2" 491 639 726 1141 and in the center of the conveyor. Holes in feet for CEILING HANGERS–Includes mouting brackets and
52 1/2" 47" 46" 58" 81 1/2" 494 644 732 1152 RIGHT
lagging to floor. KneeHAND
braces recommended aboveLEFT crossHAND
pipes only.
54 1/2" 49" 48" 56" 80 1/2" 497 649 738 1164 FSK-6 support. 180˚ CURVES
GUARD RAILS–3 in. to 24 in. tall available for all
BELT SPEED–Up to 250 FPM (shaft mounted), 251 - sizes. The outside guard rail is always supplied. The
For warranty/spare parts contact Transnorm 600 FPM (timing belt), inside guard rail is supplied unless no guard rail is
System’s customer service. Please provide NOTE: Capacity affected with speed change, see specified.
Transnorm’s serial number. chart above. Higher speeds available, contact
Transnorm System Inc. factory. ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic
2810 Avenue E East starters and push-button stations. AC variable
DRIVE LOCATION–Specify. frequency drive.
Arlington, TX 76011
Phone: 1-800-331-1749 X 249 MOTORS–Other HP available, 5 HP maximum CUSTOM COLORS–Available (contact factory).
Fax: (972) 606-0768 (contact factory). Paint chip must be provided.
CATALOG | 08312018
TS4100-150
The Model TS4100-150 uses a bilateral belt guide system •
Transnorm Mega Merge
4 Belt Widths
to ensure constant and precise belt tracking that allows a • Clipper Lacing
minimal length and maximum width merge area. Other widths • 40 lb/ft Load Capacity
and lengths available, Contact Transnorm. • Speeds up to 600 FPM
F.O.B. Arlington, Texas Conveyor shown with optional
Powered Belt Deflectors and
Support Structure.
BF
SG HEIGHT OAL
TOB
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
BELT–Black, Low Friction Clipper Laced on 10° Bias
BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM at center line of conveying surface.
FRAME–11.2” deep x 40mm x 80mm Aluminum Extrusion
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot (measured at center line of conveying surface) 40 lbs.
PULLEYS–1 7/16 in. dia. Shaft Through bearings. Adjustable to control belt tension.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Standard rectangular tubing style for up to 39” T.O.B. Other heights available
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive and tail pulley. Re-lube type. (Contact Factory)
MOTOR– 3/4 HP Shaft Mounted Right Angle Gearmotor 208/230/460/575V-3Ph. 60 Hz (Specify Exact
Voltage).
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
DRIVE LOCATION–Left or Right Hand, Discharge End only. GUARD RAILS–3 in. to 24 in. tall available for all sizes.
MOTORS–Other HP available, 7 1/2 HP maximum (contact factory). ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–AC variable frequency drives available
BELTS–Types and styles other than standard are available (contact factory). CUSTOM COLORS–Available (contact factory). Paint chip must be provided.
CATALOG | 08312018
25-RBM
The Model RBM is designed for merge applications. Roller
Horizontal Belt Conveyor
•
(Roller Bed)
12 Belt Widths
bed design reduces belt friction and provides greater • Reversible
capacity. • Moves Heavier Loads
• Center Drive
• System Ends Conveyor shown
with optional floor
• Pop-Out Roller
supports
• Adjustable MHS Type Floor Supports Available
OAW 22 24 26 28 30 34 36 40 42 48 54 60
OAL 3" R/C 791 837 884 930 977 1070 1117 1210 1257 1396 1536 1677
12'
6" R/C 791 837 884 930 977 1070 1117 1210 1257 1396 1536 1677
All weights in catalog are CONVEYOR WEIGHTS ONLY. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
6" DIA. TAKE-UP PULLEY 2.5" DIA. 8" DIA. DRIVE PULLEY
TREAD ROLLER 3 1/4" DIA. TAIL PULLEY
TAKE-UP
1.9" DIA.
2-1/8" DIA. SNUB IDLER RETURN IDLER
1.9" DIA.
PREFERRED
POP OUT ROLLER
FLOW
"X"
17-3/4"
10-3/4"
OVERALL FRAME WIDTH
8"
BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH
3-1/8" 1-1/2"
21" 38-1/4" ALLOW BELT WIDTH
62" 16" TREAD
(ALLOW 65” WITH V-BELT DRIVE)
ROLLER 3/8"
"X"
OPTIONAL
2-1/2" DIA. SNUB IDLER
MS SUPPORT
SHOWN
6-1/2"
CHANNEL
FRAME
2-1/8" DIA. SNUB IDLER/
SPACER
1.9" RETURN IDLER
TOTALLY ENCLOSED
CHAIN GUARD
CATALOG | 08312018
TW
The Model TW with wire belt can carry hot or cold parts from
Horizontal Wire Mesh Belt Conveyor
• 3 Belt Widths
ovens or freezers. Can be used in drying operations. • Wire Mesh Belt
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
SIZE TO Belt
Bed 12" 18" 24"
ORDER Width OVERALL LENGTH "A"
Length TAKE-UP
Overall Bed
"L" 16" 22" 28" 7" BED LENGTH "L" 6"
Length "A" Width
4" DIA.
6'-1" 5' 299 322 365 6" DIA. 1.9" DIA. "X" TAIL PULLEY
11'-1" 10' 368 415 465 DRIVE RETURN FLOW
SPROCKETS IDLER
16'-1" 15' 461 525 593
21'-1" 20' 530 608 693
26'-1" 25' 623 718 821 19-1/8" 11-1/8" 2-1/8" DIA.
31'-1" 30' 692 801 921 2" MAX. SNUB IDLER 2"
WEIGHTS
41'-1" 40' 854 994 1149
(Lbs.) 20-1/8" 13-1/16" OPTIONAL
51'-1" 50' 1023 1197 1391 MAX. MS SUPPORTS
33-3/16"
ALLOW "X"
61'-1" 60' 1185 1390 1609 16" SHOWN
71'-1" 70' 1355 1594 1862
81'-1" 80' 1517 1787 2090 1.9" DIA.
91'-1" 90' 1697 1979 2319
SECTION X-X BED WIDTH RETURN IDLER
4" OR
101'-1" 100' 1841 2172 2547 BELT WIDTH 2-1/8" DIA.
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. TREAD SNUB IDLER
Accessories, crating, etc., are not included. ROLLER
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
BELT–1/2 in. x 1 in. flat galvanized wire mesh belt. Maximum product temperature 350°F. RETURN IDLER–Adjustable 1.9 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings.
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube spaced every 6 in. Mounted in 6 5/8 in. x 12 TAKE-UP–Take-ups at tail pulley. Provides 4 in. of belt take-up.
ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame bolted together with splice plates.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning ball bearings on drive and tail shafts. Pre-lubricated ball
END DRIVE–Located on discharge end of conveyor, chain guard on left hand side. bearings in tread rollers.
CROSS BRACING–Rods with turnbuckles are fastened to underside of bed to provide proper alignment of bed SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive sprocket.
rollers and insure tracking. (1) supplied in first 50' of bed section lengths and (1) per 50' of bed section length
thereafter. Supplied in approximate center of lengths. MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
DRIVE SPROCKETS–6 in. pitch dia. multiple cast iron sprockets with BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
1 3/16 in. dia. shaft 6 in. centers.
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 75 lbs. NOT TO EXCEED capacity in chart.
TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings. Sprocket at each end.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
SNUB IDLER–Adjustable 2 1/8 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify top V-BELT DRIVE–V-belt supplied between motor and reducer.
of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in feet for
lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
regular lubrication).
BED–Slider bar in place of roller bed.
CEILING HANGARS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully
BELT–Other widths than standard, galvanized low carbon steel, bright high carbon steel or stainless steel. threaded. Other lengths and galvanized rods available.
1 in. or 1/2 in. x 1/2 in. mesh
available. Maximum product temperature 750°F with high carbon steel belt. MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 1 HP maximum.
BELT SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. V-belt drive supplied on speeds under 15 FPM and with ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starters and
variable speeds. Note: Capacity affected with speed change. push-button stations. AC variable frequency drive.
CATALOG | 08312018
SL Heavy Duty Horizontal Slat Conveyor
The Model SL Steel Belt Slat conveyor provides lasting, • 5 Bed Widths • Adjustable SLS-Type Floor
dependable performance. Can be used to convey hot, oily • Energy Efficient Motor with Supports Available
parts or items through heat drying processes. Can also be AC Variable Speed Controller
used for assembly line and production operations. • Rugged–all Steel Construction
• Modular Construction
• Roller Chain Reduces Friction
SIZE TO Slat
Bed 28" 31" 37" 43" 49"
ORDER Width
Length Overall
Overall 33" 36" 42" 48" 54"
"L" Bed Width
Length "A"
9' – 1692 1773 1936 2099 2262
14' 5' 2184 2291 2506 2721 2936
19' 10' 2677 2809 3076 3343 3610
24' 15' 3169 3327 3646 3965 4284
29' 20' WEIGHTS 3662 3845 4216 4587 4958
39' 30' (Lbs.) 4647 4881 5357 5831 6306
49' 40' 5632 5917 6497 7075 7654
59' 50' 6617 6954 7638 8319 9003
69' 60' 7602 7990 8778 9563 10351
79' 70' 8587 9026 9918 10807 11669
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only.
Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
25"
MINIMUM TAIL
ELEVATION SPROCKET
"X"
"Y" SLAT RETURN ACCESS PANEL
OPTIONAL SLS
SUPPORT SHOWN
OVERALL
BED WIDTH 3-7/16" OVERALL BED WIDTH 15-7/8"
2-1/2" 2-1/4" CHAIN
SLAT WIDTH STEEL GUARD
SLAT 1-1/4"
1/4" 1-1/2"
BUTT GEAR
COUPLING REDUCER
STEEL
17" SLAT
2" DIA.
ROLLER
BED CHAIN
SPACER RETURN
SECTION Y-Y
SECTION X-X
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS SL
END DRIVE–Located at discharge end of conveyor. Chain guard located on left hand side. SPEED REDUCTION–Heavy-duty sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 100 roller chain to
drive sprocket.
SLATS–Formed steel slat, 5 3/4 in. x 1 1/2 in. x 7 ga. channel.
MOTOR–2 HP–230/460V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Energy Efficient C-Face and AC variable speed controller
CHAIN–6 in. pitch bushed roller steel chain with 2 in. dia. high capacity roller bearing. with soft start capability and motor overload protection.
BED–17 in. deep x 10 ga. formed steel channel powder painted. Standard 5 ft. and 10 ft. long CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 30 FPM.
sections bolt together with butt couplings.
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 1400 lbs. NOT TO EXCEED capacity in chart.
DRIVE SPROCKETS–12 in. pitch dia. with 2 15/16 in. dia. shaft.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
TAKE-UP–Take-ups provided at tail sprockets. Provides 15 1/2 in. of chain take-up.
Detail shows inside view of roller chain which carries steel slats. Chain rides on steel
angle mounted to conveyor side of channel.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–SLS and SLSD Type fixed floor supports are available. Specify top of slat elevation. CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds available. Note: Capacity affected with
One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in feet for lagging to floor. speed change. Contact Factory.
MECHANICAL SHEAR PIN HUBS - Required if MD65 Controller is not used. ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Push-button stations.
CATALOG | 08312018
HSS Parcel Belt Conveyor
Designed for the parcel handling industry, for singulated flow
application.
• 8-5/8" Drive Pulley • 19" Take-Up Length
• Bolted Construction • 110' Maxium Overall
• 4" Tail Roller Conveyor Length
• 3-15 HP available • 250 - 600 FPM
Bed Width
MODELS
OR PART, UTILIZED IN ANY OTHER WORK, OR STANDARD TOLERANCES
1 NEW DRAWING USED FOR MANUFACTURE OF DESIGNS UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED DRAWN BY engautomation DATE 3/16/2018
FRACTIONS ±1/64
REV DATE New Revision Note TYPE ENGINEER WITHOUT THE PRIOR WRITTEN PERMISSION DECIMALS ±.005 Department MC DATE
ANGLES ±1°
OF HYTROL CONVEYOR COMPANY INC.
REVISION HISTORY PAINT CLASS P SPARE PART N REVISION 1
8 5/8” Diameter
Drive Pulley
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS HSS
BELT– Belting available per customer specification. TAIL PULLEY–4" diameter ROL-07S
BED–3 1/2" deep 10 ga. or 12 ga. formed steel slider bed painted per customer specified color. DRIVE BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, cast-iron ball bearing.
DRIVE PULLEY–8 5/8" diameter lagged pulley with through shaft design. BELT SPEED–Available from 250 to 540 FPM.
TAKE-UP ROLLER–4" diameter ROL-07S CAPACITY–100 lbs. per linear foot. Do not exceed capacity in chart below.
HP Selection Chart
LENGTH
15' 25' 50' 75' 110'
250 2 3 3 5 5
SPEED (FPM)
300 2 3 3 5 7.5
350 2 5 5 5 7.5
450 3 3 5 7.5 10
540 3 3 5 7.5 15
Note: HP calculations based on 6000 PPH. For higher rate, contact factory.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify top of belt elevation.
One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in feet for lagging to floor.
Knee bracing not included.
CABLE RAIL ASSEMBLY–For mounting cable
BELT–Option per customer specifics.
MOTORS–2, 3, 5, 7 1/2, 10, and 15 available.
UNDERSIDE BED COVERS–Hinged expanded metal per customer specifics.
SIDE GUARDS/PAN–Available in 2" to 36" high (2" increments)
NOSEOVER–Single noseover for transition from angled to horizontal position.
SLAVE TAKE-UP–Available in all widths, for scanning applications.
TAIL ROLLER–4" diameter ROL-07SX (Spherical Roller Bearings)
CATALOG | 08312018
HSS-HD Parcel Belt Conveyor
Designed for the parcel handling industry for semibulk
application.
• 8-5/8" Drive Pulley • 150' Maxium Overall
• Bolted Construction Conveyor Length
• 4" Solid Shaft Pulley • 50 - 600 FPM
• 3-20 HP available • Spherical Roller Bearings
• 13" Take-Up Length
THIS DRAWING CONTAINS CONFIDENTIAL C HYTROL
DWG NO
Bed Width
MODELS
OR PART, UTILIZED IN ANY OTHER WORK, OR STANDARD TOLERANCES
1 NEW DRAWING USED FOR MANUFACTURE OF DESIGNS UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED DRAWN BY engautomation DATE 3/16/2018
FRACTIONS ±1/64
REV DATE New Revision Note TYPE ENGINEER WITHOUT THE PRIOR WRITTEN PERMISSION DECIMALS ±.005 Department MC DATE
ANGLES ±1°
OF HYTROL CONVEYOR COMPANY INC.
REVISION HISTORY PAINT CLASS P SPARE PART N REVISION 1
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS HSS-HD
BELT– Belting available per customer specification. TAIL PULLEY–4" diameter solid shaft
BED–3 1/2" deep 10 ga. or 12 ga. formed steel slider bed painted per customer specified color. DRIVE BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, cast-iron spherical roller bearing.
DRIVE PULLEY–8 5/8" diameter lagged pulley with through shaft design. BELT SPEED–Available from 80 to 540 FPM.
TAKE-UP PULLEY–6" diameter CAPACITY–150 lbs. per linear foot. Do not exceed capacity in chart below.
HP Selection Chart
LENGTH
15' 25' 50' 75' 100' 125' 150'
55 3 3 5 5 7.5 10 10
75 3 3 5 5 7.5 10 10
100 3 3 5 7.5 7.5 10 15
SPEED (FPM)
125 3 3 5 7.5 10 10 15
150 3 3 5 7.5 10 15 15
250 3 3 7.5 10 15 15 20
350 3 5 7.5 10 15 20 20
450 3 5 10 15 20 20 NA
540 3 5 10 15 20 NA NA
Note: HP calculations based on 6000 PPH. For higher rate, contact factory.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify top of belt elevation.
One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in feet for lagging to floor.
CABLE RAIL ASSEMBLY–For mounting cable
Knee bracing not included.
MOTORS–3, 5, 7 1/2, 10, and 15 available.
BELT–Option per customer specifics.
SIDE GUARDS/PAN–Available in 2" to 36" high (2" increments)
UNDERSIDE BED COVERS–Hinged expanded metal per customer specifics.
HITCH ASSEMBLY– 2° to 20° (1° increments)
NOSEOVER–Single noseover for transition from angled to horizontal position.
CATALOG | 08312018
BPC Parcel Belt Conveyor
Designed for Parcel Bulk handling applications. • End and Center Drive Options
• Heavy Duty Bolted Construction
• Spherical Roller Bearings
• Available in Bed Widths from 19" to 61.5"
• Speeds up to 550 fpm based on application Conveyor shown with
• Adjustable Floor Supports floor supports and
less belt.
UNIT WIDTH
THE PROPERTY OF HYTROL CONVEYOR HYTROL
CONVEYOR CO., INC.
COMPANY INC. THIS DRAWING AND THE
JONESBORO, ARKANSAS
INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN MAY NOT
37" 43" 49" 61.5" Weights include 12" high side guard
ANGLES ±1°
OF HYTROL CONVEYOR COMPANY INC.
REVISION HISTORY REVISION 1
DRI-12 SHAFT MOUNTED 2141 2488 2835 3558 Accessories, supports, crating, etc are not included in above weights
Does not include weight of gearmotor
DRI-112 TIMING BELT 2601 3023 3445 4323 Available carry and return rollers not included in above weights
DRI-43 SHAFT MOUNTED 1623 1887 2150 2698
DRI-34 SHAFT MOUNTED 1338 1555 1772 2224
DRI-134 TIMING BELT 1538 1755 1972 2424
DRI-196 TIMING BELT 1661 1930 2200 2761
INTERMEDIATE BED (12 GA) 246 279 312 380
INTERMEDIATE BED (10 GA) 317 360 403 491
INTERMEDIATE BED (7 GA) 388 441 494 602
TAI-10 (110) 335 379 423 514
TAI-02 (102) 423 470 516 624
HITCH ASSEMBLY 1050 1220 1390 1745
NOSE-OVER ASSEMBLY 264 307 350 439
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
BELT– Provided per customer specs
BELT SPEED– Available from 80 to 550 FPM
BED– 7, 10 or 12 ga. formed steel bed painted per customer specific color
DRIVE CAPCITY– Up to 100 lbs. per linear foot (based on drive selection)
BEARINGS– Sealed, pre-lubricated, self aligning, cast-iron sherical roller or ball bearings.
GUARDING– Customer specifications available per order
MOTOR– Available from 3 to 15 HP
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
UNDERSIDE BED COVERS– Hinged expanded metal.
CABLE RAIL ASSEMBLY– For mounting customer supplied cable.
SINGLE NOSEOVER– Angles from 0 to 20 degrees (NOS-01).
SIDE GUARDS–Available in 2" to 36" high (2" increments) (Overlapping or Non-overlapping)
HITCH–For transition from horizontal to incline only.
T-4 Slides–Available per application
CATALOG | 01232019
BPC
DRI-12 (16" Diameter Drive Pulley) DRI-196 (12" Diameter Drive Pulley)
54 78
28
30 5/16
72
48
DRI-43 (8 5/8" Diameter Drive Pulley) DRI-134 (8 5/8" Diameter Drive Pulley)
84 54
10 5/8
78
28
48
DRI-112 (16" Diameter Drive Pulley) DRI-34 (8 5/8" Diameter Drive Pulley)
90 48”
20”
30 5/16
42”
84
CATALOG | 01232019
A Aluminum Portable Narrow Belt Conveyor
The Model A, with its high grip belt, easily moves boxes, • Aluminum Bed
cases, and cartons up inclines. Its narrow width allows it to • High Grip Belt
be used in a stairway for floor-to-floor conveying. It can be • Electrical Controls
propped on a shelf for stacking or order picking. The Model • Reversible
A can be stored on its end in a minimum amount of space.
1.7" DIA.
SNUB IDLER OVERALL LENGTH "A" 1.7" DIA. 12"
SNUB IDLER
"B" 4' 2-3/4"
"X" 8-3/4" DRUM SWITCH "Y" 10"
4-1/2" 8-3/4"
14"
"X" "Y" 4"
4" TAIL .080
PULLEY 1.9" DIA. 5-1/4" ALUMINUM
RETURN IDLER 18" 24"
SECTION X-X
"E"
L.H. 15" MAX.
R.H.
SIDE SIDE
ANGLE "A"
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS A
BELT–10 in. wide Black Trackmate 120 High Grip Longitudinal Groove with PVC cover. Clipper
lacing.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated ball bearings on drive and tail pulleys.
BED–12 in. wide x .080 aluminum, 6061-T6 heat treated, reinforced.
SPEED REDUCTION–4-step jackshaft V-belt and No. 40 roller chain.
DRIVE PULLEY–6 in. dia. with 3/4 in. dia. shaft at bearings. Machine crowned and fully lagged.
MOTOR–1/2 HP–115/230V–1 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed. Wired for 115 volt.
TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned.
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Reversing drum switch with power cord and plug mounted on side
SNUB IDLER–Adjustable 1.7 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings. shown on drawing. Specify if other side desired.
RETURN IDLER–Adjustable 1.9 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings. BELT SPEED–Constant 83 FPM.
TAKE-UP–Take-ups provided at tail pulley. Provides 3 1/2 in. of belt take-up. CAPACITY–200 lbs. total distributed load, 120 lbs. unit load at 65 FPM.
REMOTE SWITCH PERMANENT FLOOR STANDS LOWER OR UPPER STAND WITH RUBBER
CONTROL ROD GRAVITY FEEDER WHEELS AND LOCKS
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
CLEATED BELT–Two 1 1/2 in. dia. x 1/2 in. high cleats, fastened to belt by 5/16 in. elevator bolts spaced
every 60 in. Requires gear reducer drive and spooled idlers. LOWER POWERED FEEDER–Chain type driven from drive pulley. 2 ft. 6 in. long belt feeder section
includes adjustable tubular support and gravity conveyor bracket.
BELT SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. Requires gear reducer drive. NOTE: Capacity
affected with speed change. GUARD RAILS–Channel type, adjustable vertically and horizontally.
RUBBER WHEELS–Two 6 in. dia. x 2 in. wide with 5/8 in. dia. shaft. STAIRWAY WALL BRACKETS–Hinged brackets bolt to bed section and wall. Adjustable leg to rest
on floor or step. Hook to hold conveyor close to wall when not in use.
STAND WITH RUBBER WHEELS–6 in. dia. x 2 in. wide wheels (with locks) mounted on adjustable
tubular stand, 17 in. to 36 in. top of belt. TROUGHING ATTACHMENT–Flat steel supports under belt form trough for handling loose
material. Hopper available.
UNDERCARRIAGE–25 in. wide tubular steel frame with hydraulic adjustment mounted on support
with 4 in. dia. steel swivel casters. See drawing and adjustment chart. Not available on 16 ft., 18 ft. STAINLESS STEEL BED COVER–18 ga. stainless steel skin (for ice house application).
& 20 ft. units.
SELF-CLEANING DRIVE & TAIL PULLEYS–Crowned and ribbed to prevent clogging under belt.
ROLLER CARRIAGE–25 in. wide tubular steel support with 4 in. dia. steel swivel casters. See
drawing and adjustment chart. Not available on 16 ft., 18 ft. & 20 ft. units. GEAR REDUCER DRIVE–Sealed worm gear speed reducer driven by motor with V-belt. Drive is
bolted to bottom of bed. Standard motor support and guard not available. Affects mounting of
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Adjustable steel channel with knee braces. MSAT on tail RSAD on drive. other options. Consult factory.
GRAVITY CONVEYOR BRACKET–1/2 in. dia. rod for connecting wheel or roller conveyor. REMOTE SWITCH CONTROL–Rod running length of conveyor to operate reverse drum switch from
both ends. Switch regularly furnished on side shown on drawing. Specify if required on other side.
LOWER GRAVITY FEEDER–2 ft. long x 12 in. wide (1 1/2SW-12-24) includes adjustable tubular
support and gravity conveyor bracket. MOTORS–1/2 HP maximum.
UPPER GRAVITY FEEDER–2 ft. long x 12 in. wide (3SW-12-16) includes adjustable tubular
support and gravity conveyor bracket.
CATALOG | 08312018
R Aluminum Portable Folding Belt Conveyor
The Model R, besides being extremely convenient (it can be • Folding Aluminum Bed
folded in half), is also extremely versatile. For example, its • High Grip Belt
conveying uses include: truck, loft or freight car, floor-to-floor, • Electrical Controls
stairway, as well as its use as a portable booster with a wheel • Reversible
or roller conveyor. It is also suitable for bag handling, bag
and carton stacking, and moving cartons, cases, and boxes.
RETURN IDLER–Adjustable 1.9 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings. BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
TAKE-UP–Take-ups provided at tail pulley. Provides 4 in. of belt take-up. CAPACITY–300 lbs. total distributed load, 150 lbs. unit load at 65 FPM.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
CLEATED BELT–Two 1 1/2 in. dia. x 1 in. high hardwood cleats, fastened to belt with 5/16 in. elevator
bolts spaced every 60 in. Requires gear reducer drive and spooled idlers. LOWER POWERED FEEDER–Chain type driven from drive pulley. 2 ft. 6 in. long belt feeder section
includes adjustable tubular support and gravity conveyor bracket.
BELT SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. Requires gear reducer drive. NOTE: Capacity
affected with speed change. GUARD RAILS–Channel type, adjustable vertically and horizontally.
RUBBER WHEELS–Two 6 in. dia. x 2 in. wide with 5/8 in. dia. shaft. STAIRWAY WALL BRACKETS–Hinged brackets bolt to bed section and wall. Adjustable leg to rest on
floor or step. Hook to hold conveyor close to wall when not in use.
STAND WITH RUBBER WHEELS–6 in. dia. x 2 in. wide wheels (with locks) mounted on adjustable
tubular stand, 17 in. to 36 in. top of belt. TROUGHING ATTACHMENT–Flat steel supports under belt form trough for handling loose material.
Hopper available. Not foldable with troughing attachment.
UNDERCARRIAGE–25 in. wide tubular steel frame with hydraulic adjustment mounted on support
with 4 in. dia. steel swivel casters. See drawing and adjustment chart. Not available on 19 ft. & 21 STAINLESS STEEL BED COVER–18 ga. stainless steel skin (for ice house application).
ft.
SELF-CLEANING DRIVE & TAIL PULLEYS–Crowned and ribbed to prevent clogging under belt.
ROLLER CARRIAGE–25 in. wide tubular steel support with 4 in. dia. steel swivel casters. See
drawing and adjustment chart. GEAR REDUCER DRIVE–Sealed worm gear speed reducer driven by motor with V-belt. Drive is
bolted to bottom of bed. (Standard motor support and guard not available.) Affects mounting of
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Adjustable steel channel with knee braces. RSR type. other options. Consult factory.
GRAVITY CONVEYOR BRACKET–1/2 in. dia. rod for connecting wheel or roller conveyor. REMOTE SWITCH CONTROL–Rod running length of conveyor to operate reverse drum switch from
both ends. Switch regularly furnished on side shown on drawing. Specify if required on other side.
LOWER GRAVITY FEEDER–2 ft. long x 18 in. wide (1 1/2 SW-18-36) includes adjustable tubular
support and gravity conveyor bracket. MOTORS–1 HP maximum.
UPPER GRAVITY FEEDER–2 ft. long x 18 in. wide (3 SW-18-18) includes adjustable tubular support
and gravity conveyor bracket.
CATALOG | 08312018
B Portable Folding Cleated Conveyor
Ideal for stacking, loading, and unloading. Cleats permit use • Folding Bed
at steeper inclines up to 45°. Complete with portable base. • High Grip Belt with Hardwood Cleats
• Rugged Steel Frame
• Self-powered Raising Device
• Reversible
CORNER
GUARD
45˚
/2"
5-1 NIP POINT GUARD
4" DIA. TAIL PULLEY
CASTER "B"
"X" TAKE-UP
"C"
SWITCH "X"
SPOOLED
IDLER "H" 28"
30˚
32"
14" DIA.
DRIVE PULLEY
2'-0"
17-3/4" MINIMUM
FLOOR
"B" LENGTH WHEN FOLDED "E"
"L" 20" BED WIDTH HARDWOOD
CLEATS
14"
BELT WIDTH
4"
SECTION X-X
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS B
BELT–14 in. wide Black Trackmate 120 High Grip Longitudinal Groove with PVC cover. Clipper
lacing. TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings, crowned.
CLEATS–Two 1 1/2 in. dia. x 1 in. high hardwood cleats, fastened to belt with 5/16 in. elevator bolts RETURN IDLER–4 in. dia. spooled idler to provide clearance for cleats. Pre-lubricated ball
spaced every 60 in. bearings.
BED–4 in. deep x 20 in. wide x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel slider bed. Bed is hinged for TAKE-UP–Take-ups provided at tail pulley. Provides 4 in. of belt take-up.
storage purposes (see drawing).
BEARINGS– Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on tail pulley. Re-lube roller
HINGES–To fold bed to shorter length for storage. Screw adjustment insures alignment of bed. bearings on drive pulley.
Exclusive link (breathing feature) prevents damage of belt.
SPEED REDUCTION –Sealed worm gear speed reducer driven by V-belt. No. 50 roller chain to
INCLINE–Adjustable with conveyor motor powered screw raising device (see chart for angles). drive pulley.
Safety nut prevents rapid release of bed in case of overloading.
MOTOR– 1 HP -115/230V-1 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed. Wired for 115 volt.
BASE–Welded steel base (see drawing for dimensions).
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS –Reversing drum switch with 20 ft. power cord and plug.
CASTERS–6 in. dia. steel swivel casters with breaks. Corner guards.
BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
DRIVE PULLEY–14 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. removable shaft. Crowned and fully lagged.
CAPACITY–300 lbs. total distributed load, 150 lbs. unit load at 65 FPM.
LOWER POWERED FEEDER TROUGHING ATTACHMENT WITH HOPPER SELF-POWERED RAISING DEVICE
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
RUBBER CASTERS–4 in. dia. rubber swivel casters with breaks in place of steel casters.
GUARD RAILS–Channel type, adjustable vertically (specify fixed horizontal width). Not foldable
FLOOR LOCKS–Two foot operated toggle floor locks mounted on one side of conveyor base to prevent with guard rails.
unit from moving when in operation.
TROUGHING ATTACHMENT–Flat steel supports under belt form trough for handling loose material.
GRAVITY CONVEYOR BRACKET–Adjustable bar for connecting wheel or roller gravity conveyor Hopper available. Not foldable with troughing attachment.
(discharge only).
REMOTE SWITCH CONTROL–Rod running length of conveyor to operate reverse drum switch from
LOWER GRAVITY FEEDER–2 ft. long x 18 in. wide (1 1/2 SW-18-36) includes adjustable tubular both ends. Switch regularly furnished on right side (when standing at drive pulley and looking up
support and gravity conveyor bracket. toward tail pulley).
UPPER GRAVITY FEEDER–2 ft. long x 18 in. wide (3 SW-18-18) includes adjustable tubular support MOTORS–2 HP 230/1/60.
and gravity conveyor bracket.
LOWER POWERED FEEDER–Chain type driven from drive pulley. 43 in. long belt feeder section
includes adjustable tubular support and gravity conveyor bracket.
CATALOG | 08312018
BL Portable Folding Booster Belt Conveyor
The longer Model BL can be used to convey material from • Reversible
one floor to another. . .or to a balcony area. Its long bed can • Bed Section Folds
also extend far into a truck, thereby minimizing the distance • 14” Wide High Grip Belt
for loading or unloading the conveyor. • Self-powered Raising Device
45˚
5-1/2" NIP POINT GUARD
FOLDED LENGTH 14'-6" 4" DIA. TAIL PULLEY
A" GUARD
TH " "B" "X" TAKE-UP
G
EN
LLL "X"
SWITCH A
ER
OV
"H"
1'-0" 10' - 7"
14" DIA. 13˚ 5'-3"
DRIVE PULLEY SPOOLED IDLER
MINIMUM
16-3/4" FLOOR
10'-7" "E" 34"
MAX.
"L"
4"
SECTION X-X
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS BL
BELT–14 in. wide Black Trackmate 120 High Grip Longitudinal Groove with PVC cover. Clipper TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned.
lacing.
RETURN IDLER–4 in. dia. spooled idler to provide clearance for cleats. Pre-lubricated ball
CLEATS–Two 1 1/2 in. dia. x 1 in. high hardwood cleats, fastened to belt with 5/16 in. elevator bolts bearings.
spaced every 60 in.
TAKE-UP–Take-ups provided at tail pulley. Provides 4 in. of belt take-up.
BED–4 in. deep x 20 in. wide x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel slider bed. Bed is hinged for
storage purposes (see drawing). BEARINGS– Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on tail pulley. Re-lube roller
bearings on drive pulley.
HINGES–To fold bed to shorter length for storage. Screw adjustment insures alignment of bed.
Exclusive link (breathing feature) prevents damage of belt. SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear speed reducer driven by V-belt. No. 50 roller chain to
drive pulley.
INCLINE–Adjustable from 13° to 45° with conveyor motor powered screw raising device. Safety
nut prevents rapid release of bed in case of overloading. MOTOR–1 HP–115/230V–1 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed. Wired for 115 volt.
BASE–Welded steel base (see drawing for dimensions). ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Reversing drum switch with 20 ft. power cord and plug.
CASTERS–6 in. dia. steel swivel casters with Breaks. Corner guards. BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
DRIVE PULLEY–14 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. removable shaft. Crowned and fully lagged. CAPACITY–300 lbs. total distributed load, 150 lbs. unit load at 65 FPM.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
RUBBER CASTERS–6 in. dia. rubber swivel casters with Breaks in place of steel casters. LOWER POWERED FEEDER–Chain type driven from drive pulley. 43 in. long belt feeder section
includes adjustable tubular support and gravity conveyor bracket.
FLOOR LOCKS–Two foot operated toggle floor locks mounted on one side of conveyor base to prevent
unit from moving when in operation. GUARD RAILS–Channel type, adjustable vertically (specify fixed horizontal width). Not foldable
with guard rails.
GRAVITY CONVEYOR BRACKET–Adjustable bar for connecting wheel or roller gravity conveyor
(discharge only). TROUGHING ATTACHMENT–Flat steel supports under belt form trough for handling loose material.
Hopper available. Not foldable with troughing attachment.
LOWER GRAVITY FEEDER–2 ft. long x 18 in. wide (1 1/2 SW-18-36) includes adjustable tubular
support and gravity conveyor bracket. REMOTE SWITCH CONTROL–Rod running length of conveyor to operate reverse drum switch from
both ends. Switch regularly furnished on right side (when standing at drive pulley and looking up
UPPER GRAVITY FEEDER–2 ft. long x 18 in. wide (3 SW-18-18) includes adjustable tubular support toward tail pulley).
and gravity conveyor bracket.
MOTORS–2 HP 230/1/60.
CATALOG | 08312018
BA Portable Folding Booster Belt Conveyor
One lever control adjusts angle without effort. Desired angle • 6 Lengths
automatically locked by powered screw. • 14” Wide High Grip Belt
• Reversible
• Bed Section Folds
• Adjustable Infeed Height
"B"
BED–4 in. deep x 20 in. wide x 12 ga. formed steel slider bed, powder painted. Bed is hinged for RETURN IDLER–Adjustable 1.9 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings.
storage purposes (see drawing).
TAKE-UP–Take-ups provided at tail pulley. Provides 4 in. of belt take-up.
HINGES–To fold bed to shorter length for storage. Screw adjustment insures alignment of bed.
Exclusive link (breathing feature) prevents damage of belt. BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, cast-iron ball bearings on tail pulley. Re-lube
roller bearings on drive pulley.
INCLINE–Adjustable with conveyor motor powered screw raising device (see chart for angles).
Safety nut prevents rapid release of bed in case of overloading. SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear speed reducer driven by V-belt. No. 50 roller chain to
drive pulley.
INFEED HEIGHT–Adjustable with variable position support.
MOTOR– 1 HP (10 ft. to 22 ft.)–115/230V–1 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed. Wired for 115 volt.
BASE–Welded steel base (see drawing for dimensions).
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Reversing drum switch with 20 ft. power cord and plug.
CASTERS–6 in. dia. steel swivel casters with 2 Breaks. Corner guards.
BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. removable shaft. Machine crowned and fully lagged.
CAPACITY–300 lbs. total distributed load, 150 lbs. unit load at 65 FPM.
TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
RUBBER CASTERS–6 in. dia. rubber swivel casters with breaks in place of steel casters.
GUARD RAILS–Channel type, adjustable vertically (specify fixed horizontal width). Not foldable
FLOOR LOCKS–Two foot operated toggle floor locks mounted on one side of conveyor base to prevent with guard rails.
unit from moving when in operation.
TROUGHING ATTACHMENT–Flat steel supports under belt form trough for handling loose material.
GRAVITY CONVEYOR BRACKET–Adjustable bar for connecting wheel or roller gravity conveyor. Hopper available. Not foldable with troughing attachment.
LOWER GRAVITY FEEDER–2 ft. long x 18 in. wide (1 1/2 SW-18-36) includes adjustable tubular REMOTE SWITCH CONTROL–Rod running length of conveyor to operate reverse drum switch from
support and gravity conveyor bracket. both ends. Switch regularly furnished on right side (when standing at drive pulley and looking up
toward tail pulley).
UPPER GRAVITY FEEDER–2 ft. long x 18 in. wide (3 SW-18-18) includes adjustable tubular support
and gravity conveyor bracket. MOTORS–2 HP 230/1/60.
LOWER POWERED FEEDER–Chain type driven from drive pulley. 43 in. long belt feeder section
includes adjustable tubular support and gravity conveyor bracket.
CATALOG | 08312018
PC Portable Parts Conveyor
The Model PC can be used as a portable or permanent parts • 8 Belt Widths
conveyor. Side guards and cleated belt easily catch small • Tough Cleated Belt
stampings, plastic parts, etc., and carry them to hoppers or • Portable or Permanent
drums. Flapper guard prevents parts from falling through • Overhead Drive
conveyor.
• Formed Edge Guard Rails
SIZE TO ORDER Belt Width 4" 6" 8" 10" 12" 16" 18" 24"
Overall Length "A" Bed Width 8" 10" 12" 14" 16" 20" 22" 28"
5' 348 377 420 434 477 530 583 635
7' 379 408 451 467 508 563 620 675
Weights
9' 410 440 482 501 539 596 657 714
(Lbs.)
11' 441 472 513 534 570 629 694 753
13' 472 504 544 568 601 662 731 792
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only.
Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
19"
"
"
11
10"
"A
X. "
"L TH
MA 5/16
TH NG
BED WIDTH
-
12
E
BELT
AL LE LL L
"
BELT WIDTH
BE VER
LO NG
DRIVE PULLEY
O
D
16 W
3-1/2"
*"E"
"
BELT RETURN
NIP POINT GUARD "X"
A DJ SECTION X-X
US
TA 4" DIA.
BL
"C" E WHEEL
CATALOG | 04022018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS PC
BELT–2- ply black Nitrile with 1 1/2 in. high molded cleats on 12 in. centers. Clipper lacing. BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive and tail pulleys.
BED–6 5/8 in. deep x 12 ga powder painted formed steel slider bed. 3 1/2 in. high vertical sides with SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear “C” face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive pulley.
square edge guard rail. Standard sections are 4 ft., 6 ft., 8 ft., 10 ft., and 12 ft. long. Longer bed
sections are bolted together with splice plates and joint support angles. MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
PORTABLE BASE SUPPORT–Tubular steel support mounted on 4 in. dia. steel wheels. Adjustable BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
to control conveyor height at top and bottom. Adjustment height can be locked in place with
lever. NOTE: Not available on units longer than 13 ft. CAPACITY–300 lbs. total distributed load at 65 FPM.
OVERHEAD END DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted 9 1/2 in. above belt (chain guard RH side).
DRIVE PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned and fully lagged.
BELT RETURN–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned.
FEEDER SHOWN WITH STANDARD PC TYPE GUARD RAIL, GRAVITY BRACKET WITH
POP-OUT ROLLER AND OPTIONAL MS TYPE FLOOR SUPPORTS
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify V-BELT DRIVE–V-belt supplied between motor and reducer. Minimum overall drive width 14 in.
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-3 support. O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
regular lubrication).
BELT–1/2 in. x 1 in. galvanized flat wire mesh belt with 1 1/4 in. high steel angle cleats, spaced every 12
in. Galvanized low carbon steel or stainless steel. 1 in. x 1 in. or 1/2 in. x 1/2 in. mesh available. HIGHER SIDE GUARDS–6 in., 9 in., or 12 in. high vertical sides in place of standard 3 1/2 in. high.
NOTE: 12 in. high sides require higher than standard overhead or underside drive.
BELT SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. V-belt drive supplied under 17 FPM. NOTE:
Capacity affected with speed change. LOWER POWERED FEEDER–Chain type driven from tail pulley of conveyor. Black friction surface
belt. Includes MS-6 support. NOTE: conveyor tail pulley is used for belt take-up. When belt tension
OVERHEAD END DRIVE–Higher than standard clearance above belt, specify. is adjusted, feeder will have to be moved along with the take-up. NOTE: Capacity affected with this
option.
UNDERSIDE END DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted underneath bed. Extends down 11 in. from
bottom of bed. MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
PULLEYS–6 in. tail with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings or 8 in. drive with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–One direction manual start switch. Non-reversing magnetic starters. Push
bearings. button stations. AC variable frequency drive.
CATALOG | 08312018
PCX Low Profile Portable Parts Conveyor
The portable Model PCX parts conveyor can be easily • Belt with 1” High Metal Cleats
positioned under punch presses and extruding machines • Underside Drive
to catch small steel, plastics, or aluminum stampings, etc.
• 5/8” High Vertical Sides Above Cleat
Conveys them quickly up to hopper or drum.
• Enclosed Box Construction
• Belt Scraper
• Adjustable Portable Support
Overall Between
Belt Weights
Frame Rail "A" "B" "C" "D"
Width (Lbs.)
Width Width
45" 82 3/4" 32" 268
30" 54" 90 1/8" 37 1/4" 279
66" 99 3/4" 44 3/8" 294
15 1/8" 12 1/8" 12"
45" 94 3/4" 32" 277
42" 54" 102 1/8" 37 1/4" 309
66" 111 3/4" 44 3/8" 303
45" 82 3/4" 32" 298
30" 54" 90 1/8" 37 1/4" 309
66" 99 3/4" 44 3/8" 331
21 1/8" 18 1/8" 18"
45" 94 3/4" 32" 309
42" 54" 102 1/8" 37 1/4" 323
66" 111 3/4" 44 3/8" 342
45" 82 3/4" 32" 332
30" 54" 90 1/8" 37 1/4" 348
66" 99 3/4" 44 3/8" 370
27 1/8" 24 1/8" 24"
45" 94 3/4" 32" 343
42" 54" 102 1/8" 37 1/4" 359
66" 111 3/4" 44 3/8" 381
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only.
Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
BELT
"B" SECTION X-X
7-1/4"
"A" "D"
TAKE-UP "X"
36˚
1-3/4"
4" DIA.
TAKE-UP PULLEY
"X" 4" TO 30"
BELT ADJUSTABLE 1.9" DIA. 6" DIA. POLYOLEFIN WHEELS
RETURN IDLER
SCRAPER
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS PCX
END DRIVE–Located on discharge end of conveyor. Chain guard located on left hand side.
BELT RETURN–Belt cleats slide on flat metal return guide.
BELT–Black Trackmate 533 COS-PVC (cover one side) with 1” high steel angle cleats on 12”
centers.. Clipper lacing. TAKE-UP–Take-ups at tail pulley. Provides 6 in. of belt take-up.
BED–7 1/4 in. x 12 ga. powder painted steel, formed side channel with bolted in slider bed which BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated ball bearings on drive and tail pulleys.
provides 1 in. high sides above belt.
SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No 50. roller chain to drive pulley
BELT SCRAPER–Mounted inside conveyor bed section to clean underside of return belt.
MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
PORTABLE SUPPORT–Undercarriage is adjustable from 4 in. to 30 in. with 6 in. dia. rubber
wheels. BELT SPEED–Constant 25 FPM maximum.
DRIVE PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned and fully lagged. CAPACITY–100 lbs. total distributed live load.
TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in INCLINE–45° in place of standard 36° requires 15 3/4” incline section. Other horizontal and incline
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-3 support. lengths available.
OVERHEAD END DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted 9 1/4 in. above cleat. MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 1 HP maximum.
V-BELT DRIVE–V-belt supplied between motor and reducer. ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–One direction manual start switch, non-reversing magnetic starters, push
button stations, power cord. AC variable frequency drive.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
regular lubrication).
CATALOG | 08312018
PCH Piano Hinge Parts Conveyor
The Model PCH parts conveyor with hinged steel belt is • 5 Belt Widths
ideal for carrying hot, oily parts from punch presses, forging
machines, etc., to drums, hoppers, or other operations. • Piano Hinge Belt
Configurations range from straight to “Z” type units.
• Heavy-duty PCHS Type Adjustable Floor
Supports Available
OVERALL
"D" FRAME WIDTH
"A" BELT WIDTH
16-1/2"
19-5/8" R. MAX.
BETWEEN
RAIL WIDTH
2-1/4" 1-1/4"
16-3/16"
MAX. 1-7/8"
11" R 8-5/8"
"B" 8-5/8"
"X"
"A" BUTT
RETURN COUPLING
"C" FRAME SPACER
BELT
"X" DRIVE SECTION X-X
45˚ SPROCKET
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS PCH
OVERHEAD END DRIVE–Located on discharge end of conveyor. Chain guard located on right TAKE-UP–Take-ups are provided to insure proper belt tension.
hand side.
BEARINGS–Sealed, re-lube bearings at drive and take-up.
BELT–Piano Hinge metal belt with 12 ga. plain bottom aprons. 2 1/2 in. pitch chain with 1 1/2 in.
dia. hardened rollers with 7/16 in. dia. hinge axle. 1 1/2 in. high x 10 ga. continuous off-set side wing SPEED REDUCTION– Sealed worm gear speed reducer driven by V-belt. No. 60 roller chain to
links. drive sprockets.
BED–8 5/8 in. deep x 10 ga. powder painted, formed steel channel. Modular bed sections bolt MOTOR– 1 HP -208/230/460/575V-3 Ph. 60 Hz Premium Energy Efficient with torque limiter (Not
together with butt couplings. 45° standard incline section. a warranty item).
BELT GUIDES–Steel angle mounted inside bed for tracking belt. BELT SPEED–Constant 30 FPM.
DRIVE SPROCKETS–5 in. pitch dia. with 1 7/16 in. dia. shaft, 6 tooth. CAPACITY–35 lbs. belt capacity per linear foot of conveyor.
TAKE-UP SPROCKETS–5 in. pitch dia. with 1 7/16 in. dia. shaft, 6 tooth. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
Model PCH design makes it ideal for positioning into or under punch presses and similar equipment.
Horizontal discharge section allows easy positioning of hopper or drum for parts collection.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–PCHS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in INCLINES–30º, 45º, and 60º angles. Horizontal available.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above PCHS-3 support.
BED–2 ft. through 10 ft. intermediate beds available.
BELT–Perforated, pimpled, or pimpled and perforated. 1 1/2 in. or 2 in. high cleats. Contact factory.
MOTORS–Single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
DRIP PANS–Mounted underneath conveyor frame for drainage.
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Magnetic starters, push button stations and AC variable frequency drive.
COVER–Mounted on top of conveyor frame to keep parts from falling back when conveyor is used
at steep incline. BELT SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds.
CATALOG | 08312018
PCA Light Duty Portable Parts Conveyor
The Model “PCA” Conveyor is easily positioned in or • 6 Belt Widths
under punch presses, plastic injection molding machines, • Reversible
extruding equipment, and other machinery, where small steel • Overhead Drive
or aluminum stampings, plastic parts, etc., must be quickly • One Piece Troughed Bed
conveyed to hoppers or drums to keep production on the
• Adjustable PCAS Type Floor Supports Available
move.
SIZE TO ORDER Belt Width 4" 6" 8" 10" 12" 18"
Overall Bed Width 4 1/2" 6 1/2" 8 1/2" 10 1/2" 12 1/2" 18 1/2"
Length "A" "B" 9 1/8" 11 1/8" 13 1/8" 15 1/8" 17 1/8" 23 1/8"
4' 96 107 116 125 134 162
5' 100 114 124 128 146 178
Weights
6' (Lbs.) 106 121 133 145 158 196
8' 116 139 150 165 181 228
10' 126 146 166 186 205 262
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
"B"
OVERALL LENGTH "A"
16"
2-1/8" DIA.
TAIL PULLEY 19-45/64"
2"
6-3/8"
MIN. 11-3/8"
3-1/4" BELT WIDTH
2-1/2" DIA. BED WIDTH
6-1/2" DRIVE PULLEY
1-3/8" DIA. RETURN IDLER
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
OVERHEAD END DRIVE–Located on discharge end of conveyor. Chain guard located on left hand TAKE-UP–Screw take-ups are provided at drive pulley to insure proper belt tension.
side.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated ball bearings on drive pulley.
BELT–Black Ultimate 140 SD. Clipper lacing.
SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear “C” face speed reducer. No. 40 roller chain to drive pulley.
BED–12 ga. steel formed troughed bed section with 1 in. high vertical sides.
MOTOR– 1/2 HP–230/460V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed Fan Cooled “C” face.
DRIVE PULLEY–2 1/2 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft, crowned and fully lagged.
BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
TAIL PULLEY–2 1/8 in. dia. with 7/16 in. dia. threaded shaft. Pre-lubricated ball bearings.
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 10 lbs.
RETURN IDLER–Adjustable 1 3/8 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–PCAS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify BED–Higher than 1 in. high vertical sides.
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above PCAS-6 support. UNDERSIDE DRIVE–Gearhead motor mounted underneath bed section.
BELT–White Polymate 100 RPM COS. MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, other characteristics. 1/2 HP maximum.
BELT SPEED–Other constant speeds 11 to 82 FPM, specify. ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Manual one direction push button switch, one direction magnetic starters,
push button stations, power cord.
CATALOG | 08312018
ALT1000
The ALT1000 is a plastic chain belt conveyor with anodized •
Carryline Plastic Chain Conveyor
4 Belt Widths - White Acetal
aluminum beam frame designed to carry light weight products. • Anodized Aluminum Beam Frames
The components can be combined in many different ways; • Module Design
therefore the system can grow as production increases. • 1/2HP - 230/460/575V Shaft Mounted Gearmotor
• Tubular Guide Rails Included
• Floor supports not included
NOTE: • Idler and Drive Lengths included in Overall length. Idler is 500 mm and Drive is 500 mm. Standard fingerchain belt shown.
Idler Drive
500 mm 2099 mm 500 mm
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
BELT–White Acetal finger chain available in 4 widths.
GEARMOTOR– 1/2 HP 230/460/575V Shaft Mounted Drive
FRAME–Anodized Aluminum Beam Frame available in 4 widths.
BELT SPEED– 58 feet per min constant speed (17.68 meters per min)
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive and tail pulley. Re-lube
type. CAPACITY–50 lbs per foot at 58 ft per minute with clean environmental conditions
GUARD RAILS–Aluminum Round with brackets FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment. See chart below for available elevations.
THIS DRAWING CONTAINS CONFIDENTIAL C HYTROL
DWG NO
140 30 7.5 lbs 9.3 lbs 10.4 lbs 14.8 lbs 30 5.7 lbs 11 lbs
141 mm wide 140
45 9.5 lbs 11.5 lbs 13.1 lbs 18.3 lbs 45 7.9 lbs 15.9 lbs
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
141 mm wide
90 14.8 lbs 18.3 lbs 21.9 lbs 29.3 lbs 60 10.4 lbs 21 lbs
15 12.6 lbs 11.5 lbs 90 15 lbs 31 lbs
ROLLER TRANSFER– Available on all series. 220 30 16.3 lbs 19 lbs 5 4.2 lbs
N/A N/A
224 mm wide 45 20.1 lbs 23.2 lbs 30 19.4 lbs
BELTS–Friction Chain Available in 4 widths 220
90 32.2 lbs 37.2 lbs 45 n/a 28 lbs
224 mm wide
GEARMOTORS–other HP’s available, 3/4 HP maximum Radius 60 36.9 lbs
Series Angle
191 289 389 489 589 90 54.1 lbs
GUARD RAILS–Flat Face UHMW and Slide Rail 15 5.2 lbs 5.7 lbs 6 lbs 6.4 lbs 6.8 lbs 5 n/a 2.2 lbs
620 30 6 lbs 7.1 lbs 7.8 lbs 8.8 lbs 9.7 lbs 30 4.9 lbs 9.5 lbs
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–AC variable frequency drives 64 mm wide 45 6.8 lbs 8.4 lbs 9.7 lbs 11 lbs 12.6 lbs
620
45 7.5 lbs 13.7 lbs
available 64 mm wide
90 9.7 lbs 12.6 lbs 15.3 lbs 18.3 lbs 21.2 lbs 60 8.9 lbs 17.9 lbs
BENDS & CURVES–See chart for options & contact Radius 90 12.8 lbs 26.3 lbs
Series Angle
factory for wheel bend application. 150 200 300 500 600 5 n/a 2.2 lbs
15 4.9 lbs 5.1 lbs 5.6 lbs 6.4 lbs 6 lbs 30 4.9 lbs 9.5 lbs
830
830 30 5.5 lbs 6 lbs 7.1 lbs 8.8 lbs 13.3 lbs 45 7.5 lbs 13.7 lbs
86 mm wide
86 mm wide 45 6.2 lbs 7.1 lbs 8.4 lbs 11.3 lbs 16.3 lbs 60 8.9 lbs 17.9 lbs
90 8.4 lbs 10 lbs 12.9 lbs 18.6 lbs 25.6 lbs 90 12.8 lbs 26.3 lbs
NOTE: • Weight includes (2) 80 mm tangets and belt on top and bottom.
• Floor supports, drive, and idler are not included in weight.
CATALOG | 08312018
PROSORT SS
Optional ALT1000
not shown
Divert Locations 1 2 3 4 5 6
Single Level/Single-sided 419 728 1038 1347 1657 1966
Single Level/Double-sided 478 846 1215 1583 1952 2320
Dual Level/Single-sided 487 864 1242 1619 1997 2374
Dual Level/Double-sided 614 1118 1623 2127 2632 3136
NOTE: Weight includes sweeper, mounting structure and aftersort.. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
Support Structure
18 1/2 Sweeper Paddle
Divert Location
33
91 1/2
Wood Dividers
88 3/4
8 6
23 1/2
18 1/2
Support Structure Timing Belt
Take-up A
Sweeper Paddle Guarding
14
91
21
Wood Dividers
88 3/4
CATALOG | 08312018
Wood Divider
PROSORT SS
18 1/2
Support Structure
TOTE SENSOR— Retroreflective, 24 VDC, LED. Air Cylinder Part Verif ication Sensor Location
( U pper Level)
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
DUAL TIER CHUTE DESIGN—Provides the addition of divert lanes saving space and PROSORT LOGIX CONTROL PACKAGE—Provides complete controls for proper sorter
installation cost. operation. Consult factory for details.
CATALOG | 08312018
PSB
drive system to eliminate belt slippage and mistracking.
Plastic Belt Conveyor
The Model PSB with modular plastic belting uses a positive • 16 Belt Widths
• Polypropylene 2” Pitch Plastic Belt
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
Belt Width 8" 10" 12" 14" 16" 18" 20" 22" 24" 26" 28" 30" 32" 34" 36" 38"
SIZE TO
Between Rail
ORDER 9" 11" 13" 15" 17" 19" 21" 23" 25" 27" 29" 31" 33" 35" 37" 39"
Width
Overall
Length Overall Frame
12" 14" 16" 18" 20" 22" 24" 26" 28" 30" 32" 34" 36" 38" 40" 42"
Width
10' Weights 328 248 368 388 408 428 448 468 488 508 528 548 568 588 608 628
Weights Per Foot 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32 34 36 38 40 42 44 46 48
7-1/2"
11-15/16"
2" MAX. SNUB ROLLER
2"
UHMW
WEARSTRIP
TOTALLY
FRAME SPACER UHMW WEARSTRIPS ENCLOSED
OPTIONAL MS SUPPORT SHOWN CHAIN
13-1/4" ALLOW GUARD
16" MAX. 16" SECTION X-X
29-1/4"
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
END DRIVE–Located on discharge end of conveyor. Chain guard located on left hand side. SNUB ROLLERS–Located at drive and tail ends.
BELT–Polypropylene 2 in. pitch Flush Grid, nominal 1 in. less than BR. RETURN BARS–UHMW on aluminum.
BED–UHMW on aluminum slider bars, mounted to frame spacers. Mounted in 7 1/2 in. x 12 ga. powder BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning ball bearings on drive and tail shafts.
painted, formed steel channel frame bolted together with butt couplings.
SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive sprocket.
CROSS BRACING–Rods with turnbuckles are fastened to underside of bed to provide proper alignment of bed
rollers and insure tracking. (1) supplied in first 50' of bed section lengths and (1) per 50' of bed section length MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
thereafter. Supplied in approximate center of lengths.
BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
DRIVE AND TAIL SPROCKETS–10 tooth 6.4 in. pitch dia. molded plastic sprockets on 1 1/2 in. sq. shaft, 1 3/16
in. dia. shaft at bearings. CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 200 lbs. NOT TO EXCEED capacity in chart.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify top O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in feet for regular lubrication).
lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
CEILING HANGARS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized rods
BED–Stainless steel in lieu of powder painted HRS (Excluding Aluminum Support Bars). available.
BELT–Other belts available, contact factory. NOSEOVER AND NOSEUNDER–Can be incorporated to provide continuous belt travel from horizontal to
incline or decline.
BELT SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. V-belt drive supplied on speeds under 15 FPM and with
variable speeds. Note: Capacity affected with speed change. MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other haracteristics. 2 HP maximum.
V-BELT DRIVE–V-belt supplied between motor and reducer. Allow 65 in. ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–One direction magnetic starters and push-button stations. AC Variable
Frequency Drive.
CATALOG | 08312018
PSBC
The Model PSBC with modular plastic belting uses a positive
Plastic Belt Conveyor
• 3 Belt Widths
drive system to eliminate belt slippage and mistracking. • Polypropylene 1” Pitch Plastic Belt
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
11-15/16"
MAX. 2"
UHMW "C"
WEARSTRIP
4"
6.4" PITCH DIA. 3-3/8"
OPTIONAL TAIL SPROCKET
MS-SUPPORTS (6" CENTERS
APPROX.) "B"
SHOWN
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
END DRIVE–Located on discharge end of conveyor. Chain guard located on left hand side. RETURN BARS–UHMW on aluminum.
BELT–Polypropylene 1 in. pitch Flush Grid Radius Belt, nominal 1 in. less than BR. BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning ball bearings on drive and tail shafts.
BED–UHMW on aluminum slider bars, mounted to frame spacers. Mounted in 7 1/2 in. x 12 ga. powder SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive sprocket.
painted, formed steel channel frame bolted together with butt couplings.
MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
DRIVE AND TAIL SPROCKETS–20 tooth 6.4 in. pitch dia. molded plastic sprockets on 1 1/2 in. sq. shaft, 1 3/16
in. dia. shaft at bearings. BELT SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
SNUB ROLLERS–Located at drive and tail ends. CAPACITY–300 lbs. distributed live load.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify top
of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in feet for V-BELT DRIVE–V-belt supplied between motor and reducer. Allow 65 in.
lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
CEILING HANGARS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized rods
BED–Stainless steel in lieu of powder painted HRS (Excluding Aluminum Support Bars). available.
BELT–Other belts available, contact factory. MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
BELT SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. V-belt drive supplied on speeds under 15 FPM and with ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starters and push-button stations. AC variable
variable speeds. Note: Capacity affected with speed change. frequency drive.
CATALOG | 08312018
PROSORT SS
Optional ALT1000
not shown
Divert Locations 1 2 3 4 5 6
Single Level/Single-sided 419 728 1038 1347 1657 1966
Single Level/Double-sided 478 846 1215 1583 1952 2320
Dual Level/Single-sided 487 864 1242 1619 1997 2374
Dual Level/Double-sided 614 1118 1623 2127 2632 3136
NOTE: Weight includes sweeper, mounting structure and aftersort.. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
Support Structure
18 1/2 Sweeper Paddle
Divert Location
33
91 1/2
Wood Dividers
88 3/4
8 6
23 1/2
18 1/2
Support Structure Timing Belt
Take-up A
Sweeper Paddle Guarding
14
91
21
Wood Dividers
88 3/4
CATALOG | 08312018
Wood Divider
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS PLEZD
BELT–1” pitch polypropylene plastic belt. EZLogic ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone (Retro-Reflective). NEMA 1, 2, IP 62. UL
®
Approved.
BED–1/4” UHMW over steel bed channels mounted in 7 1/2” x 7 ga. powder painted formed steel
channels. IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
input/output boards. Should be located near disconnect panel. See chart for maximum quantity
EZDriveTM System–Shaft mounted gearmotor located at discharge of each zone. (1/2 HP - 3 PH of zones. Requires 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
60 Hz. Totally enclosed fan cooled. 230 or 460 V (specify voltage). Includes EZDriveTM Disconnect
Panel. Power is distributed zone to zone through pluggable cordsets. Power is connected from the CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 34 FPM.
starter box to the motor via “SO” type cord. Please contact factory if local code requires other than
the standard power distribution techniques described. CAPACITY–See Chart.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–30 in. to 120 in. on 6 in. increments. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
INFEED EYE IOP EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER † Note: Infeed Wake-Up Eye used only on terminating
infeed end of conveyor. Not used when connecting to
upstream EZLogic® conveyor through power supply
isolation cable.
ZONE GEARMOTOR
EZDRIVE™ ZONE STARTER BOX
SINGLE OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL
INFEED EYE IOP EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER
DUAL OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL ZONE GEARMOTOR EZDRIVE™ ZONE STARTER BOX
(MUST BE LOCATED AT THE CENTER OF CONVEYOR)
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always used
at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Sleep Feature – Stops tread rollers from turning when no product is present, reducing noise, reducing energy consumption and extending roller bearing life.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from a removed load, preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are routinely removed
from the conveyor with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and stops the zone from driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering loading
area.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–HS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify GEARMOTORS– 3/4 HP, 1 HP, and 1 1/2 HP available.
top of belt elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor (for standard
lengths and capacity). Holes in feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above HS-6 EZDriveTM System:
support. • Variable Frequency Drive-for adjusting conveying speed or adjusting acceleration and
deceleration time.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds available, contact factory.
EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 08312018
WHEEL
A proven performer for trailer loading and unloading. Ideally
Model “FX 200” Heavy-Duty
• Structural Steel Support: Channel steel spans the entire
conveyor width for unequalled strength.
suited for packaging, shipping and flexible assembly lines.
Order optional leg connect brackets to lock units together. • 1 1/4” Side Plates: Aluminum alloy with ribbed construction for
added durability. Assembled with shoulder bolts.
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
WIDTHS–18 in. and 24 in.
WHEELS–1.9 in. dia. with 1/4 in. bore.
FRAME–Flexible and extendible.
PACKAGE STOP–Folds down when not in use.
LENGTHS–12 ft. and 24 ft.
CASTERS–Swivel casters with locking brake.
EXPANSION RATIO–4:1
CAPACITY– 200 lbs. capacity per linear foot.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Adjustable type 28 1/2” to 41 1/2”.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
LEG CONNECT BRACKETS–Connecting two or more conveyors.
CATALOG | 08312018
CONVEYOR RAILS
Wheel Conveyor Rails are made up of standard skatewheels
mounted to various angle-channel configurations. They
provide a means of economical mobile storage systems. Can
be mounted on floor level or in storage flow racks. Rails are
12 ga. powder painted steel.
ALUMINUM FRAMES
3SW-12-12 12 38 72 3SW-15-12 12 43 78 3AW-12-12 12 21 39 3AW-15-12 12 23 42
STEEL FRAMES
SIDE CHANNEL
LOAD CAPACITY CHART
5' OR 10'
OVERALL FRAME WIDTH
Frame Capacity (Lbs.) Wheel Capacity (Lbs.)
Frame Support
1" BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH 5/16" Material Centers Maximum Distributed Maximum Load OVERALL LENGTH
Live Load Per Foot Per Wheel
5' 250
2-1/2" Steel 65
1/4" DIA. AXLE 10' 31
5' 83
Aluminum 45
BOLT-IN AXLE CENTER 10' 10 CROSS COUPLING
CROSS
MEMBERS
SPACER SUPPORT BAR MEMBER BOLT
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
WIDTH–12 in., 15 in., 18 in., and 24 in. overall.
WHEELS–1 15/16 in. O.D. ball bearings run in hardened raceway with life-time lubrication. Corrosion
FRAME–2 1/2 in. deep x 1 in. flange x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel or 1/8 in. heat-treated resistant aluminum or zinc-coated steel.
aluminum channel with bolt-in cross members.
AXLES–1/4 in. dia., threaded one end with locknut. Spaced on 3 in. or 4 in. centers, specify.
COUPLINGS–Butt Couplings on both ends
CAPACITY–See Load Capacity Chart this page.
LENGTHS–5 ft. & 10 ft. straight sections.
CATALOG | 08312018
WHEEL
Skatewheel curves add to the versatility of straight conveyors
Gravity Skatewheel
Curve Conveyor
• 4 Widths
and provide excellent package orientation because of the • Powder Painted Steel or Aluminum Frames
differential action of wheels. Curves will convey product with • Butt Couping on Both Ends
minimum amount of pitch based on weight and size. • 30°,45°,60°& 90° Curves
12" Overall Width 15" Overall Width 18" Overall Width 24" Overall Width
(48" Outside Radius) (48" Outside Radius) (48" Outside Radius) (60" Outside Radius)
STEEL FRAMES
12" Overall Width 15" Overall Width 18" Overall Width 24" Overall Width
(48" Outside Radius) (48" Outside Radius) (48" Outside Radius) (60" Outside Radius)
Model Wgts. Model Wgts. Model Wgts. Model Degree WPC Wgts.
Degree WPC Degree WPC Degree WPC
No. (Lbs.) No. (Lbs.) No. (Lbs.) No. (Lbs.)
AWC-12-90 90° 63 22 AWC-15-90 90° 84 26 AWC-18-90 90° 94 28 AWC-24-90 90° 156 43
AWC-12-60 60º 42 17 AWC-15-60 60º 56 20 AWC-18-60 60º 63 21 AWC-24-60 60º 102 33
AWC-12-45 45º 30 12 AWC-15-45 45º 40 14 AWC-18-45 45º 45 15 AWC-24-45 45º 78 23
AWC-12-30 30º 30 8 AWC-15-30 30º 40 9 AWC-18-30 30º 45 10 AWC-24-30 30º 60 14
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
INSIDE RADIUS
Overall Width Inside Radius
12" 36"
15" 33"
18" 30"
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 24" 36"
CATALOG | 08312018
WHEEL
Gravity Skatewheel Spurs are used to transfer products
Gravity Skatewheel Spur Conveyor
• 4 Widths
from one conveying line onto another. They can be used • Powder Painted Steel or Aluminum Frames
in merging or diverging applications. Ideally used where • Right & Left Hand Units
numerous lines must transfer onto a main conveyor line, from • Butt Couplings on One End
work stations or other similar operations.
• 30°, 45° & 90° Spurs
"B"
90˚
60" "R"
60"
SECTION “X-X”
OVERALL FRAME WIDTH SIDE CHANNEL
2-1/2"
1/4" DIA. AXLE
BOLT-IN
CROSS AXLE CENTER
SPACER SUPPORT BAR
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
MEMBERS
WIDTHS–12 in., 15 in., 18 in., & 24 in. SPUR ANGLE–30°, 45° & 90°. Right or left hand applications, specify.
FRAME–2 1/2 in. deep x 1 in. flange x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel or 1/8 in. heat-treated WHEELS–1 15/16 in. O.D. ball bearings run in hardened raceway with life-time lubrication. Corrosion
aluminum channel with bolt-in cross members. resistant zinc-coated steel.
COUPLINGS–Butt Couplings on one end. Spur angle on opposite end. Mounting bracket AXLES–1/4 in. dia., threaded one end with locknut.
available,specify.
CAPACITY–Same per foot capacity as straight sections. See Gravity Skatewheel Conveyor.
CATALOG | 08312018
TS-CHUTE
The Transnorm Safeglide® Spiral Chute exhibits a •
Transnorm Safeglide Chute
Multiple Sizes and Configurations
sophisticated and controlled method of delivering most • Center Column with Glass wrapped around it
products from a higher elevation down a lower level. These • Gel Coat Surface
chutes are available in four (4) sizes to accommodate a F.O.B. Arlington, Texas
large range of products. Other degrees available. Contact
Transnorm.
CONFIGURATIONS:
Counter - Clockwise
*
Elevation Differential
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
MATERIAL- 3/8” thick Fiberglass with a Gel Coat surface
ACCUMULATION- Allowed. Chute is self-starting once bottom is cleared out. • OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
EXIT SWOOP- Standard exit to allow smooth discharge. *May not be applicable depending on
design configuration. EXTENSIONS–12ga. Galv. Infeed and Exit Extension’s available upon need.
BASE PLATE- 3’ x 3’ square base plate with leveling bolts and Anchor holes. CUSTOM COLORS–Available (Contact factory), Paint chip may be required.
CATALOG | 08312018
ROLLER
1 3/8 in. dia. Gravity Roller Conveyor is used to carry
Gravity Roller Conveyor
(1 3/8 in. Dia. x 18 Ga. Rollers)
• 4 Widths
lightweight packages or when operation requires lightweight • 6 Roller Centers
sections. Useful in setting up permanent or temporary • Powder Painted Steel or Aluminum Frames
conveyor lines in warehousing activities, shipping
departments, assembly areas, etc. Majority of products will
convey with minimum amount of pitch.
12" Overall Width 15" Overall Width 18" Overall Width 24" Overall Width
STEEL FRAMES
Model Roller Wgts. (Lbs.) Model Roller Wgts. (Lbs.) Model Roller Wgts. (Lbs.) Model Roller Wgts. (Lbs.)
No. Centers 5' 10' No. Centers 5' 10' No. Centers 5' 10' No. Centers 5' 10'
SSR-12-1 1/2 1 1/2” 55 101 SSR-15-1 1/2 1 1/2” 62 112 SSR-18-1 1/2 1 1/2” 72 135 SSR-24-1 1/2 1 1/2” 91 168
SSR-12-3 3” 37 68 SSR-15-3 3” 42 78 SSR-18-3 3” 47 97 SSR-24-3 3” 58 108
SSR-12-4 1/2 4 1/2” 32 58 SSR-15-4 1/2 4 1/2” 33 61 SSR-18-4 1/2 4 1/2” 40 73 SSR-24-4 1/2 4 1/2” 47 88
SSR-12-6 6” 29 52 SSR-15-6 6” 30 55 SSR-18-6 6” 32 63 SSR-24-6 6” 42 78
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
ALUMINUM FRAMES
12" Overall Width 15" Overall Width 18" Overall Width 24" Overall Width
Model Roller Wgts. (Lbs.) Model Roller Wgts. (Lbs.) Model Roller Wgts. (Lbs.) Model Roller Wgts. (Lbs.)
No. Centers 5' 10' No. Centers 5' 10' No. Centers 5' 10' No. Centers 5' 10'
SAR-12-1 1/2 1 1/2” 29 53 SAR-15-1 1/2 1 1/2” 33 56 SAR-18-1 1/2 1 1/2” 38 70 SAR-24-1 1/2 1 1/2” 48 88
SAR-12-3 3” 20 36 SAR-15-3 3” 23 41 SAR-18-3 3” 27 51 SAR-24-3 3” 30 56
SAR-12-4 1/2 4 1/2” 17 30 SAR-15-4 1/2 4 1/2” 18 32 SAR-18-4 1/2 4 1/2” 20 38 SAR-24-4 1/2 4 1/2” 25 46
SAR-12-6 6” 15 27 SAR-15-6 6” 16 29 SAR-18-6 6” 18 33 SAR-24-6 6” 22 41
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
CROSS COUPLING
MEMBER BOLT
1/4" DIA. 2-1/2"
AXLE
LOAD CAPACITY CHART
1-3/8" DIA. ROLLER
BOLT-IN Frame Support
Frame Capacity (Lbs.) Roller Capacity (Lbs.)
CROSS MEMBER Material Centers
Maximum Distributed Maximum Load
Live Load Per Foot Per Roller
5' 250
Steel 45
10' 31
5' 83
Aluminum 30
10' 10
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
WIDTHS–12 in., 15 in., 18 in. and 24 in. overall. LENGTHS–5 ft. and 10 ft. straight sections.
FRAME–2 1/2 in. deep x 1 in. flange x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel or 1/8 in. heat-treated ROLLERS–1 3/8 in. dia. x 18 ga. galvanized steel or heat-treated aluminum tubing. Spring loaded
aluminum channel with bolt-in cross members. axle allows roller to be easily removed or inserted.
CATALOG | 08312018
ROLLER
Gravity Roller Curves add to the versatility of straight
Gravity Roller Curve Conveyor
(1 3/8 in. Dia. x 18 Ga. Rollers)
• 4 Widths
conveyors. Curves provide smooth product flow through • Powder Painted Steel or Aluminum Frames
turns. Curves will convey product with minimum amount of • Butt Couplings on Bolts Both Ends
pitch based on weight and size. Guard rails (optional item) • 30°,45°, 60° and 90°
may be added for product protection.
Aluminum Frame
12" Overall Width 15" Overall Width 18" Overall Width 24" Overall Width OVERALL FRAME WIDTH
(36" Outside Radius) (39" Outside Radius) (42" Outside Radius) (48" Outside Radius) SIDE
CHANNEL
Model Wgts. Model Wgts. Model Wgts. Model Wgts. 1" BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH 1/4"
Degree Degree Degree Degree
No. (Lbs.) No. (Lbs.) No. (Lbs.) No. (Lbs.)
SARC-12-90 90° 28 SARC-15-90 90° 31 SARC-18-90 90° 35 SARC-24-90 90° 50
1/4" DIA. 2-1/2"
SARC-12-60 60º 21 SARC-15-60 60º 24 SARC-18-60 60º 27 SARC-24-60 60º 38 AXLE
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
WIDTHS–12 in., 15 in., 18 in., & 24 in. overall.
ROLLERS–1 3/8 in. dia. x 18 ga. galvanized steel or heat-treated aluminum tubes or 1 1/2 in. dia.
FRAME–2 1/2 in. deep x 1 in. flange x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel or 1/8 in. heat-treated galvanized tapered tubes. Spring loaded axle allows roller to be easily removed or inserted. Aluminum
aluminum channel with bolt-in cross members. tapered tubes available, contact factory.
CURVES–30°,45°, 60° & 90°. CAPACITY–Same per foot capacity as straight sections. See charts previous page.
CATALOG | 08312018
ROLLER
Gravity Roller Spurs are used to transfer products from one
Gravity Roller Spur
(1 3/8 in. Dia. x 18 Ga. Rollers)
• 4 Widths
conveying line to another. They can be used in merging or • Powder Painted Steel or Aluminum Frames
diverging applications. Ideally used where numerous lines • Right & Left Hand Units Conveyor shown with
must transfer onto a main conveyor line, from work stations • Butt Couplings on One End optional floor supports
or other similar operations.
• 30°, 45°, & 90° Spurs Available
Between Overall
Wgt. Model Wgt. Model Wgt.
STEEL FRAMES
Between Overall
Wgt. Model Wgt. Model Wgt.
Rail Frame Model No. "A" "B" "C"
(Lbs.) No. (Lbs.) No. (Lbs.)
Width Width
10" 12" SARS-12-30 24" 40 SARS-12-45 18" 41 SARS-12-90 35" 33
13" 15" SARS-15-30 30" 46 SARS-15-45 22" 48 SARS-15-90 35" 35
16" 18" SARS-18-30 36" 50 SARS-18-45 26" 52 SARS-18-90 35" 37
22" 24" SARS-24-30 48" 58 SARS-24-45 35" 63 SARS-24-90 50" 41
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
NOTE: When “Between Rail Widths” exceed 21”, double rollers are supplied standard on 90˚ spurs.
1-1 60"
1/2
60" RADIUS
1-
"A"
SECTION “X-X”
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
WIDTHS–12 in., 15 in., 18 in., & 24 in. overall. SPUR ANGLE–30°, 45°, 90° right or left hand applications, specify.
FRAME–2 1/2 in. deep x 1 in. flange x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel or 1/8 in. heat-treated ROLLERS–1 3/8 in. dia. x 18 ga. galvanized steel tubing. Spring loaded axle allows roller to be easily
aluminum channel with bolt-in cross members. removed or inserted.
COUPLINGS–Butt Coupling on one end, spur angle on opposite end. Mounting bracket available, AXLES–1/4 in. dia. round
specify.
CAPACITY–Same per foot capacity as straight sections. See Gravity Roller Conveyor.
CATALOG | 08312018
ROLLER Gravity Roller Conveyor
(1.9 in. Dia. x 16 Ga. Rollers)
(1.9 in. Dia. x 9 Ga. Rollers)
OVERALL WIDTH
3/4" SIDE
CHANNEL
4-1/2"
7/16" HEX
SHAFT
• STANDARD
19GSR-23-4 1/2 4 1/2" 93 179 199SR-23-4 1/2 4 1/2" 129 254 SHAFT
19GSR-23-6 6" 81 152 199SR-23-6 6" 109 207
SPECIFICATIONS
19GSR-25-2 1/4 2 1/4" 145 290 199SR-25-2 1/4 2 1/4" 208 409
19GSR-25-3 3" 126 241 199SR-25-3 3" 167 363
19GSR-25-4 1/2 4 1/2" 97 187 199SR-25-4 1/2 4 1/2" 137 270
28" 25"
19GSR-25-6 6" 85 158 199SR-25-6 6" 116 219 WIDTHS–Between Rail Width: 13 in., 15 in., 17 in.,
19GSR-25-9 9" 73 129 199SR-25-9 9" 94 169 19 in., 21 in., 23 in., 25 in., 27 in., 31 in., 33 in., 37
19GSR-25-12 12" 64 117 199SR-25-12 12" 80 148 in., and 39 in.
19GSR-27-2 1/4 2 1/4" 153 307 199SR-27-2 1/4 2 1/4" 224 438
30" 27"
19GSR-27-3 3" 133 255 199SR-27-3 3" 200 387 FRAME–3 1/2 in. or 4 1/2 in. deep x 1 1/2 in. flange x 10
19GSR-27-4 1/2 4 1/2" 102 196 199SR-27-4 1/2 4 1/2" 146 287 ga. powder painted formed steel channel with bolt-
19GSR-27-6 6" 89 166 199SR-27-6 6" 122 232 in cross members.
19GSR-31-2 1/4 2 1/4" 169 340 199SR-31-2 1/4 2 1/4" 252 493
19GSR-31-3 3" 146 278 199SR-31-3 3" 224 433
BUTT COUPLINGS–Bolt-on type for bolting
34" 31"
19GSR-31-4 1/2 4 1/2" 112 214 199SR-31-4 1/2 4 1/2" 162 319
sections together.
19GSR-31-6 6" 97 179 199SR-31-6 6" 135 257
LENGTHS–5 ft. and 10 ft. straight sections.
19GSR-33-2 1/4 2 1/4" 177 356 199SR-33-2 1/4 2 1/4" 267 524
19GSR-33-3 3" 154 292 199SR-33-3 3" 237 460
36" 33" ROLLERS–19-GSR 1.9 in. dia. x 16 ga. galvanized
19GSR-33-4 1/2 4 1/2" 117 224 199SR-33-4 1/2 4 1/2" 171 337
steel tubing; 199-SR 1.9 in. dia. x 9 ga. unplated
19GSR-33-6 6" 101 187 199SR-33-6 6" 143 271
steel tubing. Bearings are labyrinth sealed and
19GSR-37-2 1/4 2 1/4" 193 389 199SR-37-2 1/4 2 1/4" 295 579
grease packed.
19GSR-37-3 3" 164 311 199SR-37-3 3" 261 506
40" 37"
19GSR-37-4 1/2 4 1/2" 124 238 199SR-37-4 1/2 4 1/2" 188 369
AXLES–7/16 in. hex shaft, spring loaded.
19GSR-37-6 6" 108 198 199SR-37-6 6" 156 296
19GSR-39-2 1/4 2 1/4" 201 405 199SR-39-2 1/4 2 1/4" 308 606
CAPACITY–See Load Capacity Chart this page.
19GSR-39-3 3" 173 328 199SR-39-3 3" 272 528
42" 39" LOAD CAPACITY CHART
19GSR-39-4 1/2 4 1/2" 130 250 199SR-39-4 1/2 4 1/2" 195 384
19GSR-39-6 6" 112 207 199SR-39-6 6" 162 307 Frame Roller Capacity (Lbs.)
Capacity Max. Load Per Roller
(Lbs.)
Support Max.
Centers Distributed
Live Load 19GSR 199SR
Per Foot
620
5’ 620
210 250
10’ 118
CATALOG | 08312018
ROLLER Gravity Roller Curve Conveyor
(1.9 in. Dia. x 16 Ga. Galvanized Rollers)
Rollers Rollers
Model No. Weight Model No. Weight
Inside Per Inside Per
OAW BR 19GSRC (Lbs) OAW BR 19GSRC (Lbs)
Radius Curve Radius Curve
Galvanized 90º Galvanized 45º
90º 45º
16" 13" 22 19GSRC-13-90S 97 16" 13" 11 19GSRC-13-45S 50
18" 15" 22 19GSRC-15-90S 105 18" 15" 11 19GSRC-15-45S 53
20" 17" 22 19GSRC-17-90S 114 20" 17" 11 19GSRC-17-45S 58
22" 19" 22 19GSRC-19-90S 122 22" 19" 11 19GSRC-19-45S 63
32 1/2" 32 1/2"
24" 21" 22 19GSRC-21-90S 131 24" 21" 11 19GSRC-21-45S 67
26" 23" 42 19GSRC-23-90D 161 26" 23" 22 19GSRC-23-45D 82
28" 25" 42 19GSRC-25-90D 169 28" 25" 22 19GSRC-25-45D 85
30" 27" 42 19GSRC-27-90D 177 30" 27" 22 19GSRC-27-45D 89
34" 31" 42 19GSRC-31-90D 211 34" 31" 22 19GSRC-31-45D 108
36" 33" 42 19GSRC-33-90D 220 36" 33" 22 19GSRC-33-45D 112
48" 48"
40" 37" 42 19GSRC-37-90D 238 40" 37" 22 19GSRC-37-45D 120
42" 39" 42 19GSRC-39-90D 247 42" 39" 22 19GSRC-39-45D 124
Rollers Rollers
Model No. Weight Model No. Weight
Inside Per Inside Per
OAW BR 19GSRC (Lbs) BR 19GSRC (Lbs)
Radius Curve OAW Radius Curve
Galvanized 60º Galvanized 30º
60º 30º
OVERALL WIDTH
16" 13" 14 19GSRC-13-60S 65 16" 13" 7 19GSRC-13-30S 32
18" 15" BETWEEN
14 RAIL19GSRC-15-60S
WIDTH 70 18" 15" 7 19GSRC-15-30S 35
20" 17" 14 19GSRC-17-60S 1-1/2"76 20" 17" 7 19GSRC-17-30S 38
22" 19" 14 19GSRC-19-60S 81 22" 19" 7 19GSRC-19-30S 40
32 1/2" 3/4" SIDE 32 1/2"
24" 21" 14 19GSRC-21-60S 87
CHANNEL 24" 21" 7 19GSRC-21-30S 43
26" 23" 32 19GSRC-23-60D 107 26" 23" 12 19GSRC-23-30D 53
4-1/2"
28" 25" 32 19GSRC-25-60D 113 28" 25" 12 19GSRC-25-30D 56
7/16" HEX
30" SHAFT
27" 32 19GSRC-27-60D 118 30" 27" 12 19GSRC-27-30D 58
34" 31" 32 19GSRC-31-60D 141 34" 31" 18 19GSRC-31-30D 70
36" 33" 32 19GSRC-33-60D 147 36" 33" 18 19GSRC-33-30D 73
48" 48"
40" 37" 32 19GSRC-37-60D 159 40" 37" 18 19GSRC-37-30D 79
42" 39" 32 19GSRC-39-60D 165 42" 39" 18 19GSRC-39-30D 82
OVERALL WIDTH
OVERALL WIDTH
BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH
1-1/2" 1-1/2"
1/4" 19GSR, 20SR
9/16" 2514SR SIDE SIDE
CHANNEL 3/4"
CHANNEL
3-1/2" DE
7/16" HEX
SHAFT
4-1/2" INSI IUS
7/16" HEX
RA D
SET HIGH SHAFT SET LOW
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
WIDTHS–Between Rail Width: 13 in., 15 in., 17 in., 19 in., 21 in., 23 in., 25 in., 27 in., 31 in., 33 in.,
37 in., and 39 in. ROLLERS–(Straight) “19GSRC” 1.9 in. dia. x 16 ga. galvanized steel tubing. Bearings are labyrinth
OVERALL WIDTH
sealed and grease packed.
BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH
FRAME–3 1/2 in. or 4 1/2 in. deep x 1 1/2 in. flange x 10 ga. powder painted formed steel channel with
bolt-in cross members. AXLES–7/16 in. hex shaft,1-1/2"
spring loaded.
1/4" 19GSR, 20SR
9/16" 2514SR SIDE
BUTT COUPLINGS–Bolt-on type for bolting sections together. CAPACITY– Same per foot capacity as straight sections. See charts previous page.
CHANNEL
CURVES– 30°, 45°, 60° and 90° with 32 1/2 in. inside radius for widths up to 27 in., 48 in. inside 3-1/2"
7/16" HEX
radius for 31 in. to 39 in. between rail widths. SHAFT
CATALOG | 08312018
ROLLER Gravity Roller Curve Conveyor
(1.9 in. Dia. x 9 Ga. Unplated Rollers)
Rollers Rollers
Model No. Weight Model No. Weight
Inside Per Inside Per
OAW BR 199SRC (Lbs) OAW BR 199SRC (Lbs)
Radius Curve Radius Curve
Unplated 90º Unplated 45º
90º 45º
16" 13" 22 199SRC-13-90S 128 16" 13" 11 199SRC-13-45S 66
18" 15" 22 199SRC-15-90S 144 18" 15" 11 199SRC-15-45S 73
20" 17" 22 199SRC-17-90S 161 20" 17" 11 199SRC-17-45S 82
22" 19" 22 199SRC-19-90S 176 22" 19" 11 199SRC-19-45S 90
32 1/2" 32 1/2"
24" 21" 22 199SRC-21-90S 193 24" 21" 11 199SRC-21-45S 98
26" 23" 42 199SRC-23-90D 228 26" 23" 22 199SRC-23-45D 117
28" 25" 42 199SRC-25-90D 243 28" 25" 22 199SRC-25-45D 124
30" 27" 42 199SRC-27-90D 259 30" 27" 22 199SRC-27-45D 132
34" 31" 42 199SRC-31-90D 307 34" 31" 22 199SRC-31-45D 159
36" 33" 42 199SRC-33-90D 323 36" 33" 22 199SRC-33-45D 166
48" 48"
40" 37" 42 199SRC-37-90D 356 40" 37" 22 199SRC-37-45D 182
42" 39" 42 199SRC-39-90D 373 42" 39" 22 199SRC-39-45D 190
Rollers Rollers
Model No. Weight Model No. Weight
Inside Per Inside Per
OAW BR 199SRC (Lbs) BR 199SRC (Lbs)
Radius Curve OAW Radius Curve
Unplated 60º Unplated 30º
60º 30º
16" 13" 14 199SRC-13-60S 85 16" 13" 7 199SRC-13-30S 42
18" 15" 14OVERALL199SRC-15-60S
WIDTH 96 18" 15" 7 199SRC-15-30S 48
20" 17" 14
BETWEEN 199SRC-17-60S
RAIL WIDTH 107 20" 17" 7 199SRC-17-30S 53
22" 19" 14 199SRC-19-60S 117 22" 19" 7 199SRC-19-30S 58
32 1/2" 1-1/2" 32 1/2"
24" 21" 14 199SRC-21-60S 129 24" 21" 7 199SRC-21-30S 64
26" 23" 32 3/4" 199SRC-23-60D SIDE
152 26" 23" 12 199SRC-23-30D 75
CHANNEL
28" 25" 32 199SRC-25-60D 162 28" 25" 12 199SRC-25-30D 80
30" 27" 32 199SRC-27-60D 173
4-1/2" 30" 27" 12 199SRC-27-30D 86
34" 7/16" HEX
31" 32 199SRC-31-60D 205 34" 31" 18 199SRC-31-30D 101
SHAFT
36" 33" 32 199SRC-33-60D 215 36" 33" 18 199SRC-33-30D 107
48" 48"
40" 37" 32 199SRC-37-60D 237 40" 37" 18 199SRC-37-30D 118
42" 39" 32 199SRC-39-60D 248 42" 39" 18 199SRC-39-30D 123
OVERALL WIDTH
OVERALL WIDTH
BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH
1-1/2" 1-1/2"
1/4" 19GSR, 20SR
1/4" 199SRC SIDE
9/16" 2514SR SIDE
CHANNEL 3/4"
CHANNEL
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
WIDTHS–Between Rail Width: 13 in., 15 in., 17 in., 19 in., 21 in., 23 in., 25 in., 27 in., 31 in., 33 in.,
37 in., and 39 in. ROLLERS–(Straight) “199SRC” 1.9 in. dia. x 9 ga. unplated steel tubing. Bearings are labyrinth sealed
OVERALL WIDTH
and grease packed.
FRAME–3 1/2 in. or 4 1/2 in. deep x 1 1/2 in. flange x 10 ga. powder painted formed steel channel with BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH
bolt-in cross members. AXLES–7/16 in. hex shaft, spring1-1/2"
loaded.
1/4" 19GSR, 20SR
9/16" 2514SR SIDE
BUTT COUPLINGS–Bolt-on type for bolting sections together. CAPACITY– Same per foot capacity
CHANNELas straight sections. See charts previous page.
CURVES– 30°, 45°, 60° and 90° with 32 1/2 in. inside radius for widths up to 27 in., 48 in. inside
7/16" HEX 3-1/2"
radius for 31 in. to 39 in. between rail widths.
SHAFT
CATALOG | 08312018
ROLLER
Gravity Roller Spurs are used to transfer products from one
Gravity Roller Spur
(1 3/8 in. Dia. x 18 Ga. Rollers)
• 4 Widths
conveying line to another. They can be used in merging or • Powder Painted Steel or Aluminum Frames
diverging applications. Ideally used where numerous lines • Right & Left Hand Units Conveyor shown with
must transfer onto a main conveyor line, from work stations • Butt Couplings on One End optional floor supports
or other similar operations.
• 30°, 45°, & 90° Spurs Available
Between Overall
Wgt. Model Wgt. Model Wgt.
STEEL FRAMES
Between Overall
Wgt. Model Wgt. Model Wgt.
Rail Frame Model No. "A" "B" "C"
(Lbs.) No. (Lbs.) No. (Lbs.)
Width Width
10" 12" SARS-12-30 24" 40 SARS-12-45 18" 41 SARS-12-90 35" 33
13" 15" SARS-15-30 30" 46 SARS-15-45 22" 48 SARS-15-90 35" 35
16" 18" SARS-18-30 36" 50 SARS-18-45 26" 52 SARS-18-90 35" 37
22" 24" SARS-24-30 48" 58 SARS-24-45 35" 63 SARS-24-90 50" 41
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
NOTE: When “Between Rail Widths” exceed 21”, double rollers are supplied standard on 90˚ spurs.
1-1 60"
1/2
60" RADIUS
1-
"A"
SECTION “X-X”
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
WIDTHS–12 in., 15 in., 18 in., & 24 in. overall. SPUR ANGLE–30°, 45°, 90° right or left hand applications, specify.
FRAME–2 1/2 in. deep x 1 in. flange x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel or 1/8 in. heat-treated ROLLERS–1 3/8 in. dia. x 18 ga. galvanized steel tubing. Spring loaded axle allows roller to be easily
aluminum channel with bolt-in cross members. removed or inserted.
COUPLINGS–Butt Coupling on one end, spur angle on opposite end. Mounting bracket available, AXLES–1/4 in. dia. round
specify.
CAPACITY–Same per foot capacity as straight sections. See Gravity Roller Conveyor.
CATALOG | 08312018
ROLLER
Gravity Roller Spurs are used to transfer products from one
Gravity Roller Conveyor
(1.9 in. Dia. x 16 Ga. Galvanized Rollers)
(1.9 in. Dia. x 9 Ga. Rollers)
• 12 Widths
90˚ SPUR
SHOWN IN
PHOTO
conveying line to another. They can be used in merging or • 30°, 45°, & 90° Spurs Available OVERALL WIDTH
diverging applications. Ideally used where numerous lines • Right or Left Hand Units BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH
must transfer onto a main conveyor line.
1-1/2"
3/4" SIDE
CHANNEL
"D"
3" 6' 9" 5' "R" 90˚
3"
CATALOG | 08312018
ROLLER Gravity Roller Conveyor
(2 1/2 in. Dia. x 11 Ga. Rollers)
(2 5/8 in. Dia. x 7 Ga. Rollers)
3/4" 1-5/8"
4" X 4 GA.
11/16" STEEL CHANNEL 4" X 4 GA.
HEX SHAFT SET HIGH 11/16" STEEL CHANNEL
HEX SHAFT SET LOW
CATALOG | 08312018
ROLLER
Heavy-duty gravity roller curve conveyors add versatility to
Gravity Roller Curve Conveyor
(2 1/2 in. Dia. x 11 Ga. Rollers)
(2 5/8 in. Dia. x 7 Ga. Rollers)
DE
straight gravity roller conveyors. Curves are supplied with 2 INSI IUS
A D
1/2 in. dia. rollers mounted in a powder painted steel channel. R
Curves may be furnished with rollers set high, or with rollers
set low to form 3/4 in. high guard rails.
Rollers Rollers
Model No. Weight Model No. Weight Model No. Weight Model No. Weight
Inside Per Inside Per
OAW BR 25SRC (Lbs) 26SRC (Lbs) OAW BR 25SRC (Lbs) 26SRC (Lbs)
Radius Curve Radius Curve
2 1/2" Rollers 90º 2 5/8" Rollers 90º 2 1/2" Rollers 45º 2 5/8" Rollers 45º
90º 45º
16 1/4" 13" 25SRC-13-90S 170 26SRC-13-90S 196 16 1/4" 13" 25SRC-13-45S 91 26SRC-13-45S 104
18 1/4" 15" 25SRC-15-90S 185 26SRC-15-90S 216 18 1/4" 15" 25SRC-15-45S 98 26SRC-15-45S 113
20 1/4" 17" 25SRC-17-90S 200 26SRC-17-90S 235 20 1/4" 17" 25SRC-17-45S 106 26SRC-17-45S 123
22 1/4" 19" 16 25SRC-19-90S 212 26SRC-19-90S 252 22 1/4" 19" 8 25SRC-19-45S 113 26SRC-19-45S 133
32 1/2" 32 1/2"
24 1/4" 21" Single 25SRC-21-90S 230 26SRC-21-90S 274 24 1/4" 21" Single 25SRC-21-45S 121 26SRC-21-45S 143
26 1/4" 23" 25SRC-23-90S 245 26SRC-23-90S 294 26 1/4" 23" 25SRC-23-45S 128 26SRC-23-45S 152
28 1/4" 25" 25SRC-25-90S 260 26SRC-25-90S 313 28 1/4" 25" 25SRC-25-45S 136 26SRC-25-45S 162
30 1/4" 27" 25SRC-27-90S 276 26SRC-27-90S 333 30 1/4" 27" 25SRC-27-45S 143 26SRC-27-45S 172
34 1/4" 31" 25SRC-31-90D 432 26SRC-31-90D 505 34 1/4" 31" 25SRC-31-45D 311 26SRC-31-45D 349
36 1/4" 33" 25SRC-33-90D 451 26SRC-33-90D 530 36 1/4" 33" 25SRC-33-45D 323 26SRC-33-45D 363
40 1/4" 37" 25SRC-37-90D 589 26SRC-37-90D 578 40 1/4" 37" 25SRC-37-45D 348 26SRC-37-45D 393
37 19
42 1/4" 39" 48" 25SRC-39-90D 508 26SRC-39-90D 602 42 1/4" 39" 48" 25SRC-39-45D 360 26SRC-39-45D 408
Double Double
46 1/4" 43" 25SRC-43-90D 546 26SRC-43-90D 650 46 1/4" 43" 25SRC-43-45D 385 26SRC-39-45D 438
50 1/4" 47" 25SRC-47-90D 583 26SRC-47-90D 697 50 1/4" 47" 25SRC-47-45D 408 26SRC-47-45D 467
54 1/4" 51" 25SRC-51-90D 622 26SRC-51-90D 746 54 1/4" 51" 25SRC-51-45D 434 26SRC-51-45D 498
Rollers Rollers
Model No. Weight Model No. Weight Model No. Weight Model No. Weight
Inside Per Inside Per
OAW BR 25SRC (Lbs) 26SRC (Lbs) OAW BR 25SRC (Lbs) 26SRC (Lbs)
Radius Curve Radius Curve
2 1/2" Rollers 60º 2 5/8" Rollers 60º 2 1/2" Rollers 30º 2 5/8" Rollers 30º
60º 30º
16 1/4" 13" 25SRC-13-60S 128 26SRC-13-60S 147 16 1/4" 13" 25SRC-13-30S 57 26SRC-13-30S 65
18 1/4" 15" 25SRC-15-60S 138 26SRC-15-60S 162 18 1/4" 15" 25SRC-15-30S 61 26SRC-15-30S 72
20 1/4" 17" 25SRC-17-60S 150 26SRC-17-60S 177 20 1/4" 17" 25SRC-17-30S 66 26SRC-17-30S 78
22 1/4" 19" 10 25SRC-19-60S 159 26SRC-19-60S 189 22 1/4" 19" 5 25SRC-19-30S 70 26SRC-19-30S 84
32 1/2" 32 1/2"
24 1/4" 21" Single 25SRC-21-60S 173 26SRC-21-60S 205 24 1/4" 21" Single 25SRC-21-30S 75 26SRC-21-30S 91
26 1/4" 23" 25SRC-23-60S 183 26SRC-23-60S 221 26 1/4" 23" 25SRC-23-30S 81 26SRC-23-30S 97
28 1/4" 25" 25SRC-25-60S 195 26SRC-25-60S 235 28 1/4" 25" 25SRC-25-30S 86 26SRC-25-30S 103
30 1/4" 27" 25SRC-27-60S 207 26SRC-27-60S 250 30 1/4" 27" 25SRC-27-30S 91 26SRC-27-30S 110
34 1/4" 31" 25SRC-31-60D 324 26SRC-31-60D 378 34 1/4" 31" 25SRC-31-30D 143 26SRC-31-30D 167
36 1/4" 33" 25SRC-33-60D 339 26SRC-33-60D 398 36 1/4" 33" 25SRC-33-30D 148 26SRC-33-30D 175
40 1/4" 37" 25SRC-37-60D 366 26SRC-37-60D 433 40 1/4" 37" 25SRC-37-30D 161 26SRC-37-30D 191
23 13
42 1/4" 39" 48" 25SRC-39-60D 381 26SRC-39-60D 451 42 1/4" 39" 48" 25SRC-39-30D 167 26SRC-39-30D 198
Double Double
46 1/4" 43" 25SRC-43-60D 410 26SRC-43-60D 488 46 1/4" 43" 25SRC-43-30D 181 26SRC-43-30D 215
50 1/4" 47" 25SRC-47-60D 438 26SRC-47-60D 523 50 1/4" 47" 25SRC-47-30D 192 26SRC-47-30D 230
54 1/4" 51" 25SRC-51-60D 467 26SRC-51-60D 559 54 1/4" 51" 25SRC-51-30D 205 26SRC-51-30D 246
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
OVERALL WIDTH OVERALL WIDTH
BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH
3/8" 1-5/8" 1-5/8"
WIDTHS–Between Rail Width 13 in., 15 in., 17 in., 19 in., 21 in., 23 in., 25 in., 27 3/4"
in., 31 in., 33 in., 37 in., and 39 in., 43 in., 47 in., & 51 in. 4" X 4 GA.
STEEL CHANNEL 4" X 4 GA.
11/16" STEEL CHANNEL
FRAME–4 in. deep x 1 5/8 in. flange x 4 ga. powder painted formed steel channel HEX SHAFT SET HIGH 11/16" SET LOW
with bolt-in cross members set high, welded cross members set low. HEX SHAFT
(13”—27” BR)
BUTT COUPLINGS–For bolting sections together.
OVERALL WIDTH
CURVES–30°, 45°, 60°and 90° with 32 1/2 in. inside radius up to 27 in., 48 in. BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH
inside radius on 31 in. to 51 in. between rail widths. OVERALL WIDTH
3/4"
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
1-5/8"
BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH
ROLLERS–25-SRC 2 1/2 in. dia. x 11 ga. steel tubing. Bearings are labyrinth sealed 4" X 4 GA.
and grease packed. 3/4" 1-5/8"
STEEL CHANNEL
FRAME–4 in. x 5.4 lb. powder painted structural steel
AXLES–11/16 in. hex shaft, spring loaded. channel, with welded cross members. 4" X 4 GA. 1-1/2"*
11/16" STEEL CHANNEL
11/16" HEX SHAFT
HEX SHAFT
CAPACITY–Same per foot capacity as straight sections. See charts previous page. SET LOW FRAME SPACER
OVERALL WIDTH
BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH
1-5/8"
3/8"
39" E
4" X 4 GA.
STEEL CHANNEL
D
INSI IUS
11/16" HEX. SHAFT
R A D 1-1/2"
FRAME SPACER
DEGREE
SET HIGH (ONLY)
CATALOG | 08312018
ROLLER
Gravity Roller Spurs are used to transfer products from one
Gravity Roller Conveyor
(1.9 in. Dia. x 16 Ga. Galvanized Rollers)
(1.9 in. Dia. x 9 Ga. Rollers)
• 12 Widths
90˚ SPUR
SHOWN IN
PHOTO
conveying line to another. They can be used in merging or • 30°, 45°, & 90° Spurs Available OVERALL WIDTH
diverging applications. Ideally used where numerous lines • Right or Left Hand Units BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH
must transfer onto a main conveyor line.
1-1/2"
3/4" SIDE
CHANNEL
"D"
3" 6' 9" 5' "R" 90˚
3"
CATALOG | 08312018
ROLLER
HYTROL heavy-duty roller conveyor Model 36-SR is designed
Gravity Roller Conveyor
(3 1/2 in. Dia. x .300 Rollers)
51"
36SR-51-6
36SR-51-8
6"
8"
1431
1131
719
567 • OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
36SR-51-12 12" 831 417
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. BEARINGS–Can be supplied with Teflon seals, regreaseable.
Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
HEAVY-DUTY BEARINGS–2500 lbs. capacity.
CATALOG | 08312018
199-CRR
The Model 199-CRR is a medium-duty chain driven live roller
Chain Driven Live Roller Conveyor
• 11 Bed Widths
conveyor. The roll-to-roll chain drive makes this conveyor • Center Drive
Conveyor shown with
ideal for light to medium duty pallet handling or oily conditions • Reversible optional floor supports
which are not suitable for belt driven live roller. • Chain Driven Rollers
• Adjustable MSN-Type Floor Supports Available
Conveying
12 1/4" 14 1/4" 16 1/4" 18 1/4" 20 1/4" 22 1/4" 24 1/4" 28 1/4" 30 1/4" 34 1/4" 36 1/4"
Surface
Between
15" 17" 19" 21" 23" 25" 27" 31" 33" 37" 39"
Rail Width
Overall
18" 20" 22" 24" 26" 28" 30" 34" 36" 40" 42"
Frame Width
Base
655 680 705 730 755 780 805 855 880 930 955
Weight
Weight (Lbs.) Per Foot
51 53 55 57 59 61 63 67 69 72 75
4" Roller Centers
Weight (Lbs.) Per Foot
46 47 49 51 52 54 55 59 60 63 65
6" Roller Centers
OVERALL LENGTH
18" "X"
FLOW
1-3/4"
9-13/16" "X"
OPTIONAL MSN
SUPPORTS SHOWN
OVERALL FRAME
WIDTH
BETWEEN RAIL 2-3/4"
WIDTH
CONVEYING
SURFACE
1/4" 1-5/32" 13/16"
3-1/2" 4-3/4"
16-15/16"
13-3/16"
SECTION X-X
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 199-CRR
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. x 9 ga. wall unplated tread rollers spaced every 4 in. or 6 in. mounted SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer.
in 7 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame bolted together with butt couplings.
MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
CENTER DRIVE–Mounted underneath bed section.
CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 35 FPM.
ROLLER CHAIN–No. 40 roller-to-roller chain.
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 150 lbs. with supports on 10 ft. centers,
MOTOR DRIVE CHAIN–No. 60 chain. 250 lbs. per ft. with supports on 5 ft. centers and 4 in. roller centers. NOT TO EXCEED capacity in
charts.
CHAIN GUARD–Mounted to top of channel frame to totally enclose drive chain.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated ball bearings on drive roller shaft.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MSN Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in CHAIN CROSSOVER–Move driving chain from one side to opposite side.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MSN-6 support.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, (both sides) fixed channel (both sides) or
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. NOTE: Capacity affected with speed angle (one side). See Accessory section .
change.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
SHAFT MOUNTED DRIVE–Requires shaft mounted gearmotor. Minimum elevation top of rollers
6 in. CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
rods available.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
regular lubrication). MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor. 2 HP maximum.
ROLLERS SET LOW–Tread rollers mounted in 4 3/4 in. x 10 ga. formed steel channel frame to form ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starters and
1 in. high guard rails. push-button stations. AC variable frequency drive.
CATALOG | 08312018
ROLLER
HYTROL heavy-duty roller conveyor Model 36-SR is designed
Gravity Roller Conveyor
(3 1/2 in. Dia. x .300 Rollers)
51"
36SR-51-6
36SR-51-8
6"
8"
1431
1131
719
567 • OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
36SR-51-12 12" 831 417
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. BEARINGS–Can be supplied with Teflon seals, regreaseable.
Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
HEAVY-DUTY BEARINGS–2500 lbs. capacity.
CATALOG | 08312018
25-CRR
The heavy design of the 25-CRR allows it to be used for
Chain Driven Live Roller Conveyor
•
(Roll-to-Roll Type)
15 Bed Widths
conveying higher load capacities such as loaded pallets and • Center Drive
drums. Chain driven rollers make it ideal for conveying oily • Reversible
parts in bottling and steel industries. • Chain Driven Rollers Conveyor shown
with optional floor
• Adjustable HSN-Type Floor Supports Available
supports
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 25-CRR
BED–Roller bed with 2 1/2 in. dia. x 11 ga. unplated tread rollers spaced every 4 in. with No. 40 BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated ball bearings.
roller chain; 5 in. with No. 50 roller chain. No. 60 roller chain used on 3 in., 3 3/4 in., 6 in., and 7 1/2
in. roller centers only. Tread rollers mounted in 4 in. x 4 ga. powder painted formed steel channel SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer.
on side opposite chain guard and 6 in. x 4 ga. powder painted formed steel channel on chain
guard side. NOTE: 3 in. roller center tread rollers mounted in 4 in. channel each side. MOTOR–1 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Premium Energy Efficient C-Face.
CENTER DRIVE–Can be placed in any section of conveyor length, specify. Chain guard located on CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 30 FPM.
left hand side.
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 300 lbs. with supports on 10 ft. centers,
DRIVE CHAIN–No. 40, 50 or 60 roller chain. 1000 lbs. with supports on 5 ft. centers. Contact factory for capacity of No. 40 chain, 4 in. roller
centers. NOT TO EXCEED CAPACITY IN CHART.
CHAIN GUARD–Formed steel, upper and lower chain guard mounted to top and bottom of
channel frame to totally enclose drive chains. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
BETWEEN
RAIL WIDTH
OVERALL LENGTH "A" *SEE CONVEYING
NOTE SURFACE FRAME
"X" "Y" SPACER
1-7/8"
12"
"X" "Y" 1-3/4"
*NOTE:
OPTIONAL 3 1/4” FOR 4”, 5”, 6”, and 7 1/2” CENTERS.
15-1/4"
ALLOW HSN SUPPORTS SHOWN SECTION Y-Y 6 1/2” FOR 3 3/4” CENTERS ONLY.
22-1/2" (5' SECTION) 3 1/4” ON BOTH SIDES FOR 3” CENTERS.
52-1/2" (10' SECTION) 16"
BETWEEN BETWEEN
OVERALL NO. 40A21, RAIL WIDTH
NO. 50A18, RAIL WIDTH
FRAME WIDTH *SEE *SEE CONVEYING
OR CONVEYING NOTE
1-5/8" NO. 60A16 NOTE SURFACE FRAME SURFACE FRAME
UPPER
3/8" CHAIN SPROCKETS SPACER SPACER
GUARD
1-5/8" 1-7/8"
6"
4" LOWER LOWER
CHAIN 5-7/8" CHAIN 6-1/8"
GUARD GUARD
20-1/8"
18-1/2"
14-1/8"
1-1/2" 1-3/4"
FLOOR SUPPORTS–HSN Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in feet GUARD RAILS–Fixed angle (2 in. high x 1/4 in. steel) guard bolts to top flange of channel opposite
for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above HSN-3 support. chain guard.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. V-belt supplied on speeds under 12 FPM (1 CHANNEL END STOP–6” x 8.2 lb. structural channel end stop.
HP). NOTE: Capacity affected with speed change.
ROLLERS SET LOW–Tread rollers mounted in 6 in. x 4 ga. formed steel channel frame to form 1 5/8 in.
TOP SIDE MOUNTED DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor with drive chain high guard rails. Also available in 5 in. x 6.7 lbs. structural channel frame (welded). Specify.
through top of chain guard. Specify clearances. Minimum elevation top of rollers 6 1/2 in.
CHAIN CROSSOVER–Separate 3-roller section moves driving chain from one side of conveyor to
V-BELT DRIVE–V-belt supplied between motor and reducer. other. Offset-style adds 9 in. with 3" roller centers, 12 in. to OAL of conveyor with 4" roller centers, 15
in. with 5" roller centers, & 18 in. with 6" roller centers.
SHAFT MOUNTED DRIVE–Mounted to side of conveyor complete with torque arm. Minimum
elevation to top of rollers is 6 1/2 in. TRANSFERS–Chain transfers available. See Accessory section.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that MOTORS–Single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
do not permit regular lubrication).
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starter – push-
FRAMES–4 in. X 5.4 lb. structural channel (welded). button stations. AC variable frequency drive.
CATALOG | 08312018
26-CRR
The heavy design of the 26-CRR allows it to be used for
Chain Driven Live Roller Conveyor
•
(Roll-to-Roll Type)
15 Bed Widths
conveying higher load capacities such as loaded pallets and • Center Drive
drums. Chain driven rollers make it ideal for conveying oily • Reversible
parts in bottling and steel industries. • Chain Driven Rollers
• Adjustable HSN-Type Floor Supports Available Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
BETWEEN
OVERALL LENGTH "A" RAIL WIDTH
*SEE CONVEYING
NOTE SURFACE FRAME
"X" "Y" SPACER
1-7/8"
20-1/8" 18-1/2" LOWER
TOP OF 13" 14-1/8" 6-1/8"
ROLLERS MAX. CHAIN
GUARD
12"
"X" "Y" 1-3/4"
*NOTE:
15-1/4" OPTIONAL 3 1/4” FOR 4”, 5”, 6”, and 71/2” CENTERS.
ALLOW HSN SUPPORTS SHOWN 61/2” FOR 3 3/4” CENTERS ONLY.
22-1/2" (5' SECTION)
52-1/2" (10' SECTION) 16" SECTION Y-Y 3 1/4” ON BOTH SIDES FOR 3” CENTERS.
BETWEEN BETWEEN
OVERALL NO. 40A21, RAIL WIDTH
NO. 50A18, RAIL WIDTH
FRAME WIDTH *SEE *SEE CONVEYING
OR CONVEYING NOTE
1-5/8" NO. 60A16 NOTE SURFACE FRAME SURFACE FRAME
UPPER
3/8" CHAIN SPROCKETS SPACER SPACER
GUARD
1-5/8" 1-7/8"
6"
4" LOWER LOWER
CHAIN 5-7/8" CHAIN 6-1/8"
GUARD GUARD
20-1/8"
18-1/2"
14-1/8"
1-1/2" 1-3/4"
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 26-CRR
BED–Roller bed with 2 5/8 in. dia. x 7 ga. unplated tread rollers spaced every 4 in. with No. 40 BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated ball bearings.
roller chain; 5 in. with No. 50 roller chain. No. 60 roller chain used on 3 in., 3 3/4 in., 6 in., and 7 1/2
in. roller centers only. Tread rollers mounted in 4 in. x 4 ga. powder painted formed steel channel SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer.
on side opposite chain guard and 6 in. x 4 ga. powder painted formed steel channel on chain
guard side. NOTE: 3 in. roller center tread rollers mounted in 4 in. channel each side. MOTOR–1 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Premium Energy Efficient C-Face.
CENTER DRIVE–Can be placed in any section of conveyor length, specify. Chain guard located on CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 30 FPM.
left hand side.
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 300 lbs. with supports on 10 ft. centers,
DRIVE CHAIN–No. 40, 50 or 60 roller chain. 1000 lbs. with supports on 5 ft. centers. Contact factory for capacity of No. 40 chain, 4 in. roller
centers. NOT TO EXCEED CAPACITY IN CHART.
CHAIN GUARD–Formed steel, upper and lower chain guard mounted to top and bottom of
channel frame to totally enclose drive chains. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
1 9000 6000
2 22000 18000
NOTE: Capacities are calculated on 5” Roller Centers with #50 Chain.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–HSN Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in feet GUARD RAILS–Fixed angle (2 in. high x 1/4 in. steel) guard bolts to top flange of channel opposite
for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above HSN-3 support. chain guard.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. V-belt supplied on speeds under 12 FPM (1 CHANNEL END STOP–6” x 8.2 lb. structural channel end stop.
HP). Note: Capacity affected with speed change.
ROLLERS SET LOW–Tread rollers mounted in 6 in. x 4 ga. formed steel channel frame to form 1 5/8 in.
TOP SIDE MOUNTED DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor with drive chain high guard rails. Also available in 5 in. x 6.7 lbs. structural channel frame (welded). Specify.
through top of chain guard. Specify clearances. Minimum elevation top of rollers 6 1/2 in.
CHAIN CROSSOVER–Separate 3-roller section moves driving chain from one side of conveyor to
V-BELT DRIVE–V-belt supplied between motor and reducer. other. Offset-style adds 12 in. to OAL of conveyor with No. 40 chain, 15 in. with No. 50 chain & 18
in. with No. 60 chain.
SHAFT MOUNTED DRIVE–Mounted to side of conveyor complete with torque arm. Minimum
elevation to top of rollers is 6 1/2 in. TRANSFERS–Chain transfers available. See Accessory section.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit MOTORS–Single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
regular lubrication).
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starter – push-
FRAMES–4 in. X 5.4 lb. structural channel (welded). button stations. AC variable frequency drive.
CATALOG | 08312018
25-CRR
The heavy design of the 25-CRR allows it to be used for
Chain Driven Live Roller Conveyor
•
(Roll-to-Roll Type)
15 Bed Widths
conveying higher load capacities such as loaded pallets and • Center Drive
drums. Chain driven rollers make it ideal for conveying oily • Reversible
parts in bottling and steel industries. • Chain Driven Rollers Conveyor shown
with optional floor
• Adjustable HSN-Type Floor Supports Available
supports
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 25/26-CRRC
BED–Roller bed with 2 1/2 in. dia. x 11 ga. unplated rollers mounted in BUTT COUPLINGS–Standard for connecting to 25-CRR, 2 1/2 in. dia. or 2 5/8 in. dia. gravity roller
4 in. x 4 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame. conveyor.
DRIVE–Mounted underneath, placed near center of conveyor. SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer.
DRIVE CHAIN–No. 50 circular roller chain. MOTOR–1 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Premium Energy Efficient C-Face.
CHAIN GUARD–Formed steel, upper and lower chain guard mounted to top and bottom of CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 30 FPM.
channel frame to totally enclose drive chains.
CAPACITY–4000 lbs. total distributed live load at 30 FPM.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated ball bearings.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–HSN Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify GUARD RAILS–Fixed angle (2 in. high x 1/4 in. steel) guard bolts to top of flange of channel opposite
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in chain guard.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above HSN-3 support.
ROLLERS SET LOW–Use angle guard rail.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. V-belt drive supplied on speeds under 12
FPM (1 HP). Note: Capacity affected with speed change. TREAD ROLLERS–2 5/8 in. dia. x 7 ga. steel, 11/16 in. hex spring-loaded shaft (26-CRRC).
TOP SIDE MOUNTED DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor with drive chain MOTORS–Single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 1 HP maximum.
through top of chain guard. Specify clearances. Minimum elevation top of rollers 6 1/2 in.
TANGENTS–Lengths available on 5 in. increments (5 in. roller centers) up to 45 in. OAL. Other roller
V-BELT DRIVE–V-belt supplied between motor and reducer. centers and lengths available (jackshaft required), contact factory.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing or reversible magnetic starters and push-button stations.
regular lubrication). AC variable frequency drive.
CATALOG | 08312018
25-CRRCT
The Model 25-CRRCT is a heavy-duty, chain driven live roller •
Chain Driven Live Tapered
Roller Curve Conveyor
16 Widths
(Roll-to-Roll Type)
SECTION A-A
ROLLER BETWEEN
RAIL WIDTH
BED
FRAME CONVEYING
SPACER SURFACE
3-1/4"
2" 1-5/8"
18-1/8" 1-5/8" 50A18
12-1/8" SPROCKETS
5-7/8" LOWER
OPTIONAL CHAIN
HSN SUPPORTS GUARD
KNEE
SHOWN BRACE 1-1/2"
SECTION B-B
ALLOW
16"
"B"
14-1/2" ALLOW
"OR"
ALLOW ALLOW 16"
"A" 16" 16"
60˚ 45˚
7-3/4" 30˚
"B" 7-3/4" 7-3/4"
39"
"A"
25"
90˚ 25" 25"
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 25-CRRCT
BED–Roller bed with unplated tread rollers mounted in 4 in. x 4 ga. powder painted formed steel SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer.
frame. (See dimension chart for roller details.)
MOTOR–1 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Premium Energy Efficient C-Face.
CENTER DRIVE–Mounted underneath bed section.
CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 30 FPM.
DRIVE CHAIN–No. 50 circular roller chain.
CAPACITY–4000 lbs. total distributed live load at 30 FPM.
CHAIN GUARD–Formed steel, upper and lower chain guard mounted to top and bottom of
channel frame to totally enclose drive chains. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated ball bearings. TANGENTS–25 in. long tangent on 30, 45 and 60 degree curves.
BUTT COUPLINGS–Standard for connecting to 25-CRR, 2 1/2 in. dia. or 2 5/8 in. dia. gravity roller
conveyor.
OPTIONAL
STRUCTURAL
CHANNEL SHOWN
Chain Roll-To-Roll design provides positive drive of tapered tread rollers. Chain Guard
removed to illustrate Roll-To-Roll Drive Chain.
WARNING: Do not operate conveyor with Chain Guard removed.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–HSN Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify FRAMES–4 in. x 5.4 lb. structural channel.
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above HSN-3 support. GUARD RAILS–Fixed angle (2 in. high x 1/4 in. steel) guard bolts to top flange of channel opposite
chain guard.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. V-belt drive supplied under 12 FPM (1 HP).
Note: Capacity affected with speed change. MOTORS–Single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 1 HP maximum.
TOP SIDE MOUNTED DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor with drive chain SLAVE DRIVEN–Requires jackshaft.
through top of chain guard. Specify clearances. Minimum elevation top of rollers 6 1/2 in.
TANGENTS–Lengths available on 5 in. increments (5 in. roller centers) up to 45 in. OAL. Other roller
V-BELT DRIVE–V-Belt supplied between motor and reducer. centers and lengths available (jackshaft required), contact factory.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starters and push-button stations. AC variable
regular lubrication). frequency drive.
CATALOG | 08312018
36-CRRH
The Model 36-CRRH is a heavy-duty, chain driven roller
Heavy Duty Chain Driven
Live Roller with Hex Shaft
•
(Roll-to-Roll Type)
12 Bed Widths
Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
Conveying Surface 19 3/4" 21 3/4" 23 3/4" 27 3/4" 29 3/4" 33 3/4" 35 3/4" 41 3/4" 47 3/4" 53 3/4" 55 3/4" 63 3/4"
SIZE TO ORDER
Between Rail Width 23" 25" 27" 31" 33" 37" 39" 45" 51" 57" 59" 67"
Overall Length
"A" Overall Frame
26 27/32" 28 27/32" 30 27/32" 34 27/32" 36 27/32" 40 27/32" 42 27/32" 48 27/32" 54 27/32" 60 27/32" 62 27/32" 70 27/32"
Width
10' 1284 1336 1387 1490 1541 1644 1695 1849 2003 2157 2208 2412
6" R/C
Per Foot 99 103 107 115 119 127 131 143 155 167 186 206
10' 1044 1076 1108 1172 1204 1268 1300 1396 1492 1588 1620 1748
12" R/C
Per Foot 75 78 81 87 90 96 99 108 117 126 129 141
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
7-1/4"
Roller
“B”
11-1/2" (2 HP) OVERALL FRAME Centers
13-1/4" (3 HP) WIDTH
6” 22 3/4”
TOTALLLY BETWEEN
1-3/4" 12” 25 3/4”
ENCLOSED RAIL WIDTH
CHAIN GUARD
3-1/4" CONVEYING
MOTOR SURFACE
REDUCER
DRIVE 1-1/8"
5-11/32"
3/8"
14-3/4" (2HP)
16" (3 HP) 5"
9"
7" X 9.8 LB
STRUCTURAL CHANNEL
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 36-CRRH
BED–Roller bed with 3 1/2 in. x .300 in. wall unplated tread rollers with 1 1/16 in. hex shaft spaced SPEED REDUCTION–Heavy-duty sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 80 roller chain to
every 6 in. or 12 in. Mounted in 5 ft. long powder painted structural steel channel frame bolted drive shaft.
together with butt couplings.
MOTOR–2 HP–230/460V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Energy Efficient C-Face motor and AC Variable Speed
CENTER DRIVE–Top side mounted drive, mounted to 5 ft. long section near center of conveyor. controller with softstart capability.
Chain guard located on left hand side.
CONVEYING SPEED–Variable 3-30 FPM.
DRIVE CHAIN–No. 60 roller chain.
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 2000 lbs. with supports on 5 ft. centers.
CHAIN GUARD–Formed steel upper & lower chain guard mounted to top and bottom of channel NOT TO EXCEED CAPACITY IN CHART.
frame to totally enclose drive chains.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated ball bearings.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–HSF Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify MOTORS–3 HP maximum.
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above HSF-6 support. ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Push-button stations.
CATALOG | 08312018
199-CREZD
Conveyor shown
with optional floor
Heavy Duty Accumulating Conveyor supports
Conveying
12 1/4" 14 1/4" 16 1/4" 18 1/4" 20 1/4" 22 1/4" 24 1/4" 28 1/4" 30 1/4" 34 1/4" 36 1/4"
Surface
Between Rail
15" 17" 19" 21" 23" 25" 27" 31" 33" 37" 39" U.S. Patent Numbers
Width
7,243,781 • 7,591,366
Overall Frame 7,905,345 • 6,860,381
18" 20" 22" 24" 26" 28" 30" 34" 36" 40" 42"
Width Other Patents Pending.
Weight (Lbs.)
Per Foot 4" 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 67 69 73 75
Roller Centers
Weight (Lbs.)
Per Foot 6" 46 48 50 52 54 56 58 62 64 66 68
Roller Centers
Total Weight = (Number of Zones x 30) + (OAL x Weight Per Foot)
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc. are not included.
HOW IT WORKS
The conveyor is made up of accumulation zones. Each zone
contains an individual zone drive interfaced to Hytrol’s EZLogic®
Zone Controllers, which sense product presence and control the
IOP FLOW accumulation and release of the zones by starting and stopping
the zone drives.
OVERALL LENGTH
ZONE LENGTH
“X”
“X”
OPTIONAL MSN
SUPPORTS SHOWN
DISCONNECT PANEL EZDrive™
(SINGLE OUTPUT SHOWN) ZONE STARTER BOX
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 199-CREZD
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. x 9 ga. unplated rollers spaced every 4 or 6 in. Tread rollers EZLOGIC ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone (Retro-Reflective). NEMA 1, 2, IP 62. UL
®
mounted in 3 1/2 in. x 7 ga. formed channel on side opposite chain guard and 4 3/4 in. x 7 ga. formed Approved.
channel on chain guard side. Bolted together with butt couplings.
IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
DRIVE CHAIN–No. 40 roller-to-roller. input/output boards. Should be located near disconnect panel. See chart for maximum quantity
of zones. Requires 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
CHAIN GUARD–Formed steel guards totally enclose drive chains.
CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 35 FPM.
EZDriveTM System–Shaft mounted gearmotor located near center of each zone. 1/3 HP - 3 PH 60
Hz. Totally enclosed fan cooled. 230/460 V (specify voltage). Includes EZDriveTM Disconnect Panel. CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 150 lbs. with supports on 10 ft. centers, 250
Power is distributed zone to zone through pluggable cordsets. Power is connected from the starter lbs. per ft. with supports on 5 ft. centers. Not to exceed 1300 lbs per zone. Zones longer than 6 ft.
box to the motor via “SO” type cord. Please contact factory if local code requires other than the may require an additional floor support depending on product load.
standard power distribution techniques described.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–4 in. roller centers, 32 in. to 120 in. on 4 in. increments. 6 in. centers, 30
in. to 120 in. on 6 in. increments. Frame length changes with zone length. DISCONNECT 230V 460V
PANEL 3 Ph. 60 Hz 3 Ph. 60 Hz
INFEED EYE IOP EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER SINGLE OUTPUT 1-8 ZONES 1-15 ZONES F
L
DUAL OUTPUT 9-16 ZONES 16-22 ZONES O
W
F F
L L
O O
W W
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always used
at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Sleep Feature – Stops tread rollers from turning when no product is present, reducing noise, reducing energy consumption and extending roller bearing life.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from a removed load, preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are routinely removed
from the conveyor with a lift truck.
REFLECTIVE
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and stops the zone from driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering loading
area.
DTH
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
TH FLOOR SUPPORTS–MSN Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
FACE feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MSN-6 support. CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
rods available.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. Note: Capacity affected with speed
change. EZDriveTM System:
• Variable Frequency Drive–for adjusting conveying speed or adjusting acceleration and
ROLLERS SET LOW–Tread rollers mounted in 4 3/4 in. x 7 ga. formed steel channel frame to form 1 deceleration time.
OR 1/4 in. high guard rails.
EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
DIFFUSE GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, (both sides) fixed channel (both sides) or
angle (one side).
LER (OPTIONAL)
CATALOG | 08312018
25-CREZD
The Model 25-CREZD is a chain driven live roller conveyor •
Heavy Duty Accumulating Conveyor
(Zero Pressure Accumulating Type)
EZDriveTM System (Individual zone drive)
Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
designed for zero pressure accumulation of products. This • EZLogic® Accumulation System
conveyor is designed to handle loads such as pallets, drums, • Chain Driven Rollers
containers, etc. Products may be accumulated in zones and • Shaft Mounted Drive
released upon request.
• Adjustable HSN-Type Floor Supports Available
IOP FLOW
OVERALL LENGTH
ZONE LENGTH “X”
EZLOGIC® DIFFUSE
EZLOGIC® DIFFUSE ZONE CONTROLLER (OPTIONAL)
CONTROLLER (OPTIONAL)
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 25-CREZD
BED–Roller bed with 2 1/2 in. dia. x 11 ga. unplated rollers spaced every 4 or 6 in. Tread rollers ACCUMULATION ZONES–4 in. roller centers, 32 in. to 120 in. on 4 in. increments. 3 in. and 6 in.
mounted in 4 in. x 4 ga. formed channel on side opposite chain guard and 6 in. x 4 ga. formed roller centers, 30 in. to 120 in. on 6 in. increments. 5 in. roller centers, 30 in. to 120 in. on 5 in.
channel on chain guard side. Bolted together with butt couplings. increments. Frame length changes with zone length.
DRIVE CHAIN–No. 40 roller-to-roller. EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone (Retro-Reflective). NEMA 1, 2, IP 62. UL
Approved.
CHAIN GUARD–Formed steel guards totally enclose drive chains.
IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated ball bearings. input/output boards. Should be located near disconnect panel. See chart for maximum quantity
of zones. Requires 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
EZDriveTM System–Shaft mounted gearmotor located near center of each zone. 1/2 HP - 3 PH 60
Hz. Totally enclosed fan cooled. 230/460 V (specify voltage). Includes EZDriveTM Disconnect Panel. CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 28 FPM.
Power is distributed zone to zone through pluggable cordsets. Power is connected from the starter
box to the motor via “SO” type cord. Please contact factory if local code requires other than the CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 300 lbs with supports on 10 ft. centers
standard power distribution techniques described. and 1000 lbs with supports on 5 ft. centers. Maximum unit load 4000 lbs per zone with 4” roller
centers and #40 chain. Zones longer than 6 ft. may require an additional floor support depending
on product load.
LH CHAIN
GUARD
DUAL OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL ZONE GEARMOTOR EZDRIVE™ ZONE STARTER BOX
(MUST BE LOCATED AT THE CENTER OF CONVEYOR)
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always used
at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Sleep Feature – Stops tread rollers from turning when no product is present, reducing noise, reducing energy consumption and extending roller bearing life.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from a removed load, preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are routinely removed
from the conveyor with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and stops the zone from driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering loading
area.
1-5/8"
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds available, contact factory. EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
TREAD ROLLERS–2 5/8 in. dia. x 7 ga. steel, 11/16 in. hex spring-loaded shaft.
CATALOG | 08312018
36-CREZD
Conveyor shown
with optional floor
Heavy Duty Accumulating Conveyor supports
Zero Pressure Accumulating Type)
The Model 36-CREZD is a heavy duty chain driven live • EZDriveTM System (Individual zone drive)
roller conveyor designed for zero pressure accumulation of • EZLogic® Accumulation System
products. This conveyor is designed to handle heavily loaded • Chain Driven Rollers
containers, racks, or pallets. Products may be accumulated • Shaft Mounted Drives
in zones and released upon request.
• HSF-Type Floor Supports Available
Conveying
27 3/4" 31 3/4" 35 3/4" 39 3/4" 43 3/4" 47 3/4" 51 3/4" 55 3/4" 59 3/4" 63 3/4"
Surface
Between
31" 35" 39" 43" 47" 51" 55" 59" 63" 67" U.S. Patent Numbers
Rail Width
7,243,781 • 7,591,366
Overall 7,905,345 • 6,860,381
34 1/4" 38 1/4" 42 1/4" 46 1/4" 50 1/4" 54 1/4" 58 1/4" 62 1/4" 66 1/4" 70 1/4"
Frame Width Other Patents Pending.
Weight Per Foot
115 123 131 139 147 155 163 171 179 187
6" Centers
Total Weight = (Number of Zones x 35) + (OAL x Weight per Foot)
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc. are not included.
HOW IT WORKS
The conveyor is made up of accumulation zones. Each zone
contains an individual zone drive interfaced to Hytrol’s EZLogic®
Zone Controllers, which sense product presence and control the
accumulation and release of the zones by starting and stopping
the zone drives.
OVERALL LENGTH
OVERALL LENGTH
CONVEYING SURFACE
VIEW X-X CONVEYING SURFACE
REFLECTOR
3/8”
DISCONNECT
18-1/2” EZLOGIC® DIFFUSE
PANEL REFLECTOR
12-5/8” EZLOGIC® DIFFUSE ACCUMULATION CHANNEL CONTROLLER (OPTIONAL) ACCUMULATION CHANNEL
ZONE CONTROLLER
9-1/16” (OPTIONAL)
9-1/16”
7-3/4” 7-3/4”
5 3/4”
7 1/2”
VIEW X-X
(SINGLE OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL)
VIEW X-X
REFLECTOR (DUAL OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL) R
EZLOGIC® DIFFUSE
EZLOGIC® DIFFUSE ACCUMULATION CHANNEL CONTROLLER (OPTIONAL) ACCUMULATION C
ZONE CONTROLLER (OPTIONAL)
VIEW X-X
(SINGLE OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL)
CATALOG | 08312018
VIEW X-X
(DUAL OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL)
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 36-CREZD
BED–Roller bed with 3 1/2 in. dia. x .300 wall unplated rollers spaced every 6 in. Tread rollers
mounted in 5 3/4 in. x 4 ga. channel on side opposite chain guard and 7 3/4 in. x 4 ga. channel on EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone (Retro-Reflective). NEMA 1, 2, IP 62. UL
chain guard side. Bolted together with butt couplings. Approved.
DRIVE CHAIN–No. 60 roller-to-roller. IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
input/output boards. Should be located near disconnect panel. See chart for maximum quantity
CHAIN GUARD–Formed steel guards totally enclose drive chains. of zones. Requires 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
EZDrive System–Shaft mounted gearmotor located near center of each zone. 3/4 HP - 3 PH 60
TM
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 2000 lbs. Maximum unit load 5000 lbs per
Hz. Totally enclosed fan cooled. 230 or 460 V (specify voltage). Includes EZDriveTM Disconnect zone. Zones longer than 6 ft. may require an additional floor support depending on product load.
Panel. Power is distributed zone to zone through pluggable cordsets. Power is connected from the
starter box to the motor via “SO” type cord. Please contact factory if local code requires other than FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
the standard power distribution techniques described.
DISCONNECT 230V 460V
ACCUMULATION ZONE LENGTHS–60 in., 72 in., 84 in., 96 in., 108 in., 120 in. Frame lengths will PANEL 3 Ph. 60 Hz 3 Ph. 60 Hz
change with zone lengths.
SINGLE OUTPUT 1-3 ZONES 1-6 ZONES
DUAL OUTPUT 4-6 ZONES 7-12 ZONES
RH CHAIN
GUARD
ZONE GEARMOTOR
EZDRIVE™ ZONE STARTER BOX (STANDARD)
SINGLE OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL
INFEED EYE IOP EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER
F F
L L
O O
W W
DUAL OUTPUT DISCONNECT PANEL ZONE GEARMOTOR EZDRIVE™ ZONE STARTER BOX LH CHAIN
(MUST BE LOCATED AT THE CENTER OF CONVEYOR) GUARD
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always used
at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Sleep Feature – Stops tread rollers from turning when no product is present, reducing noise, reducing energy consumption and extending roller bearing life.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from a removed load, preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are routinely removed
from the conveyor with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and stops the zone from driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering loading
area.
3/8”
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
5-3/4”
7-1/2” FLOOR SUPPORTS–HSF Type floor supports are available for a wide range of elevations. Specify top EZDrive® System:
of roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in feet for • Variable Frequency Drive for adjusting conveying speed or adjusting acceleration and
lagging to floor. Includes knee braces HSF-11 and above. deceleration time.
REFLECTOR
CHANNEL
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds available, contact factory. EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 08312018
)
199-CRE24EZ
Conveyor shown
24 Volt DC Horizontal with optional floor
Power Conveyor supports
(Zero Pressure
The Model 199-CRE24EZ Accumulating conveyor uses a
Accumulating Type)
24VDC motor/reducer to drive chain driven tread rollers. This • EZLogic® Accumulation System
conveyor is designed to handle cartons or pallets in conditions • Chain Driven Rollers
that may not be suitable for belt driven rollers. Products may • Shaft Mounted 24 VDC Drive
e24
be accumulated in zones and released upon request. • Adjustable MSN-Type Floor Supports Available TM
Conveying
12 1/4" 14 1/4" 16 1/4" 18 1/4" 20 1/4" 22 1/4" 24 1/4" 28 1/4" 30 1/4" 34 1/4" 36 1/4"
Surface
Between Rail
15" 17" 19" 21" 23" 25" 27" 31" 33" 37" 39"
Width U.S. Patent Numbers
Overall Frame 7,243,781 • 7,591,366
18" 20" 22" 24" 26" 28" 30" 34" 36" 40" 42" 7,905,345 • 6,860,381
Width
Other Patents Pending.
Weight (Lbs.)
Per Foot 4" 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 67 69 73 75
Roller Centers
Weight (Lbs.)
Per Foot 6" 46 48 50 52 54 56 58 62 64 66 68
Roller Centers
Total Weight = (Number of Zones x 30) + (OAL x Weight Per Foot)
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc. are not included.
HOW IT WORKS
The conveyor is made up of accumulation zones. Each zone
contains an individual zone drive interfaced to Hytrol’s EZLogic®
Zone Controllers, which sense product presence and control the
accumulation and release of the zones by starting and stopping
the zone drives.
OVERALL LENGTH
11 59/64
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 199-CRE24EZ
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. x 9 ga. unplated rollers spaced every 4 or 6 in. Tread rollers POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS)—40 amp DC power supply, 28 volt fixed output. Maximum of 8
mounted in 3 1/2 in. x 7 ga. formed channel on side opposite chain guard and 4 3/4 in. x 7 ga. formed zones per power supply. 120 vac, 24 amp input. Mounted near center of conveyor.
channel on chain guard side. Bolted together with butt couplings.
IOP—Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
DRIVE CHAIN–No. 40 roller-to-roller. input/output boards. Operates up to 50 zones with maximum of 25 on either side of IOP. Requires
120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
CHAIN GUARD–Formed steel guards totally enclose drive chains.
CONVEYING SPEED–up to 35 FPM.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–4 in. roller centers, 32 in. to 120 in. on 4 in. increments. 6 in. centers, 30
in. to 120 in. on 6 in. increments. Frame length changes with zone length. CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 150 lbs. with supports on 10 ft. centers, 250
lbs. per ft. with supports on 5 ft. centers. Not to exceed 1300 lbs per zone. Zones longer than 6 ft.
EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone (Retro-Reflective). NEMA 1, 2, IP 62. UL may require an additional floor support depending on product load.
Approved.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
IOP
EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER
INFEED EYE
MOTOR CONTROLLER
E24 MOTOR/POWERCUBE 40 AMP POWER SUPPLY
RH CHAIN LH CHAIN
GUARD GUARD
(STANDARD)
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always used
at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Sleep Feature – Stops tread rollers from turning when no product is present, reducing noise, reducing energy consumption and extending roller bearing life.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from a removed load, preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are routinely removed
from the conveyor with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and stops the zone from driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering loading
area.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MSN Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MSN-6 support.
CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. Note: Capacity affected with speed rods available.
change.
EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, (both sides) fixed channel (both sides) or
angle (one side).
CATALOG | 08312018
25-CRE24EZ
24 Volt DC Horizontal Conveyor shown with
Power Conveyor optional floor supports
(Zero Pressure
Accumulating Type)
The Model 25-CRE24EZ Accumulating conveyor uses a
24VDC motor/reducer to drive chain driven thread rollers. • EZLogic® Accumulation System
This conveyor is designed to handle loads such as pallets, • Chain Driven Rollers
drums, containers, etc. Products may be accumulated in • Shaft Mounted 24VDC Drive
e24
zones and released upon request. TM
• Adjustable HSN-Type Floor Supports Available
OVERALL LENGTH
12 17/32
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 25-CRE24EZ
BED–Roller bed with 2 1/2 in. dia. x 11 ga. unplated rollers spaced every 4 or 6 in. Tread rollers POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS)—40 amp DC power supply, 28 volt fixed output. Maximum of 8
mounted in 4 in. x 4 ga. formed channel on side opposite chain guard and 6 in. x 4 ga. formed zones per power supply. 120 vac, 24 amp input. Mounted near center of conveyor.
channel on chain guard side. Bolted together with butt couplings.
IOP—Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
DRIVE CHAIN–No. 40 roller-to-roller. input/output boards. Operates up to 50 zones with maximum of 25 on either side of IOP. Requires
120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
CHAIN GUARD–Formed steel guards totally enclose drive chains.
CONVEYING SPEED–Up to 30 FPM.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated ball bearings.
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 300 lbs. with supports on 10 ft. centers and
ACCUMULATION ZONES–4 in. roller centers, 32 in. to 120 in. on 4 in. increments. 3 in. and 6 in. 1000 lbs with supports on 5 ft. centers. Maximum unit load 2500 lbs. per zone. Zones longer than
roller centers, 30 in. to 120 in. on 6 in. increments. Frame length changes with zone length. 6 ft. may require an additional floor support depending on product load.
EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone (Retro-Reflective). NEMA 1, 2, IP 62. UL FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
Approved.
IOP
EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER
INFEED EYE
MOTOR CONTROLLER
E24 MOTOR/POWERCUBE 40 AMP POWER SUPPLY
RH CHAIN LH CHAIN
GUARD GUARD
(STANDARD)
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always used
at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Sleep Feature – Stops tread rollers from turning when no product is present, reducing noise, reducing energy consumption and extending roller bearing life.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from a removed load, preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are routinely removed
from the conveyor with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and stops the zone from driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering loading
area.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–HSN Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify GUARD RAILS–Angle type only.
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above HSN-6 support. TREAD ROLLERS–2 5/8 in. dia. x 7 ga. steel, 11/16 in. hex spring-loaded shaft.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds available, contact factory. EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 08312018
199-PVR
The Model 199-PVR is a medium-duty poly-v belt driven live
• 11 Bed Widths
Poly-V Belt Driven
Live Roller Conveyor
Conveying Surface 12 1/4" 14 1/4" 16 1/4" 18 1/4" 20 1/4" 22 1/4" 24 1/4" 28 1/4" 30 1/4" 34 1/4" 36 1/4"
Between Rail Width 15" 17" 19" 21" 23" 25" 27" 31" 33" 37" 39"
Overall Frame Width 18" 20" 22" 24" 26" 28" 30" 34" 36" 40" 42"
3" Centers 10' Length-O.A. 705 740 765 790 825 850 885 935 970 1010 1055
Per Foot 56 59 61 63 66 68 71 75 78 81 85
4" Centers 10' Length-O.A. 655 680 705 730 755 780 805 855 870 920 955
Per Foot 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 67 69 72 75
6" Centers 10' Length-O.A. 605 620 645 670 685 710 725 775 780 830 855
Per Foot 46 47 49 51 52 54 55 59 60 63 65
• All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc. are not included
• Motors will slave a maximum of 40 rollers, 20 rollers per side.
OVERALL LENGTH
OVERALL FRAME
WIDTH
BETWEEN RAIL
WIDTH
CONVEYING
SURFACE
29/32
1/4
3 1/2 4 1/2
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 199-PVR
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. x 9 ga. wall unplated tread rollers spaced every 3 in, 4 in, or 6 in MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Gearmotor.
mounted in 7 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame bolted together with butt
couplings. CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 35 FPM.
SHAFT MOUNTED DRIVE–Shaft mounted gearmotor to the side of the bed section. CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 150 lbs with supports on 10’ centers, 250 lbs
with supports on 5’ centers. 600 lbs total load.
POLY-V BELT–4-rib J-Profile roller to roller
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
GUARD–Mounted to top of channel frame to totally enclose drive belts.
CONVEYOR LENGTH–Maximum 10’ per drive.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated ball bearings on drive roller shaft.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MSN Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MSN-6 support. rods available.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. NOTE: Capacity affected with speed MOTORS–Other HP gearmotors available.
change.
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starters and push-button stations. AC variable
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, (both sides) fixed channel (both sides) or frequency drive.
angle (one side). See Accessory section .
TRANSFERS–Chain transfers available. See accessories.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
CATALOG | 08312018
25-PVR
The heavy design of the 25-PVR allows it to be used for
Poly-V Belt Driven Live Roller
Conveyor (Roll-to-Roll Type)
• 15 Bed Widths
conveying higher load capacities such as loaded pallets and • Shaft Mounted Drive
drums. Poly-V belt driven rollers make it ideal for conveying • Reversible
heavier parts where little maintenance or a quieter conveyor • Poly-V Belt Driven Rollers
is required. Conveyor shown
• Adjustable HSN-Type Floor Supports Available
with optional floor
supports
OVERALL LENGTH
2 19/32
VIEW A-A
SCALE 1:5
OVERALL
8
FRAME WIDTH OVERALL LENGTH
BETWEEN
RAIL WIDTH
CONVEYING
SURFACE
5 4
6 1/8
1 3/4
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 25-PVR
BED–Roller bed with 2 1/2 in. dia. x 11 ga. unplated tread rollers spaced every 3 in., 4 in., or 6 in. MOTOR–1 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. gearmotor.
roller centers only. Tread rollers mounted in 4 in. x 4 ga. powder painted formed steel channel on
side opposite guard and 5 in. x 4 ga. powder painted formed steel channel on guard side. CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 30 FPM.
SHAFT MOUNTED DRIVE–Shaft mounted drive to the side of the bed section. CAPACITY–– Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 300 lb. with supports on 10 ft. centers,
1000 lb. with supports on 5 ft. centers. Total load 3000 lbs.
POLY-V BELT–8-rib J-Profile roller to roller.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
GUARD–Formed steel, upper and lower guard mounted to top and bottom of channel frame to
totally enclose drive belts. CONVEYOR LENGTHS–Maximum 10’ per drive.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–HSN Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in feet TRANSFERS–Chain transfers available. See Accessory section.
for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above HSN-3 support.
MOTORS–Other HP gearmotors available.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. NOTE: Capacity affected with speed
change. ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starter – push-button stations. AC variable
frequency drive.
GUARD RAILS–Fixed angle (2 in. high x 1/4 in. steel) guard bolts to top flange of channel opposite
guard.
CATALOG | 08312018
199-PVEZD
The Model 199-PVEZD is a chain driven live roller conveyor •
Medium Duty
Accumulating Conveyor
(Zero Pressure Accumulating Type)
EZDriveTM System (Individual zone drive)
Conveyor shown
with optional floor
supports
designed for zero pressure accumulation of products. This • EZLogic® Accumulation System
conveyor is designed to handle cartons or pallets. Products • Poly-V Belt Driven Rollers
may be accumulated in zones and released upon request. • Shaft Mounted Drive
• Adjustable MSN-Type Floor Supports Available
Conveying
12 1/4" 14 1/4" 16 1/4" 18 1/4" 20 1/4" 22 1/4" 24 1/4" 28 1/4" 30 1/4" 34 1/4" 36 1/4"
Surface
U.S. Patent Numbers
Between Rail
15" 17" 19" 21" 23" 25" 27" 31" 33" 37" 39" 7,243,781 • 7,591,366
Width 7,905,345 • 6,860,381
Overall Frame Other Patents Pending.
18" 20" 22" 24" 26" 28" 30" 34" 36" 40" 42"
Width
Weight (Lbs.)
Per Foot 3” 56 59 61 63 66 68 71 75 78 81 85
Roller Centers
Weight (Lbs.)
Per Foot 4" 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 67 69 73 75
Roller Centers
Weight (Lbs.)
Per Foot 6" 46 48 50 52 54 56 58 62 64 66 68
Roller Centers
• Total Weight = (Number of Zones x 30) + (OAL x Weight Per Foot)
• All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc. are not included.
• Motors will slave a maximum of 40 rollers, 20 rollers per side.
HOW IT WORKS
The conveyor is made up of accumulation zones. Each zone
contains an individual zone drive interfaced to Hytrol’s EZLogic®
Zone Controllers, which sense product presence and control the
accumulation and release of the zones by starting and stopping
the zone drives.
OVERALL LENGTH
SECTION LENGTH
IOP
OVERALL
8 1/8 FRAME
WIDTH
BETWEEN
FRAME
WIDTH
CONVEYING
SURFACE
1/4
7 1/2
3 1/2
11 1/16
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 199-PVEZD
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. x 9 ga. unplated rollers spaced every 3, 4, or 6 in. Tread rollers EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone (Retro-Reflective). NEMA 1, 2, IP 62. UL
mounted in 3 1/2 in. x 7 ga. formed channel on side opposite guard and 4 1/2 in. x 7 ga. formed Approved.
channel on guard side. Bolted together with butt couplings.
IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
POLY-V BELT–J profile, 4-rib roller to roller. input/output boards. Should be located near disconnect panel. See chart for maximum quantity
of zones. Requires 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
GUARD–Formed steel guards totally enclose drive belts.
CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 35 FPM.
EZDriveTM System–Shaft mounted gearmotor located near center of each zone. 1/2 HP - 3 PH 60
Hz. Totally enclosed fan cooled. 230/460 V (specify voltage). Includes EZDriveTM Disconnect Panel. CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 150 lbs. with supports on 10 ft. centers and
Power is distributed zone to zone through pluggable cordsets. Power is connected from the starter 250 lbs with supports on 5 ft. centers. Maximum unit load 1000 lbs. per zone. Zones longer than 6
box to the motor via “SO” type cord. Please contact factory if local code requires other than the ft. may require an additional floor support depending on product load.
standard power distribution techniques described.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–4 in. roller centers, 32 in. to 120 in. on 4 in. increments. 3in. and 6 in.
centers, 30 in. to 120 in. on 3in. or 6 in. increments. Frame length changes with zone length. DISCONNECT 230V 460V
PANEL 3 Ph. 60 Hz 3 Ph. 60 Hz
INFEED EYE IOP EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER SINGLE OUTPUT 1-8 ZONES 1-15 ZONES F F
L L
DUAL OUTPUT 9-16 ZONES 16-22 ZONES O O
W W
F F
L L
O O
W W
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always used
at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Sleep Feature – Stops tread rollers from turning when no product is present, reducing noise, reducing energy consumption and extending roller bearing life.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from a removed load, preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are routinely removed
from the conveyor with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and stops the zone from driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering loading
area.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MSN Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MSN-6 support. CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
rods available.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. Note: Capacity affected with speed
change. EZDriveTM System:
• Variable Frequency Drive–for adjusting conveying speed or adjusting acceleration and
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, (both sides) fixed channel (both sides) or deceleration time.
angle (one side).
EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 08312018
25-PVEZD
The Model 25-PVEZD is a Poly-V Belt driven live roller •
Heavy Duty Accumulating Conveyor
(Zero Pressure Accumulating Type)
EZDriveTM System (Individual zone drive)
Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
OVERALL LENGTH
SECTION LENGTH
IOP
OVERALL
8 1/8 FRAME
WIDTH
BETWEEN
FRAME
WIDTH
CONVEYING
SURFACE
3/8
7 13/16
4
11 1/16
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 25-PVEZD
BED–Roller bed with 2 1/2 in. dia. x 11 ga. unplated rollers spaced every 3, 4, or 6 in. Tread rollers ACCUMULATION ZONES–4 in. roller centers, 32 in. to 120 in. on 4 in. increments. 3 in. and 6 in.
mounted in 4 in. x 4 ga. formed channel on side opposite chain guard and 5 in. x 4 ga. formed roller centers, 30 in. to 120 in. on 6 in. increments. Frame length changes with zone length.
channel on chain guard side. Bolted together with butt couplings.
EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone (Retro-Reflective). NEMA 1, 2, IP 62. UL
POLY-V BELT–J-profile, 8 rib roller to roller Approved.
GUARD–Formed steel guards totally enclose drive belts. IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
input/output boards. Should be located near disconnect panel. See chart for maximum quantity
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated ball bearings. of zones. Requires 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
EZDriveTM System–Shaft mounted gearmotor located near center of each zone. 1/2 HP - 3 PH 60 CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 28 FPM.
Hz. Totally enclosed fan cooled. 230/460 V (specify voltage). Includes EZDriveTM Disconnect Panel.
Power is distributed zone to zone through pluggable cordsets. Power is connected from the starter CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 300 lbs. with supports on 10 ft. centers and
box to the motor via “SO” type cord. Please contact factory if local code requires other than the 1000 lbs. with supports on 5 ft. centers. Maximum unit load 3000 lbs per zone. Zones longer than
standard power distribution techniques described. 6 ft. may require an additional floor support depending on product load.
F F
L L
O O
W W
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always used
at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Sleep Feature – Stops tread rollers from turning when no product is present, reducing noise, reducing energy consumption and extending roller bearing life.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from a removed load, preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are routinely removed
from the conveyor with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and stops the zone from driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering loading
area.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–HSN Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify EZDrive® System:
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in • Variable Frequency Drive-for adjusting conveying speed or adjusting acceleration and
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above HSN-6 support. deceleration time.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds available, contact factory. EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 08312018
199-PVE24EZ
24 Volt DC Horizontal
Power Conveyor Conveyor shown
with optional floor
(Zero Pressure supports
Accumulating Type)
The Model 199-PVE24EZ Accumulating conveyor uses a 24 • EZLogic® Accumulation System
VDC motor/reducer to drive Poly-V Belt driven tread rollers. • Poly-V Belt Driven Rollers
This conveyor is designed to handle cartons or pallets. • Shaft Mounted 24 VDC Drive
Products may be accumulated in zones and released upon • Adjustable MSN-Type Floor Supports Available
e24
request. TM
Conveying
12 1/4" 14 1/4" 16 1/4" 18 1/4" 20 1/4" 22 1/4" 24 1/4" 28 1/4" 30 1/4" 34 1/4" 36 1/4"
Surface
Between Rail U.S. Patent Numbers
15" 17" 19" 21" 23" 25" 27" 31" 33" 37" 39"
Width 7,243,781 • 7,591,366
Overall Frame 7,905,345 • 6,860,381
18" 20" 22" 24" 26" 28" 30" 34" 36" 40" 42" Other Patents Pending.
Width
Weight (Lbs.)
Per Foot 3” 56 59 61 63 66 68 71 75 78 81 85
Roller Centers
Weight (Lbs.)
Per Foot 4" 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 67 69 73 75
Roller Centers HOW IT WORKS
Weight (Lbs.) The conveyor is made up of accumulation zones. Each
Per Foot 6" 46 48 50 52 54 56 58 62 64 66 68 zone contains an individual zone drive interfaced to
Roller Centers Hytrol’s EZLogic® Zone Controllers, which sense product
• Total Weight = (Number of Zones x 30) + (OAL x Weight Per Foot) presence and control the accumulation and release of
• All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc. are not included. the zones by starting and stopping the zone drives.
• Motors will slave a maximum of 40 rollers, 20 rollers per side.
OVERALL LENGTH
RETRO-REFLECTIVE
ACCUMULATION CHANNEL
FLOW
POWERBLOCK/E24 MOTOR
IOP
CONVEYING
SURFACE
1/4
3 1/2
11 59/64
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 199-PVE24EZ
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. x 9 ga. unplated rollers spaced every 3, 4, or 6 in. Tread rollers POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS)—40 amp DC power supply, 28 volt fixed output. Maximum of 8
mounted in 3 1/2 in. x 7 ga. formed channel on side opposite guard and 4 1/2 in. x 7 ga. formed zones per power supply. 120 vac, 24 amp input. Mounted near center of conveyor.
channel on guard side. Bolted together with butt couplings.
IOP—Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
POLY-V BELT–J profile, 4-rib roller to roller input/output boards. Operates up to 50 zones with maximum of 25 on either side of IOP. Requires
120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
GUARD–Formed steel guards totally enclose drive belts.
CONVEYING SPEED–Up to 35 FPM.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–4 in. roller centers, 32 in. to 120 in. on 4 in. increments. 6 in. centers, 30
in. to 120 in. on 6 in. increments. Frame length changes with zone length. CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 150 lbs. supports on 10 ft. centers. 250 lbs.
per ft. with supports on 5 ft. centers. Not to exceed 1000 lbs per zone. Zones longer than 6 ft. may
MOTOR–One 24 VDC motor in each zone. require an additional floor support depending on product load.
EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone (Retro-Reflective). NEMA 1, 2, IP 62. UL FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
Approved.
IOP
EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER
INFEED EYE
MOTOR CONTROLLER
E24 MOTOR/POWERCUBE 40 AMP POWER SUPPLY
RH LH
GUARD GUARD
(STANDARD)
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always used
at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Sleep Feature – Stops tread rollers from turning when no product is present, reducing noise, reducing energy consumption and extending roller bearing life.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from a removed load, preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are routinely removed
from the conveyor with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and stops the zone from driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering loading
area.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MSN Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MSN-6 support.
CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. Note: Capacity affected with speed rods available.
change.
EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, (both sides) fixed channel (both sides) or
angle (one side).
CATALOG | 08312018
25-PVE24EZ
24 Volt DC Horizontal Conveyor shown with
Power Conveyor optional floor supports
(Zero Pressure
Accumulating Type)
The Model 25-PVE24EZ Accumulating conveyor uses a 24
VDC motor/reducer to drive Poly-V Belt driven tread rollers. • EZLogic® Accumulation System
This conveyor is designed to handle loads such as pallets, • Poly-V Belt Driven Rollers
drums, containers, etc. Products may be accumulated in • Shaft Mounted 24VDC Drive
e24
zones and released upon request. • Adjustable HSN-Type Floor Supports Available TM
OVERALL LENGTH
POWERBLOCK/E24 MOTOR
IOP OVERALL
8 1/8 FRAME
OPTIONAL "HSN" WIDTH
40 POWER SUPPLY
SUPPORTS SHOWN
BETWEEN
FRAME
WIDTH
CONVEYING
SURFACE
3/8
4
6 1/8
12 17/32 1 3/4
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 25-PVE24EZ
BED–Roller bed with 2 1/2 in. dia. x 11 ga. unplated rollers spaced every 3, 4, or 6 in. Tread rollers POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS)—40 amp DC power supply, 28 volt fixed output. Maximum of 8
mounted in 4 in. x 4 ga. formed channel on side opposite chain guard and 5 in. x 4 ga. formed zones per power supply. 120 vac, 24 amp input. Mounted near center of conveyor.
channel on chain guard side. Bolted together with butt couplings.
IOP—Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
POLY-V BELT–J-profile, 8 rib roller to roller input/output boards. Operates up to 50 zones with maximum of 25 on either side of IOP. Requires
120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
GUARD–Formed steel guards totally enclose drive belts.
CONVEYING SPEED– Up to 30 FPM.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated ball bearings.
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 300 lbs. with supports on 10 ft. centers and
ACCUMULATION ZONES–4 in. roller centers, 32 in. to 120 in. on 4 in. increments. 3 in. and 6 in. 1000 lbs with supports on 5 ft. centers. Maximum unit load 2500 lbs. per zone. Zones longer than
roller centers, 30 in. to 120 in. on 6 in. increments. Frame length changes with zone length. 6 ft. may require an additional floor support depending on product load.
MOTOR–One 24 VDC motor in each zone. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
IOP
EZLOGIC® ZONE CONTROLLER
INFEED EYE
MOTOR CONTROLLER
E24 MOTOR/POWERCUBE 40 AMP POWER SUPPLY
RH LH
GUARD GUARD
(STANDARD)
Zone Stop - Function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always used
at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone stop is required.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
Sleep Feature – Stops tread rollers from turning when no product is present, reducing noise, reducing energy consumption and extending roller bearing life.
Unloading Zone Feature - Zone On Delay – Timer delays the zone immediately upstream from a removed load, preventing it from driving for a set time. This feature is ideal where loads are routinely removed
from the conveyor with a lift truck.
Loading Zone Feature – Zone detects load being placed onto the conveyor with a fork truck and stops the zone from driving and automatically prevents any loads in zones upstream from entering loading
area.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–HSN Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify GUARD RAILS – Angle type only.
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above HSN-6 support. EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 08312018
PROSORT 121 & 131 ELITE
The ProSort 121 is designed to sort products at a 22 degree angle where
higher speeds are required and close divert centers are not so critical. •
High Speed Sortation Conveyor (Small Item)
4 Widths Available
The ProSort 131 is designed to sort products at a 30 degree angle where • Right or Left Hand Diverts Available
close divert centers are required. Products are transported on anodized • High Sort Rates
aluminum slats where at a predetermined location, divert shoes move • Sorts Small Fragile Items
diagonally across the conveyor to push the product onto a take-away line.
The ProSort 100 family of sorters are designed for high speed applications • Anodized Aluminum Slats Conveyor shown with
• Adjustable MHS-Type Floor Supports Available optional floor supports
where product diverting needs to be both positive and gentle.
ProSor t
Sortation Systems
* Note: Spur location is measured beyond the end of
the section on both the 22 degree and the 30 degree
diverts (the chain cover is not shown).
6"*
2-3/8"*
1-1/4"-2-1/4"
1-1/4"-2-1/4"
30° 22°
MINIMUM DISTANCE
SAME AS MINIMUM
"A-A" LENGTH OF
DIVERT SECTION CHAIN
30° 2 1/2"
6 1/4" INDUCTION
CONVEYOR
INDUCTION
OAW
FLOW CONVEYING SURFACE BED
WIDTH
DIVERT
SHOE 7"
SHAFT MOUNTED ALUMINUM
GEARMOTOR SLAT
6 1/2"
8" DIA DRIVE
DIVERT DIVERT 30" TAIL PULLEY
42" DRIVE SECTION SECTION 8'-0"
3/8" 2-1/4" 6 1/2"
LENGTH LENGTH 4'-0"
DIA TAIL 6" DIA. TAKE-UP
FLOW
PULLEY PULLEY
16"
30"
OPTIONAL
MHS-SUPPORTS
SHOWN
CATENARY SWITCH 2-1/2" DIA
ASSEMBLY TIMING BELT SNUB ROLLER
SLAVE CONNECTION 2-1/8" DIA
SNUB ROLLER
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS PROSORT 121 & 131 ELITE
INTERMEDIATE–16 in. deep x 1 1/2 in. bottom flange inside, 12 ga. formed steel frame-powder painted. of 60 P.S.I.
TAIL BED–16 in. deep x 1 1/2 in. bottom flange inside, 7 ga formed steel frame - powder painted AIR PRESSURE SWITCH–Install in main air line near the last divert switch. Used to detect low air pressure
and turn off drive.
DRIVE/CATENARY BED–30 in. deep formed steel frame-powder painted.
SMART PROXIMITY SWITCHES–24 Volt DC inductive proximity switch. One at each divert. Requires
CARRYING CHAIN–Dual strands of No. 60 prelubricated o-ring roller chain with precision bearings and maintained electrical signal for duration of each divert.
extended pins.
SAFETY SWITCHES–Switches located at infeed and discharge ends to detect stray divert shoes or internal
CATENARY TAKE-UP–Underside catenary take-up provided at drive end. jams. Additional switch supplied at 30 ft. intervals. Interrupts power to drive motor when these conditions
are detected.
CHAIN LUBRICATOR–Installed at infeed end to lubricate carrying chains. Gravity feed with 24 volt DC on/
off switch. Flow control valves to control the amount of oil allowed to flow to each of the brush applicators. DRIVE–Shaft mounted gear motor. Mounted at discharge end on the opposite side from the diverts.
230/460V- 3Ph. 60HZ. Horsepower based on speed and length requirements.
SLATS–Anodized aluminum slats supported at each end by bushings and extended chain pins on 1 1/2 in.
centers. VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLER–Provides smooth acceleration of drive motor and speed variations if
necessary.
DIVERT SHOES–Low friction molded base with high friction pusher face. Steel guide pin for switching and
ball bearing cam follower for diverting. Located on 3 in. centers. CONVEYING SPEED–Determined by application requirements. Up to 450 FPM on ProSort 121. Up to 350
FPM on ProSort 131.
SWITCH ASSEMBLY–Pneumatic operated switch assembly mounted with rubber isolators for quietness and
easily removable for maintenance. PACKAGE SIZE–Minimum 4 1/2 in. long.
AIR REQUIREMENTS–Free air consumption at 60 P.S.I. equals .002 cu. ft. per divert. CAPACITY–Maximum load-25 lbs. per ft. Maximum product weight is 50 lbs.
AIR VALVE–High Speed 24 volt DC single solenoid 4-way air valve at each divert station. INDUCTION CONVEYOR–Belt conveyor slave driven from sorter at same speed as sorter.
AIR FILTER, REGULATOR–Supplied for main air supply line.—1/2 in. NPT ports. Required working pressure FLOOR SUPPORTS–Not supplied as standard. See optional equipment.
DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 11/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings-machine crowned. BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MHS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify top
of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in feet for GUARD RAILS–6 1/2" Solid Side Guards on Shoe Side Only
lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MHS-6 support. Vibration pads between channel and
supports. PROSORT LOGIX CONTROL PACKAGE–Provides complete controls for proper sorter operation. Contact
factory for details.
TAKE AWAY LINES–Gravity spurs are available. Consult factory for recommendation of type and
configuration.
CATALOG | 08312018
PROSORT 122 & 132 ELITE
The ProSort 122 is designed to sort products at a 22 degree angle where
higher speeds are required and close divert centers are not so critical. •
High Speed Sortation Conveyor (Small Item)
4 Widths Available
The ProSort 132 is designed to sort products at a 30 degree angle where • Dual, Right or Left Hand Diverts Available
close divert centers are required. Products are transported on anodized • High Sort Rates
aluminum slats where at a predetermined location, divert shoes move • Sorts Small Fragile Items
diagonally across the conveyor to push the product onto a take-away line.
The ProSort 100 family of sorters are designed for high speed applications • Anodized Aluminum Slats Conveyor shown with
• Adjustable MHS-Type Floor Supports Available optional floor supports
where product diverting needs to be both positive and gentle.
ProSor t
Sortation Systems
* Spur location is measured from the end of the section
on both the 22 degree and the 30 degree diverts (the
chain cover is not shown).
6" *
1/2" *
1-1/4"-2-1/4"
1-1/4"-2-1/4"
30° 22°
MINIMUM DISTANCE
SAME AS MINIMUM
VIEW "A-A" VIEW "A-A"
LENGTH OF PROSORT 132 PROSORT 122
DIVERT SECTION
"A-A"
CHAIN
INDUCTION 6 1/2"
6 1/4" CONVEYOR
INDUCTION
OAW FLOW CONVEYING SURFACE BED
WIDTH
SHAFT DIVERT
SHOE
MOUNTED ALUMINUM 7"
GEARMOTOR SLAT
6 1/2"
SEE NOTE UNDER CHART FOR LIMITATIONS TAIL
ON SPURS NEAR DRIVE SECTION PULLEY
8" DIA DRIVE
DIVERT DIVERT PULLEY
30" TAIL
42" DRIVE SECTION SECTION 8'-0"
3/8" 2-1/4"
LENGTH LENGTH 4'-0" 6" DIA.
DIA TAIL 6 1/2"
TAKE-UP
FLOW PULLEY
PULLEY
16"
30"
OPTIONAL
MHS-SUPPORTS
SHOWN
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS PROSORT 122 & 132 ELITE
INTERMEDIATE–16 in. deep x 1 1/2 in. bottom flange inside, 12 ga. formed steel frame-powder painted.
AIR PRESSURE SWITCH–Install in main air line near the last divert switch. Used to detect low air pressure
TAIL BED–16 in. deep x 1 1/2 in. bottom flange inside, 7 ga formed steel frame - powder painted and turn off drive.
DRIVE/CATENARY BED–30 in. deep formed steel frame-powder painted. SMART PROXIMITY SWITCHES–24 Volt DC inductive proximity switch. One at each divert. Requires
maintained electrical signal for duration of each divert.
CARRYING CHAIN–Dual strands of No. 60 prelubricated o-ring roller chain with precision bearings and
extended pins. SAFETY SWITCHES–Switches located at infeed and discharge ends to detect stray divert shoes or internal
jams. Additional switch supplied at 30 ft. intervals. Interrupts power to drive motor when these conditions
CATENARY TAKE-UP–Underside catenary take-up provided at drive end. are detected.
CHAIN LUBRICATOR–Installed at infeed end to lubricate carrying chains. Gravity feed with 24 volt DC on/ DRIVE–Shaft mounted gear motor. 230/460V- 3Ph. 60HZ. Horsepower based on speed and length
off switch. Flow control valves to control the amount of oil allowed to flow to each of the brush applicators. requirements. See note under chart below for mounting info.
SLATS–Anodized aluminum slats supported at each end by bushings and extended chain pins on 1 1/2 in. VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLER–Provides smooth acceleration of drive motor and speed variations if
centers. necessary.
DIVERT SHOES–Low friction molded base with high friction pusher face. Steel guide pin for switching and CONVEYING SPEED–Determined by application requirements. Up to 450 FPM on ProSort 122. Up to 350
ball bearing cam follower for diverting. Located on 3 in. centers. FPM on ProSort 132.
SWITCH ASSEMBLY–Pneumatic operated switch assembly mounted with rubber isolators for quietness and PACKAGE SIZE–Minimum 4 1/2 in. long.
easily removable for maintenance.
CAPACITY–Maximum load-25 lbs. per ft. Maximum product weight is 50 lbs.
AIR REQUIREMENTS–Free air consumption at 60 P.S.I. equals .002 cu. ft. per divert.
INDUCTION CONVEYOR–Belt conveyor slave driven from sorter at same speed as sorter.
AIR VALVE–High Speed 24 volt DC single solenoid 4-way air valve at each divert station.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Not supplied as standard. See optional equipment.
AIR FILTER, REGULATOR–Supplied for main air supply line.—1/2 in. NPT ports. Required working pressure
of 60 P.S.I.
DRIVE–Slave driven at same speed as sorter via timing belt and bolted directly to infeed of sorter. TAKE-UP–Take-ups in drive provide 16 in. of belt take-up.
Access holes designed into side plate for ease of pulley removal.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive.
CONVEYOR SECTION
Sorter Sorter Induction
Spur Divert section with 22
Conveying Overall Bed Drive (not Tail (not including Divert section with 30 Intermediate with
Width degree diverter ProSort
Surface Width Width including gearmotor) induction belt) degree diverter ProSort 132 no Diverter
"OAW" 122
Width "OAW" "OAW"
Length Wt (LBS) Length Wt (LBS) Length Wt (LBS) Length Wt (LBS) Length Wt (LBS/FT)
15" 31" 18" 18" 570 322 81" 453 60" 335 59
21" 37" 24" 24" 607 344 96" 584 69" 420 9" to 120" 69
42" 30" on 3"
27" 43" 30" 30" 641 366 111" 729 81" 532 increments 79
33" 49" 36" 36" 674 385 126" 875 90" 626 88
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
Note: ProSort 122 requires that a catenary intermediate section be used
Gearmotor Wt. with standard length drive and standard gearmotor mounting or that a
HP LBS minimum 51" length drive be used with a reverse mounted gearmotor.
3 100 ProSort 132 requires that a catenary intermediate section be used with
5 181 standard length drive and standard gearmotor mounting or that a
minimum 45" length drive be used with a reverse mounted gearmotor.
7.5 209
10 254
15 287
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MHS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify TAKE AWAY LINES–Gravity spurs are available. Consult factory for recommendation of type and
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. configuration.
Holes in feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MHS-6 support. Vibration pads
between channel and supports. PROSORT LOGIX CONTROL PACKAGE–Provides complete controls for proper sorter operation.
Contact factory for details.
CATALOG | 08312018
PROSORT 421 & 431 ELITE
Conveyor shown
with optional floor
supports
7”* 2-5/8”*
2”-3” 2”-3”
22˚ 30˚
MINIMUM DISTANCE
NOTE: SPUR WIDTH IS 6” WIDER SAME AS MINIMUM
THAN INDUCTION CONVEYOR LENGTH OF DIVERT
SECTION
VIEW “A-A” -22° DIVERT VIEW “A-A” -30° DIVERT
(ProSort 421) (ProSort 431)
“A- A” CHAIN
22° OR 30° INDUCTION
(30° SHOWN) CONVEYOR
2-1/2”
6-9/16”
INDUCTION
FLO W CONVEYING SURFACE BED WIDTH
O AW BR
12-1/2”
7-1/2”
54” DRIVE DIVERT SECTION LENGTH DIVERT SECTION LENGTH 36” 48” 24” THRU 120”
TAI L
FLO W
7/16”
6-7/8”
21” 21-3/8”
38”
OPTIONAL MHS
SUPPORTS SHOWN
CATENARY SWITCH ASSEMBLY 2-1/2” DIA. SNUB ROLLER 2-1/8” DIA. SNUB IDLER
OPTIONAL MHS
SUPPORTS SHOWN
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS PROSORT 421 & 431 ELITE
INTERMEDIATE BED—21 in. deep x 1 1/2 x 7/8 in flange 10 ga. formed steel channel frame, powder painted. AIR PRESSURE SWITCH—Install in main air line near the last divert switch. Used to detect low air pressure
and turn off drive only for pneumatic.
TAIL BED—21 in. deep x 1 1/2 x 7/8 in flange 7 ga. formed steel channel frame, powder painted.
SMART PROXIMITY SWITCHES—24 volt DC inductive proximity switch. One at each divert. Requires
DRIVE/CATENARY BED—38 in. deep x 4 ga. formed steel channel frame, powder painted. maintained electrical signal for duration of each divert.
CARRYING CHAIN—Dual strands of No. 100 pre-lubricated o-ring roller chain with precision bearings and SAFETY SWITCHES—Switches located at infeed and discharge ends to detect stray divert shoes or internal
extended pins. jams. Additional switch supplied at 30 ft. intervals. Interrupts power to drive motor when these conditions
are detected.
CHAIN LUBRICATOR—Installed at infeed end to lubricate carrying chains. Gravity feed with 24 volt DC on/
off switch. Flow control valves to control the amount of oil allowed to flow to each of the brush applicators. DRIVE—Shaft mounted gearmotor. Mounted at discharge end on the opposite side from the diverts.
230/460V-3Ph. 60Hz.
FLIGHTS—Anodized aluminum slat supported at each end by bushings and extended chain pins on 5 in.
centers. VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLER—Provides smooth acceleration of drive motor and speed variations if
necessary.
DIVERT SHOES—Low friction molded shoe with high friction pusher face. Steel guide pin for switching
and ball bearing cam follower for diverting. Located on 5 in. centers. CONVEYING SPEED—Determined by application requirements. Up to 600 FPM on ProSort 421. Up to 350
FPM on ProSort 431.
SWITCH ASSEMBLY—Pneumatic or Electric operated high speed switch assembly mounted with rubber
isolators for quietness and easily removable for maintenance. PACKAGE SIZE—Minimum 9 in. long x 4 in. wide.
AIR REQUIREMENTS—Free air consumption at 60 psi equals .0033 cu. ft. per divert only for pneumatic. CAPACITY—Maximum load 50 lbs. per ft. Maximum product weight is 100 lbs.
AIR VALVE—High speed 24 volt DC single solenoid 4-way air valve at each divert station only for INDUCTION CONVEYOR—Belt conveyor slave driven from sorter at same speed as sorter.
pneumatic.
FLOOR SUPPORTS—Not supplied as standard. See optional equipment.
AIR FILTER, REGULATOR—Supplied for main air supply line with 1/2 in. NPT ports. Required working
pressure of 60 psi only for pneumatic.
DRIVE PULLEY—8 in. dia. with 1 11/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings. FLOOR SUPPORTS—Not supplied as standard. See optional equipment.
CONVEYOR SECTION
Sorter
Sorter Sorter Induction Divert section with 22 Divert section with 30
Overall Spur Width Drive (not including Tail (not including
Conveying Between Rail Bed Width degree diverter ProSort degree diverter ProSort Intermediate with no Divert
Width “OAW” gearmotor) induction belt)
Surface Width Width “BR” “OAW” 421 431
“OAW”
Length Wt. (LBS) Length Wt. (LBS) Length Wt. (LBS) Length Wt. (LBS) Length Wt. (LBS)
15" 30" 33" 18" 24" 1251 511 78" 704 60" 545 104
21" 36" 39" 24" 30" 1322 551 93" 879 71" 687 110
9" to 120" on
27" 42" 45" 30" 36" 54" 1393 36" 591 108" 1072 81" 838 116
3" increments
33" 48" 51" 36" 42" 1464 631 123" 1278 91" 1000 122
39" 54" 57" 42" 48" 1536 671 138" 1498 102" 1182 128
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
GEARMOTOR WEIGHT
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT HP
5
LBS
181
FLOOR SUPPORTS—Adjustable MHS type w/ FLIGHT TUBES—1 1/2 in. dia. plated tubing
knee braces. Holes in feet for lagging to floor. supported at each end by bushings and extended 7.5 209
Specify elevation. Vibration pads between channel chain pins on 2 1/2 in. centers. 10 254
and supports.
PROSORT LOGIX CONTROL PACKAGE—Provides 15 287
GUARD RAIL—6 1/2 in high solid side guards on complete controls for proper sorter operation.
switch side only. Consult factory for details. 20 584
25 695
30 728
40 849
CATALOG | 08312018
PROSORT 422 & 432 ELITE
Conveyor shown
with optional floor
supports
The ProSort 422 is designed to sort products at a 22 degree angle where High Speed Sortation Conveyor
higher speeds are required and close divert centers are not so critical.
• 5 Widths Available
The ProSort 432 is designed to sort products at a 30 degree angle where
close divert centers are required. Products are transported on anodized • Dual, Right or Left Hand Diverts Available
aluminum slats where at a predetermined location, divert shoes move • High Sort Rates
diagonally across the conveyor to push the product onto a take-away line. • Anodized Aluminum Slats
The ProSort 400 family of sorters are designed for high speed applications
• Adjustable MHS-Type Floor Supports Available
where product diverting needs to be both positive and gentle.
ProSor t
Sortation Systems
4 1/2”* 5/8”*
2” to 3” 2” to 3”
22° 30°
INDUCTION
OAW BR FLOW CONVEYING SURFACE
BED WIDTH
12”
6-1/2”
DIVERT ALUMINUM
SHAFT MOUNTED SHOES SLATS
GEARMOTOR
6-7/8”
21” 21-3/8”
38”
OPTIONAL
2-1/2” MHS 2-1/8” DIA
DIA SNUB SUPPORTS SNUB ROLLER
CATENARY ROLLER SHOWN
SWITCH
94-1/2” ASSEMBLY
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS PROSORT 422 & 432 ELITE
INTERMEDIATE & TAIL BED—21 in. deep x 1 1/2 x 7/8 in flange 10 ga. formed steel channel
frame, powder painted. AIR PRESSURE SWITCH—Install in main air line near the last divert switch. Used to detect low
air pressure and turn off drive only for pneumatic.
DRIVE/CATENARY BED—38 in. deep x 4 ga. formed steel channel frame, powder painted.
SMART PROXIMITY SWITCHES—24 volt DC inductive proximity switch. One at each divert.
CARRYING CHAIN—Dual strands of No. 100 pre-lubricated o-ring roller chain with precision Requires maintained electrical signal for duration of each divert.
bearings and extended pins.
SAFETY SWITCHES—Switches located at infeed and discharge ends to detect stray divert shoes
CHAIN LUBRICATOR—Installed at infeed end to lubricate carrying chains. Gravity feed with 24 or internal jams. Additional switch supplied at 30 ft. intervals. Interrupts power to drive motor
volt DC on/off switch. Flow control valves to control the amount of oil allowed to flow to each of when these conditions are detected.
the brush applicators.
DRIVE—Shaft mounted gearmotor. Mounted at discharge end on the opposite side from the
FLIGHTS—Anodized aluminum slat supported at each end by bushings and extended chain pins diverts. 230/460V-3Ph. 60Hz.
on 5 in. centers.
VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLER—Provides smooth acceleration of drive motor and speed
DIVERT SHOES—Low friction molded shoe with high friction pusher faces. Steel guide pin for variations if necessary.
switching and ball bearing cam follower for diverting. Located on 5 in. centers.
CONVEYING SPEED—Up to 600 FPM on ProSort 422. Up to 350 FPM on ProSort 432.
SWITCH ASSEMBLY—Pneumatic or Electric operated high speed switch assembly mounted with
rubber isolators for quietness and easily removable for maintenance. PACKAGE SIZE—Minimum 9 in. long x 4 in. wide.
AIR REQUIREMENTS—Free air consumption at 60 psi equals .0033 cu. ft. per divert only for CAPACITY—Maximum load 50 lbs. per ft. Maximum product weight is 100 lbs.
pneumatic.
INDUCTION CONVEYOR—Belt conveyor slave driven from sorter at same speed as sorter.
AIR VALVE—High speed 24 volt DC single solenoid 4-way air valve at each divert station only for
pneumatic. FLOOR SUPPORTS—Not supplied as standard. See optional equipment.
AIR FILTER, REGULATOR—Supplied for main air supply line with 1/2 in. NPT ports. Required
working pressure of 60 psi only for pneumatic.
DRIVE—Slave driven at same speed as sorter via timing belt and bolted directly to infeed of BEARINGS—Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive.
sorter. Access holes designed into side plate for ease of pulley removal.
FLOOR SUPPORTS—Not supplied as standard. See optional equipment.
DRIVE PULLEY—8 in. dia. with 1 11/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings.
CONVEYOR SECTION
Sorter
Sorter Sorter Induction Divert section with 22 Divert section with 30
Overall Spur Width Drive (not including Tail (not including Intermediate with no
Conveying Between Rail Bed Width degree diverter ProSort degree diverter ProSort
Width “OAW” gearmotor) induction belt) Diverter
Surface Width Width “BR” “OAW” 422 432
“OAW”
Length Wt. (LBS) Length Wt. (LBS) Length Wt. (LBS) Length Wt. (LBS) Length Wt. (LBS)
15" 39" 42" 18" 24" 1359 571 90" 951 72" 684 113
21" 45" 48" 24" 30" 1430 611 105" 1124 83" 818 119
9" to 120" on
27" 51" 54" 30" 36" 54" 1501 36" 651 120" 1315 93" 962 125
3" increments
33" 57" 60" 36" 42" 1572 691 135" 1518 103" 1116 131
39" 63" 66" 42" 48" 1644 731 150" 1735 114" 1288 137
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
NOTE: ProSort 422 requires that the catenary
section be either an intermediate or a single divert
(with the spur and drive on opposite sides) GEARMOTOR WEIGHT
ProSort 432 requires that the catenary section be
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT either an intermediate or a single divert (with the
spur and drive on opposite sides) OR that a reverse
HP LBS
mounted gearmotor be used. 5 181
FLOOR SUPPORTS—Adjustable MHS type w/
knee braces. Holes in feet for lagging to floor. PROSORT LOGIX CONTROL PACKAGE—Provides 7.5 209
Specify elevation. Vibration pads between channel complete controls for proper sorter operation.
and supports. Consult factory for details. 10 254
15 287
FLIGHT TUBES—1 1/2 in. dia. plated tubing
supported at each end by bushings and extended 20 584
chain pins on 2 1/2 in. centers.
25 695
30 728
40 849
CATALOG | 08312018
PROSORT MRT 90
The Model ProSort MRT is a sorter for medium-sized items. • Right Angle Transfer 90° Medium Roller
Product is transported on multiple narrow belts. Rollers pop • Two-Sided Transfer Transfer Conveyor
up between the belts to transfer items at right angles to the • High Sort Rates
sorter. • Close Transfer Locations Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
• Flexible Sort Locations
• HyPower Distributed Cabling System
ProSor t Sortation Systems
Tail and
Intermediate
Section Length
24”
27”
30”
33”
36”
39”
42”
45”
Between Rail Overall Width Number of
48” “BR” “OAW” Belts
51” 15” 18” 4
54”
18” 21” 5
57”
60” 21” 24” 6
66” 24” 27” 7
72” 27” 30” 8
78”
84”
90” FLOW
96”
102”
108” FLOW
114”
120”
OAW
CTION LENGTH INTERMEDIATE SECTION LENGTH INTERMEDIATE SECTION LENGTH 30" DRIVE BR 11"
9 1/2" 5/16"
Conveyor Weights
THE PROPERTY OF HYTROL CONVEYOR
C
COMPANY INC. THIS DRAWING AND THE
J
INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN MAY NOT
Overall Width Drive Weight Conveyor Weight Lbs. OR PART, UTILIZED IN ANY OTHER WORK, OR
USED FOR MANUFACTURE OF DESIGNS
S
UNL
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS - CONVEYOR PROSORT MRT 90
BELT- Endless ARAMIDE Power Transmission Belt TF-102T
BELT SPEED- Determined by application requirements including rate required, package size, and
BED- UHMW wear strip spaced every 3 in., Mounted in 6 1/2 in. x 1 1/2 in. x 12 ga. powder painted weight.
formed steel channel frame bolted together with butt coupling.
TRACKING ENCODER - Provided on snub pulley in drive section. Contact factory for encoder
END DRIVE PULLEY- 8 in. dia. with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, fully lagged with driven pop- specification.
our roller.
CAPACITY- Maximum unit package weight 75 lbs. Maximum distributed load determined by
SNUB PULLEY - 4 in. dia. pulley with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings. Drilled and tapped both ends number of belts under product. (See chart.) 150 ft. maximum length. NOT TO EXCEED capacity
for encoder. in chart.
INFEED IDLER PULLEY- 4 in. dia. x 1 1/2 in. wide crowned sheave with precision bearings. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Supplied as optional equipment.
PNEUMATIC TAKE-UP - Take-up provides 14 in. of individual belt take-up. 25 PSI max on filter Maximum Live Conveyor Load
regulator. Need one pneumatic take-up for every 75 ft. of conveyor length. Maximum
Overall Width Number of
Conveyor Load
AIR FILTER, REGULATOR - Supplied for main air line. “OAW” Belts
(Lbs.)
18” 4 1200
RETURN ROLLERS - 1.9” dia. galvanized tube with ABEC bearings. With cardboard tube inserts.
21” 5 1500
BEARINGS- Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning ball bearings with eccentric lock collars. Pre- 24” 6 1800
lubricated ball bearings in return rollers. 27” 7 2100
30” 8 2400
DRIVE - Shaft mounted gearmotor 3 HP- 230/460/575V –3 ph.- 60 hz. energy efficient, with an
AC variable frequency controller.
PACKAGE SIZE- minimum of 8 in. long x 6 in. wide – maximum length of 28 in. MOTOR- 1/2 HP - 230/460 V–3 PH- 60 HZ Flange Mount Gearmotor.
TRANSFER MECHANISM- Series of 1 1/2 in. dia. x 17 in. long drive rollers with 3/32 in. lagging. AC DRIVE –1/2 HP – AC variable frequency controller.
Driven by 1 in. wide flexproof endless polyester belt.
HYPOWER DISTRIBUTED CABLING SYSTEM - Supplies distributed power to transfer motors.
AIR CYLINDER- 100 mm bore x 20 mm stroke guided table cylinder. (See diagram.) Electrical Code: All motor controls and wiring shall conform to the National
Electrical Code (Article 670 or other applicable articles) as published by the National Fire Protection
AIR REQUIREMENTS- Working pressure 60 P.S.I. Free air consumption at 60 P.S.I., .0556 cu. ft. Association and as approved by the American Standards Institute, Inc. Subject to local code and
per cycle. local customer acceptance.
Motor
VFD
Transfer
Motor
OAW
123456 Dual Output Disconnect Panel SINGLE OUTPUT 1-3 TRANSFERS 1-6 TRANSFERS
(must be located at the center of conveyor)
HYTROL
CONVEYOR CO., INC.
MODELS
STANDARD TOLERANCES
DRAWN BY jfsmith DATE 7/8/2011
NOTE: Sorters over 50 ft. long require a dual output disconnect
LESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FRACTIONS ±1/64
DECIMALS ±.005 CHECKED BY DATE
ANGLES ±1°
PAINT CLASS SPARE PART REVISION
panel.
FLOOR SUPPORTS- MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify MOTORS- Single phase, and other characteristics are available. For conveyor unit only.
top of belt elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes are in feet
for lagging to floor. Knee braces supplied with MS-7 supports and above. PROLOGIX CONTROL PACKAGE- Provides complete controls for proper sorter operation. Contact
factory for details.
GUARD RAILS- Continuous adjustable channel, fixed channel or type A & B angle. NOTE: If product
comes in contact with guard rails, products may not transfer. PLUG-N-GO WIRING - Available with ProLogix Control Package.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS – 36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
CATALOG | 08312018
PROSORT MRT 30
The Model ProSort MRT is a sorter for medium-sized items. • 30° Angle Transfer 30° Diverter Wheel
Product is transported on multiple narrow belts. Diverter • LH or RH Transfer Transfer Conveyor
wheels pop up between the belts to transfer items at 30° • High Sort Rates
angles to the sorter. • Close Transfer Locations Conveyor shown with
• Flexible Sort Locations optional floor supports
• HyPower Distributed Cabling System
ProSor tSortation Systems
Tail and
Intermediate
Section Length
24”
27”
30”
33”
36”
39”
42”
45”
Between Rail Overall Width Number of
48” “BR” “OAW” Belts
51” 15” 18” 4
54”
18” 21” 5
57”
60” 21” 24” 6
66” 24” 27” 7
72” 27” 30” 8
78” FLOW
84”
90”
96”
102”
108” FLOW
114”
120”
OAL
OAW
INTERMEDIATE SECTION LENGTH INTERMEDIATE SECTION LENGTH 30" DRIVE BR 11"
9 1/2" 5/16"
19 3/4"
OAL
FLOW
18" MIN 30" MIN 15" MINTAIL SECTION LENGTH INTERMEDIATE SECTION LENGTH INTERMEDIATE SECTION LENGTH 30" DRIVE
DISCHARGE END VIEW
25 1/2" 26 1/4"
7 3/8" 6 1/2" 69" MIN 9 1/2"
13 7/8"
product length
COMPANY INC. THIS DRAWING AND THE
INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN MAY NOT
JONESBORO, ARKANSAS 25 1/2" 26 1/4"
BE DISCLOSED OR DUPLICATED IN WHOLE MODELS
OR PART, UTILIZED IN ANY OTHER WORK, OR
69" MIN
Conveyor Weights
STANDARD TOLERANCES
USED FOR MANUFACTURE OF DESIGNS DRAWN
UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED BY jfsmith DATE 7/7/2011
FRACTIONS ±1/64
WITHOUT THE PRIOR WRITTEN PERMISSION DECIMALS ±.005 CHECKED BY DATE
Transfer
ANGLES ±1°
OF HYTROL CONVEYOR COMPANY INC.
PAINT CLASS SPARE PART REVISION
INFEED IDLER PULLEY- 4 in. dia. x 1 1/2 in. wide crowned sheave with precision bearings. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Supplied as optional equipment.
PNEUMATIC TAKE-UP - Take-up provides 14 in. of individual belt take-up. 25 PSI max on filter
regulator. Need one pneumatic take-up for every 75 ft. of conveyor length. Maximum Live Conveyor Load
Maximum
AIR FILTER, REGULATOR - Supplied for main air line. Overall Width Number of
Conveyor Load
“OAW” Belts
(Lbs.)
RETURN ROLLERS - 1.9” dia. galvanized tube with ABEC bearings. With cardboard tube inserts. 18” 4 1200
BEARINGS- Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning ball bearings with eccentric lock collars. Pre- 21” 5 1500
lubricated ball bearings in return rollers. 24” 6 1800
27” 7 2100
DRIVE - Shaft mounted gearmotor 3 HP- 230/460/575V –3 ph.- 60 hz. energy efficient, with an 30” 8 2400
AC variable frequency controller.
PACKAGE SIZE- minimum of 8 in. long x 6 in. wide MOTOR- 1/2 HP - 230/460 V–3 PH- 60 HZ Flange Mount Gearmotor.
TRANSFER MECHANISM- Series of 1 3/4 in. dia. precision bearing diverter wheels with. Driven by AC DRIVE –1/2 HP – AC variable frequency controller.
1 in. wide flexproof endless polyester belt.
TRANSFER SPEED- 275 FPM @ 60Hz 367 FPM @ 80Hz
AIR CYLINDER- (2) 40mm bore x 2in stroke cylinders.
Spur Centers Chart DISCONNECT 230V 460V
AIR REQUIREMENTS- Working pressure 60 P.S.I. Free air consumption at 60 P.S.I., .053 cu. ft. per OAW Min Ctrs PANEL 3 Ph. 60 Hz 3 Ph. 60 Hz
cycle. 18" 42"
21" 48" SINGLE OUTPUT 1-3 TRANSFERS 1-6 TRANSFERS
HYPOWER DISTRIBUTED CABLING SYSTEM - Supplies distributed power to transfer motors. 24" 54" DUAL OUTPUT 4-6 TRANSFERS 7-12 TRANSFERS
(See diagram.) Electrical Code: All motor controls and wiring shall conform to the National 27" 60" NOTE: Sorters over 50 ft. long require a dual output disconnect
Electrical Code (Article 670 or other applicable articles) as published by the National Fire Protection 30" 66" panel.
Association and as approved by the American Standards Institute, Inc. Subject to local code and
local customer acceptance.
Products must be
justified to divert side.
2" (REF)
FIRST DIVERT WHEEL
Motor TO SPUR CORNER
IN DOWN POSITION 11"
VFD
Transfer
Motor
VFD
Transfer
Motor
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS- MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify THIS DRAWING CONTAINS CONFIDENTIAL
DESIGNS AND INFORMATION WHICH ARE
C HYTROL
DWG NO
top of belt elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes are in feet MOTORS- Single phase, and other characteristics are available. For conveyor unit only.
THE PROPERTY OF HYTROL CONVEYOR
COMPANY INC. THIS DRAWING AND THE
INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN MAY NOT
HYTROL
CONVEYOR CO., INC.
JONESBORO, ARKANSAS
CatalogMRT
for lagging to floor. Knee braces supplied with MS-7 supports and above. 1 NEW DRAWING
BE DISCLOSED OR DUPLICATED IN WHOLE
OR PART, UTILIZED IN ANY OTHER WORK, OR STANDARD TOLERANCES
MODELS
DRAWN BY Chris Bullard DATE 4/15/2019
PROLOGIX CONTROL PACKAGE- Provides complete controls for proper sorter operation. Contact
UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED
USED FOR MANUFACTURE OF DESIGNS FRACTIONS ±1/64
REV DATE New Revision Note TYPE ENGINEER WITHOUT THE PRIOR WRITTEN PERMISSION DECIMALS ±.005
ANGLES ±1°
Department Systems DATE
OF HYTROL CONVEYOR COMPANY INC.
REVISION HISTORY REVISION 1
GUARD RAILS- Continuous adjustable channel, fixed channel or type A & B angle. NOTE: If product factory for details.
comes in contact with guard rails, products may not transfer.
PLUG-N-GO WIRING - Available with ProLogix Control Package.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS – 36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
CATALOG | 07262019
VIPERSORT
The Model ViperSort is a right angle sortation conveyor used
Right Angle Sortation Conveyor
• 4 Widths Available
to sort small to medium size products. The ViperSort utilizes • Sorts Up To 120 Items Per Minute
a patented design which enables the sorting of cylindrical • Blue Acetal Open Grid 1” Pitch Cleated Plastic Belt
products, extremely thin items such as blister packs, vinyl • Flexible Sort Locations
envelopes and other problematic items.
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
• Close Divert Centers
ProSor t
Sortation Systems
5”
3 TIMES LONGEST
42” MIN. 33” MIN. PRODUCT
OR 30” MINIMUM
24-5/16”
11-1/2”
5”
O AW O AW
6-7/16”
24-1/2” 3”
27-1/2”
5-1/2”
O VERALL LENGTH O VER 80 ’
66” 42”
DRIVE SECTION TAIL SECTION
6-3/8”
1-1/4” 1-1/4”
22-1/2” AIR IN
AIR IN
5”
PNEUMATIC CYLINDER
FOR TAKE-UP
5” 6” PULLEYS 36”
BELT
WIDTH
AIR CYLINDER-High speed 32mm dia. bore x 325mm stroke guided cylinder. CHUTE-Adjustable 27 1/2 in. wide x 24 in. long x 12 ga. formed steel chute powder painted.
AIR REQUIREMENTS-Working pressure 60 psi. Free air consumption at 60 psi, 0.1 cu. ft. per STROKE SENSOR-Two 24VDC sensors, adjustable for setting stroke length and determining home
cycle. position.
RETURN CARRY WAY–Aluminum guide rail extrusion capped with UHMW wearstrip placed on AIR FILTER, REGULATOR–Use with pneumatic take-up. Supplied for main air supply line with 1/2
inside of bed bottom flange. in. NPT ports. Required working pressure of 15-20 psi, 20 psi max.
TAKE UP–80 ft. and less have gravity cantenary, over 80 ft. has pneumatic take-up with 6 in. VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLER–Provides smooth acceleration of drive motor and speed
pulleys. variations if necessary. Maximum belt speed - 120 FPM.
APPLICATION NOTE: Products placed on the ViperSort must be justified to the pusher side of the conveyor to prevent mis-diverts and damaging of products.
Total Weight = Base Weight + (Conveyor Weight per Foot x (Overall Length - 9 ft.)) + (115 lbs. x Num. of Diverters)
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation.One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in BELT–Blue acetal flat top 1 in. pitch - less cleats.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
DUAL SIDED DIVERTERS–Pushers located on both sides with staggered centers
PROSORT LOGIX VIPERSORT CONTROL PACKAGE–Provides complete controls for proper sorter
operation. Contact factory for details.
CATALOG | 08312018
PROSORT SC1 & SC2
The Model ProSort SC series of sorters are belt driven
Horizontal Belt Sortation Conveyor
Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
ProSor t
Sortation Systems
SLAVED SPUR
SHAFT-MOUNTED LENGTH
GEAR MOTOR
SINGLE-SIDED POSITIONING DIVERTER
DIVERTER (FOR TWO-SIDED SORTERS)
TWO-SIDED
DIVERTER
MIN. 8'-6" (HEAVY DUTY STANDARD DRIVE) FLOW
MIN 10'-0" (HIGH PERFORMANCE DRIVE)
MIN. DIVERTCENTERS 24" MIN. TO 8'-0" MIN.
6" DISCHARGE TAIL PULLEY INFEED OF
"X" SECTION
6-1/2" 6-7/8"
10-1/4"
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS PROSORT SC1 & SC2
BELT–Ultimate 140 BBS-Nitrile. BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning ball bearings with eccentric lock collars. Pre-
lubricated ball bearings in tread rollers.
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia.x 16 ga. galvanized rollers with ABEC-1 bearings spaced every 3
in. Mounted in 6 1/2 in.x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame bolted together with DRIVE–Heavy-duty (1-3 diverts and less than 30ft OAL) or high-performance center drive,
splice plates. located at discharge end. Shaft-mounted gearmotor and variable speed controller, 230V or 460V-
3Ph. 60HZ. Horsepower based on speed and length requirements.
DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 11/16 in.dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned and fully lagged.
TRACKING ENCODER–Provided on take-up pulley shaft. Contact factory for encoder
INFEED TAIL PULLEY–3 1/4 in. dia. “drop-in” pulley, machine-crowned. specifications.
DISCHARGE TAIL PULLEY–6 in. dia. with 1 7/16 in. dia shaft at bearings, machine crowned. BELT SPEED–Determined by application requirements. 300 FPM maximum.
SNUB IDLER–Adjustable 2 1/2 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings. CAPACITY–Maximum unit package weight 75 lbs. Maximum distributed load of 4000 lbs.
Maximum conveyor length is 150 ft.
RETURN IDLER–Adjustable 2 1/2 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings.
MAXIMUM NUMBER OF DIVERTERS–Double-sided with slaved spurs: 7 diverters (plus one
TAKE-UP PULLEY–6 in. dia. with 1 7/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned. positioning diverter). Single-sided with slaved spurs: 9 diverters. Single- or double-sided with
non-slaved spurs: 12 diverters.
TAKE-UP–Take-up in center drive provides 15 in. (heavy-duty drive) or 36 in. (high performance
drive) of belt take-up. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
DIVERTER MECHANISM–Two banks of twin pivoting 3 1/8 in. dia. wheels with urethane treads AIR FILTER, REGULATOR–Supplied for main air supply line with 1/2 in. NPT ports. Required
driven by 3/8 in. dia. urethane belts. Double sided diverts not available on 18 in. OAW. working pressure 30 to 40 P.S.I.
AIR CYLINDER–32mm dia. bore x 7/8 in. stroke double acting. Dual cylinder for two-sided DRIVE–Slave driven from main belt conveyor.
diverters.
POSITIONING DIVERTER–Diverter used at infeed of two-sided sorters to position packages for
AIR REQUIREMENTS–Working pressure 30 to 40 P.S.I. depending on width. Free Air Consumption proper diverting.
at 40 P.S.I., .024 cu. ft. per cycle.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes BELT SKIRTS–Hide return belt.
in feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
UNDERSIDE COVER–Attach to belt skirts to cover belt on underside of sorter.
TAKE AWAY LINES–Gravity spurs are available. Consult factory for recommendation of type and
configuration. PROSORT LOGIX SC CONTROL PACKAGE–Provides complete controls for proper sorter operation.
Contact factory for details.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable channel and fixed channel types available.
CATALOG | 08312018
190-E24
The model 190-E24 24 VDC Live Roller Conveyor
24 VDC Live Roller
• All-Electric Operation
uses a series of 24 VDC motors to drive the tread • Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
rollers, eliminating the need for drive belts, chains,
or line shafts.
Quiet operation and ease of maintenance and
installation are just some of the advantages. 190-E24 and 190-E24C
shown together.
Between Rail
9” 11” 13” 15” 17" 19" 21" 23" 25" 27" 31" 33" 37" 39"
Width
Section Length
Overall Frame
12” 14” 16” 18” 20" 22" 24" 26" 28" 30" 34" 36" 40" 42"
Width
Weights
10'-0" 285 300 310 325 340 355 370 385 400 410 435 450 480 495
(lbs.)
Weights
Per Foot 16 17 19 20 21 23 24 26 27 28 31 32 35 36
(lbs.)
NOTE: • Section Lengths are available from 2 ft. to 10 ft, in 6 in. increments.
• Motors are mounted on various centers, and will slave a maximum of 16 rollers. Includes: motor, control board, o-rings, frame and slaved rollers.
OVERALL LENGTH
6 1/2"
•
Curve Conveyor
All-Electric Operation
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports
Available
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 190-E24
BED (E24)—Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube and bearings spaced every 3 CAPACITY—Maximum 37 lbs. per foot with a maximum capacity per E24 motor of 75 lbs. If loading
in. Mounted set-high in 6 1/2 in x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame bolted together product “back to back” use the following chart:
with splice plates. NUMBER OF MOTORS IN CAPACITY
SECTION LENGTH
SECTION (LBS PER FOOT)
BED (E24C)—Roller bed with 2 1/2 in. dia tapered to 1 11/16 in. dia. x 14 ga. galvanized rollers. Mounted
in 6 1/2 x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame. 2’-0” 37
2’-6” 30
MOTOR—24 VDC motor with integrated control card located along section on the inside of the BR on 3’-0” 1 25
straight section only. Maximum slaved rollers is 16 per each motor. 3’-6” 21
SLAVE O-RINGS—3/16 in. dia. polyurethane o-rings slave-drive tread rollers from motor. 4’-0” 19
4’-6” 33
POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS)—40 amp DC power supply, 24 volt fixed output. Maximum of 40 5’-0” 30
motors per power supply. 120 vac, 8.6 amp input. Mounted near center of conveyor. Note: Number 5’-6” 27
of motors per power supply is based on the use of standard Hytrol o-rings. Other o-rings are available
6’-0” 25
that may increase load capacity, but reduce the number of motors that may be powered from one 2
power supply. Contact factory for more information. 6’-6” 23
7’-0” 21
CONVEYING SPEED—25-254 FPM, set on integrated motor control card. 7’-6” 20
8’-0” 19
8’-6” 26
9’-0” 25
3
9’-6” 23
10’-0” 22
NOTE: Capacity is based on the use of standard Hytrol o-rings. Other o-rings are available that
may increase load capacity, but reduce the number of motors that may be powered from one power
supply. Contact factory for more information.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, type A & B angle. (See Accessory section.)
POWER SUPPLY (MOTORS)—20 Amp power supply available. 20 motors maximum. 5 AMP power NOTE: If product comes in contact with guard rails, product flow will be affected.
supply available. 3 motors maximum. 480 Volt Power Supplies also available.
MOTOR AND SEPARATE CONTROL CARD– Available with 3 Amp setting.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS—36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces
required. TANGENTS- Slaved and Powered type available.
CEILING HANGERS—5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated steel rods fully threaded. Other lengths and Motors mounted on outside of channel.
galvanized rods available.
CATALOG | 08312018
PROSORT SC1 & SC2
The Model ProSort SC series of sorters are belt driven
Horizontal Belt Sortation Conveyor
Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
ProSor t
Sortation Systems
SLAVED SPUR
SHAFT-MOUNTED LENGTH
GEAR MOTOR
SINGLE-SIDED POSITIONING DIVERTER
DIVERTER (FOR TWO-SIDED SORTERS)
TWO-SIDED
DIVERTER
MIN. 8'-6" (HEAVY DUTY STANDARD DRIVE) FLOW
MIN 10'-0" (HIGH PERFORMANCE DRIVE)
MIN. DIVERTCENTERS 24" MIN. TO 8'-0" MIN.
6" DISCHARGE TAIL PULLEY INFEED OF
"X" SECTION
6-1/2" 6-7/8"
10-1/4"
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 190-E24SS
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in dia. roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube. Mounted in 6 1/2 in. 12 ga. powder BEARINGS–Pre-lubricated ball bearings in tread rollers.
painted formed steel channel frame.
SPLICE PLATES–Standard for connecting to 190-E24.
SLAVE DRIVEN– Spurs are driven from power supply of Model 190-E24 conveyor. 45° spur has (1)
24 VDC motor with integrated motor control card, 30° spur has (1) 24 VDC motor with integrated CAPACITY–See Load Capacity Chart.
motor control card on 12"-16" OAW, and (2) VDC motor with integrated motor control card on 18"-
42" OAW. Motors mounted on the inside of the B.R. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
SLAVE O-RING–3/16 in. dia. polyurethane o-ring from drive spool to tread roller.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
HIGH SPEED DRIVE SPOOL–Provides a speed range of 50-200 FPM Capacity affected with speed rods available.
change.
MOTOR AND SEPARATE CONTROL CARD– Available with 3 Amp setting.
DRIVE–Motors mounted on the inside of the frame channel.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, fixed channel or type A or B angle. Note: If
product comes in contact with guard rails, product flow will be affected.
CATALOG | 08312018
190-E24EZ
Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports and
24 VDC Live Roller Conveyor optional EZLogic® cover.
(Zero Pressure Accumulating Type)
The model 190-E24EZ Accumulating Conveyor uses a series • EZLogic® Accumulation System
of 24 VDC motors to drive the tread rollers, eliminating the • All-Electric Operation
need for drive belts, chains, or line shafts. • Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
Quiet operation, zero pressure accumulation, and ease of
maintenance and installation are just some of the advantages.
Between Rail
9” 11” 13” 15” 17" 19" 21" 23" 25" 27" 31" 33" 37" 39"
Section Width
Length Overall Frame
12” 14” 16” 18” 20" 22" 24" 26" 28" 30" 34" 36" 40" 42"
Width
Weights U.S. Patent Numbers
10'-0" 320 335 350 365 375 390 405 415 430 445 470 485 510 525 7,243,781 • 7,591,366
(lbs.)
7,905,345 • 6,860,381
Weights
Per Foot 20 21 23 24 26 27 28 30 31 32 35 36 39 41 Other Patents Pending.
(lbs.)
Note: Bed Sections available in the following multiples:
12" Zones–2', 3’, 5’, 6', 7’, 8', 9’
18’’ Zones–3’, 4’-6'’, 6’, 7’-6’’, 9’
24” Zones–2’, 4’, 6’, 8’ & 10’
HOW IT WORKS
30” Zones–2 1/2’, 5’, 7 1/2’ & 10’
36’’ Zones–3’, 6’, 9’
The conveyor is divided into accumulation zones. Each zone is powered
by a 24 VDC Motor. The motor may be turned off to cause product in that
zone to stop. Hytrol’s EZLogic® Zone Controllers sense product presence
SET HIGH EZLOGIC® and control the accumulation and release of product from the zones.
OVERALL LENGTH
OVERALL FRAME WIDTH
SECTION LENGTH EZ-LOGIC ZONE CONTROLLER 1 1/2 " BETWEEN RAIL WIDTH
6 1/2 "
SECTION LENGTH
EZ-LOGIC ZONE CONTROLLER
E24i MOTOR
TREAD ROLLER
1 1/2
8 1/2
2" 2"
IOP UNIT
POWER SUPPLY
OPTIONAL "MS"
SUPPORT SHOWN
CATALOG | 08312018
190-E24EZC • EZLogic® Accumulation System
Powered Roller Curve Conveyor
(Zero Pressure Accumulating Type)
190-E24EZ
CONTROLLER All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only.
Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
BED (E24EZ)—Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube bearings spaced every EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER – Located in each zone. (Retro-reflective). NEMA 1, 2, IP 62. UL
3 in. Mounted in 6 1/2 in x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame bolted together with Approved.
splice plates.
POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS)—40 amp DC power supply, 24 volt fixed output. Maximum of
BED (E24EZC)—Roller bed with 2 1/2 in. dia tapered to 1 11/16 in. dia. x 14 ga. galvanized. Mounted 40 zones per power supply. 120 vac, 24 amp input. Mounted near center of conveyor.
in 6 1/2 x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame.
IOP—Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
MOTOR—24 VDC motor with integrated motor control card. One in each zone of conveyor input/output boards. Operates up to 50 zones with maximum of 25 on either side of IOP. Requires
mounted on inside of BR. 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
SLAVE O-RINGS—3/16 in. dia. polyurethane o-rings slave-drive zone tread rollers from motor. CONVEYING SPEED—25-125 FPM, set on integrated motor control card.
ACCUMULATION ZONES—18 in., 24 in., 30 in., and 36 in. zones available. CAPACITY—Maximum load 37 lbs. per foot, 75 lbs. per zone.
SET LOW CHANNEL– Added additional flanges to make the installation and removal of the FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
optional cover simple.
EZLOGIC® ACCUMULATION SYSTEM Selectable Modes of Operation
Hytrol’s EZLogic®, or “Electronic Zero-pressure Logic” Accumulation System, combines the sensing Singulation Mode – Product separates while traveling down the conveyor and when it is released
accuracy of photo-electronics with discrete electronic logic control without the use of a PLC or from the conveyor - creating a zone-length gap between products.
pneumatic logic components. The EZLogic® Accumulation System provides many features including:
Enhanced Slug Mode w/ Jam Protection – Product does not separate when traveling down the
Zero-Pressure Accumulation of Product onveyor or when it is released from the conveyor. This allows higher product throughput at any
given conveyor speed. Product will not separate on the conveyor even when accumulation has
Zone Stop function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry been activated at the discharge end.
contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always
used at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone Cascaded Slug Release – Rather than releasing all zones simultaneously, this function introduces
stop is required. a momentary delay in the release of each zone, from discharge upstream.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the
length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify POLY-TIER SUPPORTS—36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in required.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
CEILING HANGERS—5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated steel rods fully threaded. Other lengths and
POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS)—120-240 Volt, Single Phase - 20 and 40 amp available. 120 volt galvanized rods available.
at 4.56 amps.
HIGH-SPEED DRIVE SPOOL--Provides a speed range of 50-200 FPM.
POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS) 460 volt, 3 phase – 20 and 40 amp available.
EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
MOTOR AND SEPARATE CONTROL CARD—Available with 3 Amp settings.
CATALOG | 08312018
190-E24EZSS
The model 190-E24 24 VDC Live Roller Conveyor uses a • EZLogic Accumulation System
24 VDC 30°Live Roller
Straight Spur
series of 24 VDC motors to drive the tread rollers, eliminating • All-Electric Operation (Power Supply Optional)
the need for drive belts, chains, or line shafts. • Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
Quiet operation and ease of maintenance and installation are
just some of the advantages.
"B"
30°
OVERALL
FRAME WIDTH
"
"A
BETWEEN
1 1/2
RAIL WIDTH
1/4
HOW IT WORKS
6 1/2
X
The conveyor is divided into accumulation
zones. Each zone is powered by a 24
VDC Motor. The motor may be turned
off to cause product in that zone to
stop. Hytrol’s EZLogic® Zone Controllers
sense product presence and control the
accumulation and release of product
-
X
N
IO
T
C
E
S
from the zones.
190-E24EZSS
THIS DRAWING CONTAINS CONFIDENTIAL C DWG NO
Straight Spur
UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED
DESIGNS WITHOUT THE PRIOR WRITTEN FRACTIONS ±1/64
DECIMALS ±.005
DRAWN BY jfsmith DATE 11/8/2010
PERMISSION OF HYTROL CONVEYOR ANGLES ±1°
CHECKED BY DATE
COMPANY INC.
SPARE PART PAINT CLASS MFG CLASS REVISION
"B"
CATALOG | 08312018
SLAVE O-RING–3/16 in. dia. polyurethane o-ring from drive spool to tread roller. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, fixed channel or type A or B angle. Note: If
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in product comes in contact with guard rails, product flow will be affected.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
POWER SUPPLY FOR MOTORS–40, 20, and 5 AMP available in 115, 230, or 460 volt
CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
HIGH SPEED DRIVE SPOOL–Provides a speed range of 50-200 FPM Capacity affected with speed rods available.
change.
MOTOR AND SEPARATE CONTROL CARD– Available with 3 Amp setting.
DRIVE–Motors mounted on the inside of the frame channel.
CATALOG | 08312018
BZE24EZ
The model BZE24EZ Accumulating conveyor uses a series of
24 VDC Roller Belt Conveyor
(Zero Pressure Accumulating Type)
• EZLogic® Accumulation System
24VDC motors to drive full width belt over roller zones. • All-Electric Operation
Quiet operation, zero pressure accumulation and reduced • Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
belt friction are some of the advantages. • Direct Drive Roller
e24
Conveyor shown with
• Pop-Out Roller TM
optional floor supports
Between Rail
15” 21" 27" 33"
Width
Section U.S. Patent Numbers
Belt Width 14" 20" 26" 32"
Length 5,862,907 • 7,243,781
Overall Frame 7,591,366 • 7,905,345
19-1/4" 25-1/4" 31-1/4" 37-1/4"
Width 6,860,381 •9,714,142
Weights Other Patents Pending.
10'-0" 388 428 468 508
(lbs.)
Weights
Per Foot 27 31 35 39
(lbs.)
Note: Bed Sections available in the following multiples:
24” Zones–2’, 4’, 6’, 8’ & 10’, 30” Zones–2 1/2’, 5’, 7 1/2’ & 10’, 36’’ Zones-3’, 6’, 9’
OVERALLOVERALL
LENGTH LENGTH
8 1/2
8 1/2
1 1/2 BR 2 3/4
EZLOGIC ZONE
CONTROLLER
REFLECTOR
8 1/2
POP-OUT ROLLER
ASSEMBLY
THIS DRAWING CONTAINS CONFIDENTIAL D HYTROL
DWG
Section A-A
CATALOG | 06182019
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS BZE24EZ
BED—Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. roller x 16 ga. galvanized rollers spaced every 3 in. Mounted in 8 EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER – Located in each zone. (Retro-reflective). NEMA 1, 2, IP 62. UL
1/2 in x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame bolted together with splice plates. Approved.
DRIVE ROLLER–1.9 in Dia. Fully Lagged with Trapezoidal Crown. POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS)—40 amp DC power supply, 24 volt fixed output. Maximum of
12 zones per power supply. 120 vac, 4.56 amp input. Mounted near center of conveyor.
BELT–PVC, Endless splice.
IOP—Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
MOTOR—24 VDC, 100W motor. One in each zone of conveyor mounted on outside coupled input/output boards. Operates up to 50 zones with maximum of 25 on either side of IOP. Requires
directly to a lagged drive roller. 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
MOTOR CONTROL CARD–Used with each 24VDC Motor utilizing the 3A setting mounted on CONVEYING SPEED—See below for speed chart.
outside frame.
CAPACITY—Maximum load 37 lbs. per foot, 75 lbs. per zone at 65 FPM.
ACCUMULATION ZONES—24 in., 30 in., and 36 in. zones available.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
SET LOW CHANNEL– Added additional flanges to make the installation and removal of the
optional cover simple.
SPEED CHART
Switches 100W24 125W24
033.0905 033.0905
SW2-1 SW-2 SW-3 SW-4 Standard Card Standard Card
RPM FPM RPM FPM
OFF OFF OFF OFF 280 161 350 201
ON OFF OFF OFF 265 152 331 190
OFF ON OFF OFF 250 144 312 179
ON ON OFF OFF 235 135 293 168
OFF OFF ON OFF 220 126 274 157
ON OFF ON OFF 205 118 255 147
OFF ON ON OFF 190 109 236 136
ON ON ON OFF 175 101 217 125
OFF OFF OFF ON 160 92 198 114
ON OFF OFF ON 145 83 179 103
OFF ON OFF ON 130 75 160 92
ON ON OFF ON 115 66 141 81
OFF OFF ON ON 100 57 122 70
ON OFF ON ON 85 49 103 59
OFF ON ON ON 70 40 84 48
ON ON ON ON 55 32 65 37
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate the
length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in POLY-TIER SUPPORTS—36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces required.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
CEILING HANGERS—5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated steel rods fully threaded. Other lengths and
MOTOR AND CONTROL CARD—Provides speed range of 40-190 FPM. 125 Volt motor at 4A setting galvanized rods available.
on standard card.
EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS)—20 amp power supply available. 6 zones maximum. 120 volt
@ 4.56 amps. BRAKE MOTORS—100W motor with 24VDC brake. Provide 24VDC to release brake. Connects to
standard card.
POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS)— 460 volt, 3 phase – 20 and 40 amp available.
CATALOG | 06182019
BZDE24EZ
The model BZDE24EZ Accumulating Incline conveyor is a
24 VDC Decline Slider Belt Conveyor
(Zero Pressure Accumulating Type)
• EZLogic® Accumulation System
floor-to-floor decline conveyor which uses a series of 24VDC • All-Electric Operation
motors to drive full width belt over slider pan zones. It can be • Direct Drive Roller
equipped with a nose-over transition section at the infeed end • Pop-Out Roller
e24
to ensure a smooth transition from the horiztontal to decline • Adjustable MS-Type Floor TM Conveyor shown with
plane. Supports Available optional floor supports
Between Rail
15” 21" 27" 33"
Width
Section
Belt Width 14" 20" 26" 32" U.S. Patent Numbers
Length 5,862,907 • 7,243,781
Overall Frame 7,591,366 • 7,905,345
19-1/4" 25-1/4" 31-1/4" 37-1/4"
Width 6,860,381 •9,714,142
Weights Other Patents Pending.
16'-0" 500 545 580 623
(lbs.)
Weights
Per Foot 27 31 35 40
(lbs.)
Note: Bed Sections available in the following multiples:
24” Zones–2’, 4’, 6’, 8’ & 10’, 30” Zones–2 1/2’, 5’, 7 1/2’ & 10’, 36’’ Zones-3’, 6’, 9’
CATALOG | 06182019
THIS DRAWING CONTAINS CONFIDENTIAL D HYTROL
DESIGNS AND INFORMATION WHICH ARE
THE PROPERTY OF HYTROL CONVEYOR HYTROL
CONVEYOR CO., I
COMPANY INC. THIS DRAWING AND THE
JONESBORO, ARKAN
INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN MAY NOT
SAME AS BE DISCLOSED OR DUPLICATED IN WHOLE
OR PART, UTILIZED IN ANY OTHER WORK, OR STANDARD TOLERAN
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS BZDE24EZ
BED—Slider bed with 1.9 in Dia. Tracking Roller Mounted in 8 1/2 in x 12 ga. powder painted
formed steel channel frame bolted together with splice plates. EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER – Located in each zone. (Retro-reflective). NEMA 1, 2, IP 62. UL
Approved.
DRIVE ROLLER–1.9 in Dia. Fully Lagged with Trapezoidal Crown.
POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS)—40 amp DC power supply, 24 volt fixed output. Maximum of
BELT–PVC, Endless splice. 12 zones per power supply. 120 vac, 4.56 amp input. Mounted near center of conveyor.
MOTOR—24 VDC, 100W motor. One in each zone of conveyor mounted on outside coupled IOP—Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
directly to a lagged drive roller. input/output boards. Operates up to 50 zones with maximum of 25 on either side of IOP. Requires
120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
MOTOR CONTROL CARD–Used with each 24VDC Motor utilizing the 3A setting mounted on
outside frame. CONVEYING SPEED—See below for speed chart.
ACCUMULATION ZONES—24 in., 30 in., and 36 in. zones available. CAPACITY—See below for per zone capacity chart.
SET LOW CHANNEL– Added additional flanges to make the installation and removal of the FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
optional cover simple.
SPEED CHART
NOSE-OVER SECTION– A zone length section provides a transition of product from horizontal Switches 100W24 125W24
to decline. 033.0905 033.0905
SW2-1 SW-2 SW-3 SW-4 Standard Card Standard Card
POWERED FEEDER/ TAIL BED– A zone length with roller section driven by a 24VDC motor.
RPM FPM RPM FPM
OFF OFF OFF OFF 280 161 350 201
ON OFF OFF OFF 265 152 331 190
OFF ON OFF OFF 250 144 312 179
Angle (Degrees) Decline (lbs) OFF OFF ON OFF 220 126 274 157
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate
the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify POLY-TIER SUPPORTS—36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces required.
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. CEILING HANGERS—5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated steel rods fully threaded. Other lengths and
galvanized rods available.
MOTOR AND CONTROL CARD—Provides speed range of 37-201 FPM. 125 Volt motor at 4A setting
on standard card. EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS)—20 amp power supply available. 6 zones maximum. 120 volt BRAKE MOTORS—100W motor with 24VDC brake. Provide 24VDC to release brake. Connects to
@ 4.56 amps. standard card.
POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS)— 460 volt, 3 phase – 20 and 40 amp available. DECLINE WITH ROLLERS—Rollers are available. Contact Factory for Capacity.
CATALOG | 06182019
BZIE24EZ
The model BZIE24EZ Accumulating conveyor uses a series
24 VDC Incline Roller Belt Conveyor
(Zero Pressure Accumulating Type)
• EZLogic® Accumulation System
of 24VDC motors to drive full width belt over bolt in pan zones. • All-Electric Operation
Quiet operation, zero pressure accumulation with a roller bed • Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
design are some of the advantages. It can be equipped with • Direct Drive Roller
e24
a nose-over transition section at the infeed end to ensure a • Pop-Out Roller TM
Conveyor shown with
smooth transition from the horiztontal to incline plane. optional floor supports
Between Rail
15” 21" 27" 33"
Width
Section
Belt Width 14" 20" 26" 32" U.S. Patent Numbers
Length 5,862,907 • 7,243,781
Overall Frame 7,591,366 • 7,905,345
19-1/4" 25-1/4" 31-1/4" 37-1/4"
Width 6,860,381 •9,714,142
Weights Other Patents Pending.
16'-0" 500 545 580 623
(lbs.)
Weights
Per Foot 27 31 35 40
(lbs.)
Note: Bed Sections available in the following multiples:
24” Zones–2’, 4’, 6’, 8’ & 10’, 30” Zones–2 1/2’, 5’, 7 1/2’ & 10’, 36’’ Zones-3’, 6’, 9’
H
E24 MOTOR
LENGT
E BED
INCLIN E LENGTH)
(ZON BELT
CLUTCH ROLLER
TREAD ROLLER
FEEDER LENGTH
(ZONE LENGTH)
MOTOR CONTROL
CARD
2° - 20°
OPTIONAL SUPPORT
"MS" SHOWN
DRIVE ROLLER–1.9 in Dia. Fully Lagged, Trapezoidal Crown POWERED FEEDER/TAIL BED– A horizontal zoned length section driven by a 24 VDC motor.
CLUTCH ROLLER—1.9 in Dia. One Directional Roller included in incline zones. EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER – Located in each zone. (Retro-reflective). NEMA 1, 2, IP 62. UL
Approved.
BELT–PVC, Endless splice.
POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS)—40 amp DC power supply, 24 volt fixed output. Maximum of
MOTOR—24 VDC, 100W motor. One in each zone of conveyor mounted on outside coupled 12 zones per power supply. 120 vac, 9.12 amp input. Mounted near center of conveyor.
directly to a lagged drive roller.
IOP—Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
MOTOR CONTROL CARD–Used with each 24VDC Motor utilizing the 3A setting mounted on input/output boards. Operates up to 50 zones with maximum of 25 on either side of IOP. Requires
outside frame. 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
ACCUMULATION ZONES—24 in., 30 in., and 36 in. zones available. CONVEYING SPEED—30 lbs see below capacity chart per zone at 65 FPM.
SET LOW CHANNEL– Added additional flanges to make the installation and removal of the CAPACITY—See below for Capacity Chart
optional cover simple.
SPEED equipment.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional CHART
Switches 100W24 125W24
033.0905 033.0905
SW2-1 SW-2 SW-3 SW-4 RPM RPM
Standard Card Standard Card
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate
the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system flexibility.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS)— 460 volt, 3 phase – 20 and 40 amp available.
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in Motors mounted on outside of channel.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS—36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces required.
MOTOR AND CONTROL CARD—24VDC, 125W with Standard card with dip switch set accordingly.
Provides speed range of 40-190 FPM. CEILING HANGERS—5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated steel rods fully threaded. Other lengths and
galvanized rods available.
POWER SUPPLY (FOR MOTORS)—20 amp power supply available. 6 zones maximum. 120 volt
@ 4.56 amps. EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 06182019
190-NSP
The Model 190-NSP Live Roller Spool Conveyor is a general
Live Roller Conveyor
• 12 Bed Widths
transport conveyor with the capabilities of accumulating • Reversible
products with back pressure. Quiet operation, versatile • Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Conveyor shown with
design, easy installation and maintenance make the 190- Available optional floor supports
NSP conveyor a valuable component in operations requiring
high performance with minimal downtime.
SIZE TO Between
13" 15" 17" 19" 21" 23" 25" 27" 31" 33" 37" 39"
ORDER Rail Width
Overall Overall
Length "A" 16" 18" 20" 22" 24" 26" 28" 30" 34" 36" 40" 42"
Frame Width
5’ 229 236 249 259 272 284 293 307 329 341 364 376
10’ 371 384 409 426 450 472 488 514 553 576 618 639
15’ 513 533 569 594 629 660 684 721 778 811 872 902
20’ 655 682 729 761 808 848 880 928 1003 1046 1126 1166
25’ 797 830 889 929 987 1036 1076 1135 1228 1281 1380 1429
30’ 939 979 1049 1096 1166 1224 1271 1342 1453 1517 1634 1692
35’ 1082 1128 1209 1264 1344 1413 1467 1549 1678 1752 1888 1956
40’ 1224 1276 1369 1431 1523 1601 1663 1756 1903 1987 2142 2219
WEIGHTS
45’ (Lbs.) 1366 1425 1529 1599 1702 1789 1859 1963 2127 2222 2396 2483
50’ Weights 1508 1574 1689 1767 1881 1977 2054 2170 2352 2458 2650 2746
55’ Based on 1650 1723 1849 1934 2060 2165 2250 2377 2577 2693 2904 3009
60’ 3" Roller 1793 1871 2009 2102 2239 2354 2446 2584 2802 2928 3158 3273
Centers
65’ 1935 2020 2169 2269 2417 2542 2642 2791 3027 3163 3412 3536
70’ 2077 2169 2329 2437 2596 2730 2837 2998 3252 3399 3666 3800
75’ 2219 2317 2489 2604 2775 2918 3033 3205 3477 3634 3920 4063
80’ 2361 2466 2649 2772 2954 3106 3229 3412 3702 3869 4174 4326
85’ 2503 2615 2809 2939 3133 3294 3425 3619 3926 4104 4428 4590
90’ 2646 2764 2969 3107 3311 3483 3621 3826 4151 4340 4682 4853
95’ 2788 2912 3129 3274 3490 3671 3816 4033 4376 4575 4936 5117
100’ 2930 3061 3289 3442 3669 3859 4012 4240 4601 4810 5190 5380
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
OVERALL
OVERALL LENGTH "A" FRAME WIDTH
SECTION “X-X”
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 190-NSP
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube spaced every 3 in. Mounted in 9 1/2 DRIVE O-RING–3/16 in. dia. polyurethane o-ring from drive spool to tread rollers.
in. x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame bolted together with splice plates.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings with eccentric lock collar on drive
CROSS BRACING–Rods with turnbuckles are fastened to underside of bed to provide proper shaft. Pre-lubricated ball bearings in tread rollers.
alignment of bed rollers and insure correct product tracking. Supplied to section adjoining drive
and every other section, 20 ft bed lengths and over. Supplied on bed lengths 9 ft and over. SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive shaft.
DRIVE–Mounted underneath, placed near center of conveyor. NOTE: On Conveyors less than 24 in. MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz Totally Enclosed C-Face.
OAW motor extends beyond frame. Chain guard located on left hand side.
CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
DRIVE SHAFT–1 in. dia. steel shaft extends full length of conveyor. Chain coupling at bed joints.
Located on left hand side. CAPACITY–Maximum load per powered roller–15 lbs. NOTE: Maximum load capacity will be less
for products with soft or irregular bottoms. Total load NOT TO EXCEED capacity in chart.
DRIVE SPOOLS–2 in. dia. Delrin spool held in place on drive shaft with spool spacers.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
DRIVE GUARD–Underside of drive shaft with spools and drive o-rings guarded full length of
conveyor.
1) Powered drive shaft (coupled at bed joints) is bearing MOTOR SELECTION CHART
supported on frame.
2) Drive o-ring transmits power to tread rollers from drive FPM 30-44 45-120
shaft. HP (MAX) 1 2
3) Drive spool (held in place by spool spacers) and groove
in tread roller keep drive o-ring in position. If the required horsepower exceeds the maximum horsepower shown in the chart, more than one drive is
4) If back pressure (accumulation) is applied to tread roller, required
drive spool will slip on drive shaft, stopping power to
tread roller.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
REVERSING O-RING TRANSFER– See Accessories section.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds from 30 to 120 FPM. Over 120 FPM timing
belt drive recommended. Capacity affected with speed change. GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, fixed channel or type A & B angle. Note: If
product comes in contact with guard rails, product flow will be affected. Fixed channel overlapping,
SIDE MOUNTED DRIVE–with Hytrol Reducer. one direction. Fixed channel non-overlapping, reversing.
SIDE MOUNTED DRIVE–with Gearmotor. PACKAGE STOPS–Blade, roller or pin type stops available, contact factory.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
regular lubrication).
CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
LOW ELEVATION DRIVE–Gearmotor mounted inside of conveyor. Minimum elevation 11 1/4 in. rods available.
POSITIVE DRIVE–Spools are keyed to drive shaft in positive drive areas. MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
CROSSOVER–Separate section relocates drive shaft from one side of conveyor to the other. Minimum ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing or reversible magnetic starters and push-button stations.
Elevation—12 3/8 in. AC variable frequency drive.
CATALOG | 07262019
190-NSPC
The 190 Spool Curves and Spurs are designed to be slave • 12 Bed Widths
driven from the 190-NSP Conveyor. Curves are used where • Slave Driven from Model 190-NSP
turns in the conveyor line are necessary. Spurs are used in • Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
diverging and converging applications.
190-NSPS
SHAFT COUPLING
SHAFT COUPLING
"X" "X" "X" "X" "X" "X" "X" "X"
Width Width 45º 30º 45º 30º 45º 30º 45º 30º 45º 30º 45º 30º 45º 30º
FRAME WIDTH BETWEEN
1-1/2"
RAIL WIDTH
13" 16" 24" 29" 38" 27" 36" 21" 30" 21 7/8" 38" 50" 42 1/4" 8T/12S 10T/11S 173 1761-1/2"
BETWEEN
RAIL WIDTH 1/4"
15" 18" 32" 41" 30" 39" DRIVE
230 263 DRIVE O-RING
1/4"
O-RING
17" 20" 35" 47" 33" 45" 240 274
19" 22" 38" 50" 36" 48" 4-1/2" 250 283 9-1/2"
21" 24" 32 1/2" 41" 53" 39" 51" 36" 54" 35" 63" 66 5/8" 61 5/8" 10T/17S 12T/19S 259 293SHAFT DRIVE
23" 26" 44" 56" 42" 54" DRIVE 268 303COUPLING SPOOL
GUARD DRIVE
25" 28" 47" 62" 45" 60" 280 316 GUARD
27" 30" 50" 65" 48" 63" 288 325
31" 34" 56" 74" 54" 72" 410 499
33" 36" 59" 77" 57" 75" 422 513
48" 48" 75" 48" 89" 86" 85 1/2" 14T/21S 20T/26S
37" 40" 65" 86" 63" 84" 446 540
39" 42" 68" 89" 66" 87" 457 553 SECTION “X-X”
*T = TAPERED S = STRAIGHT
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. "A" "A"
Accessories, crating, etc., are not included. "B" 45˚ "B" 30˚
DRIVE SHAFT
"C"
"U" JOINT "C"
"E"
"E" 45˚ "U" JOINT
60˚
18"
RIGHT LEFT DRIVE
SHAFT 6-1/4"
HAND HAND "D"
SHAFT COUPLING SHAFT
"R"
"R" COUPLING
"D"
"X" "X" "X" "X"
CATALOG | 08312018
190-NSPSS
"A" "A"
"B" "B"
"X"
OVERALL
FRAME WIDTH
SHAFT BETWEEN
1-1/2"
55-5/32" COUPLING LOCK
85-3/4" RAIL WIDTH
COLLAR
1/4"
"X" "X" DRIVE
O-RING
NOTE: DARK SHAFT INDICATES POSITIVE DRIVE SPOOLS.
9-1/2"
DRIVE
SPOOL
DRIVE
WEIGHTS GUARD
Between Overall "A" "B"
Rail Frame (Lbs.)
Width Width 45º 30º 45º 30º 45º 30º
13" 16" 29" 38" 27" 36" 177 224
15" 18" 32" 41" 30" 39" 184 233 SECTION “X-X”
17" 20" 35" 47" 33" 45" 191 241
19" 22" 38" 50" 36" 48" 198 249
21" 24" 41" 53" 39" 51" 204 256 LOAD CAPACITY CHART
23" 26" 44" 56" 42" 54" 210 262 190-NSPC 190-NSPS 190-NSPSS
25" 28" 47" 62" 45" 60" 219 272 Overall
Capacity Per Capacity Per Capacity Per
Frame
27" 30" 50" 65" 48" 63" 225 278 Curve Spur (Lbs.) St. Spur (Lbs.)
Width
31" 34" 56" 74" 54" 72" 237 290 (Lbs.) 45º 30º 45º 30º
33" 36" 59" 77" 57" 75" 242 296 16" 240 300 285
37" 40" 65" 86" 63" 84" 253 306 18" to 30" 300 405 435 375 480
39" 42" 68" 89" 66" 87" 256 310 34" to 42" 450 540 720
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only.
Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
BED–Roller bed with 2 1/2 in. dia. tapered to 1 11/16 in. dia. x 14 ga. galvanized and 1.9 in. dia. roller x
16 ga. galvanized tube. Mounted in 9 1/2 in. x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame. DRIVE O-RING–3/16 in. dia. polyurethane o-ring from drive spool to tread roller.
SLAVE DRIVEN–Curves and spurs are slave driven from drive shaft of Model 190-NSP conveyor. BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings with eccentric lock collar on drive
Shafts are coupled by chain coupling at bed joints. shaft. Pre-lubricated ball bearings in tread rollers.
DRIVE SHAFT–1 in. dia. steel shaft extends full length of conveyor, coupled with universal joints SPLICE PLATES–Standard for connecting to 190-NSP.
(U joints) at necessary intervals.
CAPACITY–See Load Capacity Chart.
DRIVE SPOOLS–2 in. dia. Delrin spool held in place on drive shaft with spool spacers.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
DRIVE GUARD–Underside of drive shaft with spools and drive o-rings guarded full length of
conveyor.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, fixed channel or type A or B angle. Note: If
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in product comes in contact with guard rails, product flow will be affected.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds from 30 to 120 FPM. Over 120 FPM timing
belt drive recommended. Capacity affected with speed change. CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
rods available.
DRIVE–24 in. long drive section replaces standard 6 1/4 in. or 18 in. tangent on end of 190-NSPC or
190-NSPS. No change on 190-NSPSS. Specify RH or LH. OPTIONAL TANGENTS–Available in 3 in. increments up thru 48 in. long.
CATALOG | 08312018
138-ACC
The simplest method ever devised for accumulating cartons,
Horizontal Power Conveyor
(Accumulating Type)
• 4 Bed Widths
boxes, etc. Basic design eliminates complicated adjustments • 2% Minimum Back Pressure
and allows a minimum of 2% back pressure. • Finger Tip Snub Roller Adjustment, No Tools Needed
• Reversible Conveyor shown
with optional floor
• Adjustable LS-Type Floor Supports Available supports
SIZE TO Between
10" 13" 16" 22"
ORDER Rail Width
Overall Overall
Length "A" 12" 15" 18" 24"
Frame Width
5’ 214 231 249 284
10’ 337 369 402 466
15’ 461 507 555 648
20’ 584 645 708 830
25’ 708 783 861 1012
30’ 831 921 1014 1194
35’ 955 1059 1167 1376
40’ 1078 1197 1320 1558
WEIGHTS
45’ (Lbs.) 1202 1335 1473 1740
50’ Weights 1325 1473 1626 1922
55’ Based on 1449 1611 1779 2104
60’ 1 1/2" Roller 1572 1749 1932 2286
Centers
65’ 1696 1887 2085 2468
70’ 1819 2025 2238 2650
75’ 1943 2163 2391 2832
80’ 2066 2301 2544 3014 Conveyor sections are easily coupled together at
85’ 2190 2439 2697 3196 either end to make up to 100 ft. long units. Drive
90’ 2313 2577 2850 3378 is usually located near center of conveyor.
95’ 2437 2715 3003 3560
100’ 2560 2863 3156 3742
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only.
Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
NOTE: Intermediate bed sections are available in multiples of 4 ft., 5 ft., 6 ft., 7 1/2 ft.,
8 ft., and 10 ft. lengths only.
RETURN TAKE-UP
OVERALL LENGTH "A" SHEAVE
OVERALL
FRAME WIDTH 1-3/8" DIA.
1" TREAD ROLLER
END 5-3/4" DIA.
GUARD "Y" "X" DOUBLE GROOVE 1/4" BETWEEN
RAIL WIDTH DRIVE V-BELT
SHEAVE SUSPENSION
ANGLE
6-1/2"
18" KNURLED NUT
11-1/4"
2" 2"
1-3/8" DIA. RETURN
PRESSURE ROLLER TAKE-UP
13-1/4" SHEAVE
MAX.
16"
ALLOW
12" 29-1/4" "Y" "X"
SECTION “X-X”
OPTIONAL LS SUPPORT SHOWN
3-5/8"
CROSS BRACING–Rods with turnbuckles are fastened to underside of bed to provide proper SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive shaft.
alignment of bed rollers and insure correct product tracking. Supplied to section adjoining drive
and every other section, 20 ft bed lengths and over. Supplied on bed lengths 9 ft and over. MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
DRIVE BELT–Endless B-section aramid core V-Belt drives each section of conveyor. CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 50 lbs. NOT TO EXCEED capacity in chart.
RETURN TAKE-UP SHEAVE–3 1/4 in. dia. x 1/2 in. bore flat idler has seven position adjustment to FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
maintain proper V-belt tension.
• HOW IT WORKS
The driving of the tread rollers on the HYTROL minimum pressure conveyor is accomplished with the top surface of a standard section endless V belt. The strength and wear qualities of the tread rollers
and this belt have been thoroughly tested for continuous duty.
To maintain the driving of the tread roller, the pressure roller is mounted in spring adjusted carriers (See Photo) which sense the required driving friction regardless of the length of accumulated load. This
pressure can be maintained constantly to give a 2% minimum back pressure in either a forward or reverse direction.
In the event of extreme changes in unit load (weight of box or package), convenient knurled thumb adjusting nuts can be turned to accept this heavier load.
This method eliminates the need for selecting proper tension spring holes in trigger mechanisms or jogging cleats on driving belt and eccentric (off center) tread rollers.
By maintaining a constant minimum pressure on the tread rollers, long loads may be conveyed, accumulated or stopped on the conveyor at any point using very little motor horsepower and giving
practically no pressure between boxes or packages.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–LS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in PACKAGE STOPS–Roller or pin type stops available, contact factory.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above LS-6 support.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, fixed channel or type A & B angle. See
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds from 25 to 120 FPM. Note: Capacity and Accessory section. NOTE: If product comes in contact with guard rails, product flow will be affected.
accumulation feature affected with speed change. Fixed channel overlapping, one direction. Fixed channel nonoverlapping, reversing.
SIDE MOUNTED DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor. Minimum elevation with POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
standard sheave retainer 10 in. With low elevation sheave retainer 8 in. 9 3/8 in. elevation at drive,
9 7/8 in elevation with standard sheave return. 8 in. elevation with low elevation sheave return CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
(intermediate only). rods available.
V-BELT DRIVE–V-belt supplied between motor and reducer. Minimum overall drive width 14 in. MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing or reversible magnetic starters and push-button stations.
regular lubrication). AC variable frequency drive.
CATALOG | 07262019
138-LRC
The Model 138-LRC is a light-duty live roller curve that •
Live Roller Curve
Conveyor
4 Bed Widths
provides a positive drive for negotiating 90°, 60°, 45°, or 30° • Reversible
turns. It may be self-powered or can be slave driven from • Adjustable LS-Type Floor Supports Available
138-ACC, LRS or LRSS conveyors.
Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
138-LRC
Between Overall Number WEIGHTS
Rail Frame "A" "B" "C" "R" of Rollers** (Lbs.)
Width Width 90º 60º 45º 30º 90º 60˚ 45º 30º
10" 12" 272 262 252 242
13" 15" 3 1/16" 9 3/4" 9 5/8" 25" 30S 38S 34S 30S 278 268 258 248
16" 18" MAX. 287 277 267 257
22" *24" 10 5/16" 10 1/8" 32 1/2" 22T/4S 14T/12S 10T/12S 6T/12S 302 292 282 272
*T = TAPERED S = STRAIGHT
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only.
Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
*NOTE: 24 in. OAW curve has 1.9 in. dia. tapered & straight rollers mounted in a 6 1/2 in. x 1 in. x 12 ga. painted form steel channel.
18-3/8" "B"
6-1/2"
PRESSURE
TOTALLY SHEAVE "C"
2"
ENCLOSED
V-BELT GUARD OPTIONAL
LS SUPPORT V-BELT TAKE-UP
SHOWN END
GUARD
SECTION “X-X” SECTION “Y-Y”
"R"
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 138-LRC
BED–(LRC) Roller bed with 1 3/8 in. dia. roller x 18 ga. galvanized tube and 5/16 in. HRS hex shafts BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self aligning ball bearings with eccentric lock collar on flange
(12 in.–18 in. OAW) and 2 1/2 in. dia. tapered to 1 11/16 in. dia. roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube and 1.9 and pillow block bearings. Pre-lubricated ball bearings in tread rollers.
in. dia. straight rollers x 16 ga. galvanized tube 7/16 in. HRS hex shafts (24 in. OAW). Mounted in 6 1/2
in. x 12 ga powder painted formed steel channel frame. BUTT COUPLINGS–Standard for connecting 138-ACC, 138-LRS, and 138-LRSS.
END DRIVE–Mounted underneath bed section on outside radius. SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear reducer, driven by V-belt. No. 50 roller chain to drive
sheave.
DRIVING BELT–Endless B-section V-Belt, industrial grade.
MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 PH. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed.
PRESSURE SHEAVES–2 1/2 in. dia. with 3/8 in. bore.
CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
IDLER SHEAVE–4 in. dia. x 5/8 in. bore V type and/or 5 1/2 in. dia. x 5/8 in. bore flat type.
CAPACITY–150 lbs. total distributed live load.
TAKE-UP–Take-ups provided to maintain proper V-belt tension. Includes 4 3/8 in. dia. x 5/8 in. bore
V type take-up sheave. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
Horsepower required to slave-drive LRC’s & LRCT’s from ACC’s affect the lengths NOTE:
of ACC’s due to the capacities of the driving V-belt. The four (4) arrangements • CURVES MAY BE 30°, 45°, 60, & 90 °
shown, illustrate basic slave limitations. Other arrangements are possible. • CURVES ARE NOT ACCUMULATING
• SNUB ROLLER ADJUSTMENT IS ON DRIVE BELT SIDE OF CONVEYOR
3
10' MAX.
4
60' MAX. STRAIGHT 80' MAX. STRAIGHT
LRC LRC SLAVE
LRC SLAVE DRIVEN DRIVEN
SLAVE DRIVEN
DRIVE CENTRALLY
DRIVE BELT MOUNTED DRIVE BELT DRIVE
10' MAX. 10' MAX.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–LS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, fixed channel, type A or B angle. See
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in Accessory section. Note: If product comes in contact with guard rails, product flow will be affected.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above LS-6 support.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds from 25 to 120 FPM. NOTE: Capacity
affected with speed change. CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
rods available.
END DRIVE–Mounted on inside radius. Minimum elevation 18 7/8”.
SLAVE DRIVEN–Standard drive may be omitted and curve slave driven from 138-ACC. (Specify by
SIDE MOUNTED DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor. Specify inside or outside. sketch, location of slave connection). Minimum elevation 10 1/2 in.
Minimum elevation 11 1/16 in.
MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 1 HP maximum.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
regular lubrication). ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing or reversible magnetic starters and push-button stations.
AC variable frequency drive.
CATALOG | 08312018
138-LRS
Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
"F"
DRIVE 6-1/2"
PRESSURE "G"
SHEAVE
OPTIONAL LS SUPPORT SHOWN
V-BELT
TAKE-UP
END GUARD
"A" "A"
"B" 45˚ "B" 30˚
"Y"
"C" "E" "Y"
"C"
"E" 45˚ 12-1/4"
12-1/4"
60˚
"Y" "Y"
"R" 13"
18" 6-1/4"
13"
"R"
"D" 4" "D"
4" OAW
"X" "X" "X" "X"
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 138-LRS
BED–Roller bed with 1 3/8 in. dia. roller x 18 ga. galvanized tube and 5/16 in. HRS hex shafts (12 in. MOUNTING BRACKET–Bracket is supplied to attach spur to side channels of 138-ACC conveyor.
thru18 in. OAW) and 2 1/2 in. dia. tapered to 1 11/16 in. dia. roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube and 1.9 in.
dia. straight rollers x 16 ga. galvanized tube 7/16 in. HRS hex shafts (24 in. OAW). Mounted in 6 1/2 in. BUTT COUPLINGS–Standard for connecting 138-ACC and 138-LRC.
x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame.
SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear reducer, driven by V-belt. No. 50 roller chain to drive
END DRIVE–Mounted underneath bed section on outside radius. sheave.
DRIVING BELT–Endless B-section V-Belt, industrial grade. MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 PH. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed.
PRESSURE SHEAVES–2 1/2 in. dia. with 3/8 in. bore. CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
IDLER SHEAVE–4 in. dia. x 5/8 in. bore V type and/or 5 1/2 in. dia. x 5/8 in. bore flat type. CAPACITY–150 lbs. total distributed live load.
TAKE-UP–Take-up provided to maintain proper V-belt tension. Includes 4 3/8 in. dia. x 5/8 in. bore FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
V type take-up sheave.
BEARINGS–Pre-lubricated, self aligning ball bearings in tread rollers. Flange and pillow block
bearings are sealed, pre-lubricated with eccentric lock collar.
• SPUR APPLICATIONS Live Roller Spurs are used to transfer cartons, etc., onto and off of main conveyor lines. The illustrations below shows the correct usage
of Plows and Turning Wheels with Spurs in Diverging and Converging applications.
DIVERGING CONVERGING
30° most desirable transfer angle Both 30° and 45° are desirable transfer angles
MOUNTING
BRACKET CONVEYOR
SIDE CHANNEL
RH LH
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–LS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail–Fixed channel–Type A or B angle. See
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in Accessory section. NOTE: If product comes in contact with guard rails, product flow will be affected.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above LS-6 support.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments . Knee braces supplied.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds from 25 to 120 FPM. NOTE: Capacity
affected with speed change. CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
rods available.
END DRIVE–Mounted on inside radius. Minimum elevation 18 7/8”.
SLAVE DRIVEN–Standard drive may be omitted and curve slave driven from 138-ACC. (Specify by
SIDE MOUNTED DRIVE–Motor-reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor. Specify inside or outside. sketch, location of slave connection). Minimum elevation 10 1/2 in.
Minimum elevation–11 1/16 in.
MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 1/2 HP maximum.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
regular lubrication). ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing or reversible magnetic starters and push-button stations.
AC variable frequency drive.
CATALOG | 08312018
138-LRSS
The Model 138-LRSS Live Roller Straight Spur is used
Live Roller Straight
•
Spur Conveyor
4 Bed Widths
in diverging or converging applications. It may be self- • Reversible
powered or can be slave driven from 138-ACC, LRC, or LRS • Right or Left Hand Units Available
conveyors. • Adjustable LS-Type Floor Supports Available
"A" "A"
"B" 45˚ "B" 30˚
"Y"
34-23/32" "Y"
49-1/32" "X"
69" 4" 69"
"X"
4" OAW
48-13/16" 59-3/4"
OAW 2" (12" OAW ONLY) "X"
"Y" "Y"
2" (12" OAW ONLY)
"X"
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 138-LRSS
BED–Roller bed with 1 3/8 in. dia. roller x 18 ga. galvanized tube 5/16 in. HRS hex shafts spaced every
1 1/2 in. Mounted in 6 1/2 in. x 12 ga. powder painted steel frame. MOUNTING BRACKET–Bracket is supplied to attach spur to side channels of 138-ACC conveyor.
END DRIVE–Mounted underneath bed section. BUTT COUPLINGS–Standard for connecting 138-ACC and 138-LRC.
DRIVE BELT–Endless B-section aramid core V-Belt drives each section of conveyor. SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive sheave.
PRESSURE SHEAVES–2 1/2 in. dia. with 3/8 in. bore. MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 PH. 60 Hz Totally Enclosed.
SNUB RETURN SHEAVE–3 1/4 in. dia. x 1/2 in. bore flat idler has seven position adjustment. CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
TAKE-UP–Take-up provided to maintain proper V-belt tension. Includes 4 3/8 in. dia. x 5/8 in. bore CAPACITY–150 lbs. total distributed live load.
V type take-up sheave.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
BEARINGS–Tread rollers have pre-lubricated, self aligning ball bearings. Flange and pillow block
bearings are sealed, pre-lubricated with eccentric lock collar.
• SPUR APPLICATIONS Live Roller Spurs are used to transfer cartons, etc., onto and off of main conveyor lines. The illustrations below shows the correct usage of
Plows and Turning Wheels with Spurs in Diverging and Converging applications.
DIVERGING CONVERGING
30° most desirable transfer angle Both 30° and 45° are desirable transfer angles
RH LH
SPUR CURVE CHANNEL
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–LS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above LS-6 support.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
BED LENGTHS–57 in. and 63 in. Drive not available on all lengths and widths. Contact factory.
CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds from 25 to 120 FPM. NOTE: Capacity
rods available.
affected with speed change.
SLAVE DRIVEN–Standard drive may be omitted and spur slave driven from 138-ACC. (Specify by
SIDE MOUNTED DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor. Minimum elevation with
sketch, location of slave connection). Minimum elevation 10 1/2 in.
standard sheave retainer 11 1/16 in.
MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 1/2 HP maximum.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
regular lubrication).
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing or reversible magnetic starters and push-button stations.
AC variable frequency drive.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, fixed channel, type A & B angle. (See
Accessory section.) NOTE: If product comes in contact with guard rails, product flow will be
affected.
CATALOG | 08312018
190-ACC
The simplest method ever devised for accumulating cartons,
Horizontal Power Conveyor
(Accumulating Type)
• 12 Bed Widths
boxes, etc. Basic design eliminates complicated adjustments • 2% Minimum Back Pressure
and allows a minimum 2% back pressure. Conveyor shown with
• Finger Tip Snub Roller Adjustment, No Tools Needed optional floor supports
• Reversible
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
Between
SIZE TO Rail Width 13" 15" 17" 19" 21" 23" 25" 27" 31" 33" 37" 39"
ORDER
Overall Overall
Length "A" Frame 16" 18" 20" 22" 24" 26" 28" 30" 34" 36" 40" 42"
Width
5’ 231 238 252 263 277 289 299 314 337 350 375 387
10’ 370 384 410 429 455 477 495 522 564 588 633 655
15’ 509 530 568 595 633 665 691 730 791 826 891 923
20’ 648 676 726 761 811 853 887 938 1018 1064 1149 1191
25’ 787 822 884 927 989 1041 1083 1146 1245 1302 1407 1459
30’ 926 968 1042 1093 1167 1229 1279 1354 1472 1540 1665 1727
35’ 1065 1114 1200 1259 1345 1417 1475 1562 1699 1778 1923 1995
40’ 1204 1260 1358 1425 1523 1605 1671 1770 1926 2016 2181 2263 Conveyor shown with
WEIGHTS featured option - shaft
45’ (Lbs.) 1343 1406 1516 1591 1701 1793 1867 1978 2153 2254 2439 2531
mounted drive.
50’ Weights 1482 1552 1674 1757 1879 1981 2063 2186 2380 2492 2697 2799
55’ Based on 1621 1698 1832 1923 2057 2169 2259 2394 2607 2730 2955 3067 SPEED CHART FOR SHAFT MOUNTED
60’ 3" Roller 1760 1844 1990 2089 2235 2357 2455 2602 2834 2968 3213 3335 DRIVE ON 190ACC
Centers MAX MOTOR
65’ 1899 1990 2148 2255 2413 2545 2651 2810 3061 3206 3471 3603 SPEED FPM
HP FRAME
70’ 2038 2136 2306 2421 2591 2733 2847 3018 3288 3444 4503 3871 26 1/2 56C
75’ 2177 2282 2464 2587 2769 2921 3043 3226 3515 3682 3987 4139 32 1 56C
43 1 56C
80’ 2316 2428 2622 2753 2947 3109 3239 3434 3742 3920 4245 4407 52 1 56C
85’ 2455 2574 2780 2919 3125 3297 3435 3642 3969 4158 3503 4675 64 2 140TC
86 2 140TC
90’ 2594 2720 2938 3085 3303 3485 3631 3850 4196 4396 4761 4943 103 2 140TC
95’ 2733 2886 3096 3251 3481 3673 3827 4058 4423 4634 5019 5211 129 2 140TC
*172 2 140TC
100’ 2872 3012 3254 3417 3659 3861 4023 4266 4650 4872 5277 5479 *257 2 140TC
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included. *343 2 140TC
NOTE: Stockyard drives are located on 10 ft beds only.
NOTE: 16”, 20”, 22”, 26”, 28”, 34”, 36”, 40” & 42” Overall Frame Widths - 1 Week Stockyard
NOTE: Intermediate bed sections are available in multiples of 4 ft., 5 ft., 6 ft., 7 1/2 ft., 8 ft., and 10 ft lengths only.
RETURN
TAKE-UP
OVERALL LENGTH "A" SHEAVE OVERALL
1-1/4” DIA. DRIVE SHAFT FRAME WIDTH 1.9" DIA.
1-1/2" TREAD ROLLER
END GUARD 5-3/4" DIA. 1/4" BETWEEN
1” DIA. TAIL AND "Y" "X" DOUBLE RAIL WIDTH DRIVE V-BELT
INTERMEDIATE SHAFT GROOVE
SHEAVE SUSPENSION
ANGLE
18-11/16" 6-1/2"
MAX.
2" 12-1/8" MAX. KNURLED NUT
2"
13-1/4"
MAX. 16" 1.9" DIA. RETURN
PRESSURE ROLLER TAKE-UP
SHEAVE
29-1/4" "Y" "X"
ALLOW 16"
OPTIONAL MS SUPPORT SHOWN SECTION “X-X”
3/8” 4-3/8"
1-1/8”
6-3/4” 1/4”
10-1/2"
FEATURED OPTION-
6-1/2”
SHAFT MOUNTED DRIVE
10-1/2” SHOWN MOUNTED HORIZONTAL 3-3/4" TOTALLY
ENCLOSED
CHAIN GUARD
SECTION “Y-Y”
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 190-ACC
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube spaced every 3 in. and 1.9 in. dia. BEARINGS–Tread & pressure rollers have pre-lubricated ball bearings. Flange and pillow block
pressure rollers x 16 ga. galvanized tube spaced every 6 in. Mounted in 6 1/2 in. x 12 ga. powder bearings are sealed, pre-lubricated with eccentric lock collar.
painted formed steel channel frame bolted together with butt couplings.
SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive shaft.
CROSS BRACING–Rods with turnbuckles are fastened to underside of bed to provide proper
alignment of bed rollers and insure correct product tracking. Supplied to section adjoining drive MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
and every other section, 20 ft bed lengths and over. Supplied on bed lengths 9 ft and over.
CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 25 - 120 FPM.
DRIVE–Mounted underneath, placed near center of conveyor.
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 150 lbs. NOT TO EXCEED capacity in chart.
DRIVE BELT–Endless B-section aramid core V-Belt drives each section of conveyor.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
RETURN TAKE-UP SHEAVE–3 1/4 in. dia. x 1/2 bore flat idler has seven position adjustment to
maintain proper V-belt tension.
• HOW IT WORKS
The driving of the tread rollers on the HYTROL minimum pressure conveyor is accomplished with the top surface of a standard section endless flat belt. The strength and wear qualities of the tread rollers
and this belt have been thoroughly tested for continuous duty.
To maintain the driving of the tread roller, the pressure roller is mounted in spring adjusted carriers (See Photo) which sense the required driving friction regardless of the length of accumulated load. This
pressure can be maintained constantly to give a 2% minimum back pressure in either a forward or reverse direction.
In the event of extreme changes in unit load (weight of box or package), convenient knurled thumb adjusting nuts can be turned to accept this heavier load.
This method eliminates the need for selecting proper tension spring holes in trigger mechanisms or jogging cleats on driving belt and
eccentric (off center) tread rollers.
By maintaining a constant minimum pressure on the tread rollers, long loads may be conveyed, accumulated or stopped on the conveyor at any point using very little motor horsepower and giving
practically no pressure between boxes or packages.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
PACKAGE STOPS–Roller or pin type stops available.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, fixed channel, type A & B angle. (See
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant speeds from 25 to 120 FPM. V-belt drive supplied under 56 FPM
Accessory section.) NOTE: If product comes in contact with guard rails, product flow will be affected.
(with 1 HP). NOTE: Capacity and accumulation feature affected with speed change.
Fixed channel overlapping, one direction. Fixed channel non-overlapping, reversing.
SHAFT MOUNTED DRIVE – Motor reducer unit mounted on extended drive shaft. Can be mounted
ROLLER CENTERS–Tread rollers spaced every 2 in. and 4 in. (NOT AVAILABLE in 7 ft. 6 in. bed).
with standard sheave retainer for 10 ½ in. elevation (motor horizontal), or can be mounted with low
elevation sheave retainer for 8 3/4 in. elevation (motor vertical). Mounting bracket and torque arm
SPRING BALANCED GATE – See 190-E24G powered or gravity die spring balanced gate.
allows for multiple mounting positions.
See above chart for speeds.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
SIDE MOUNTED DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor. Elevation 10 1/2 in. with
CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
standard sheave retainer. 9 3/8 in. elevation at drive, 8 3/4 in. elevation at intermediate when low
rods available.
elevation sheave retainer used.
MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
V-BELT DRIVE–V-belt supplied between motor and reducer.
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing or reversible magnetic starters and push-button stations.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
AC variable frequency drive.
regular lubrication).
CATALOG | 07262019
190-LRC
The Model 190-LRC is a medium-duty live roller curve that •
Live Roller
Curve Conveyor
12 Bed Widths
provides a positive drive for negotiating 30°, 45°, 60°, or 90° • Reversible
turns. It may be self-powered or can be slave driven from • Tapered Tread Rollers
190-ACC, LRS or LRSS conveyors. • Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
6-1/4"
12-1/4" 4"
13" "X" 4" "X" 4"
"X" "X"
8" 18"
4" 13" 18"13"
OAW OAW
OAW 18" 13"
"Y" "X" "X"
12-1/4"
"X" 12-1/4"
8" 8" 12-1/4" 8"
"X" "Y" 45 o
"Y"
90o TAKE-UP TAKE-UP SHEAVE "Y"
"Y" 60o (V TYPE) 30 o
SHEAVE (V TYPE) TAKE-UP SHEAVE "R"
6-1/4" "Y" (V TYPE)
"Y" "Y"
18" 18" 18"
"R"
IDLER SHEAVE IDLER SHEAVE "R"
("V" TYPE) IDLER SHEAVE "R" IDLER SHEAVE "R"
(FLAT TYPE) (FLAT TYPE) (FLAT TYPE)
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 190-LRC
BED–Roller bed with 2 1/2 in. dia. tapered to 1 11/16 in. dia. x 14 ga. galvanized and 1.9 in. dia. BUTT COUPLINGS–Standard for connecting 190-ACC, 190-LRS, 190-LRSS, 190-ACZ, or 190-LR
roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube. Mounted in 6 1/2 in. x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel conveyors.
frame.
SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear speed reducer driven by V-belt. No. 50 roller chain to
END DRIVE–Mounted underneath bed section on outside radius. drive sheave.
DRIVING BELT–Endless B-section V-Belt, industrial grade. MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 PH. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed.
PRESSURE SHEAVES–2 1/2 in. dia. with 3/8 in. bore. CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
IDLER SHEAVE–4 in. dia. x 5/8 in. bore V type and/or 5 1/2 in. dia. x 5/8 in. bore flat type. CAPACITY–500 lbs. total distributed live load.
TAKE-UP–Take-ups provided to maintain proper V-belt tension. Includes 4 3/8 in. dia. x 5/8 in. bore FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
V type take-up sheave.
BEARINGS–Tread rollers have pre-lubricated ball bearings. Flange and pillow block bearings are
sealed, pre-lubricated with eccentric lock collar.
Horsepower required to slave-drive LRC’s & LRCT’s from ACC’s affect the lengths NOTES
of ACC’s due to the capacities of the driving V-belt. The four (4) arrangements • CURVES MAY BE 30°, 45°, 60, & 90 °
shown, illustrate basic slave limitations. Other arrangements are possible. • CURVES ARE NOT ACCUMULATING
• SNUB ROLLER ADJUSTMENT IS ON DRIVE BELT SIDE OF CONVEYOR
1 10' MAX. 2
DRIVE
LRC 60' MAX. STRAIGHT LRC
SLAVE DRIVEN SLAVE DRIVEN
DRIVE BELT
DRIVE CENTRALLY
DRIVE BELT MOUNTED
10’ MAX.
10' MAX. 10' MAX.
3
10' MAX. 4
60' MAX. STRAIGHT 80' MAX. STRAIGHT
LRC LRC SLAVE
LRC SLAVE DRIVEN DRIVEN
SLAVE DRIVEN
DRIVE CENTRALLY
DRIVE BELT MOUNTED DRIVE BELT DRIVE
10' MAX. 10' MAX.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, fixed channel or type A & B angle. (See
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in Accessory section.) Note: If product comes in contact with guard rails, product flow will be affected.
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments . Knee braces supplied.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds from 25 to 120 FPM. Note: Capacity CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
affected with speed change. rods available.
END DRIVE–Mounted on inside radius. Minimum elevation 18 7/8”. SLAVE DRIVEN–Standard drive may be omitted and curve slave driven from 190-ACC, 190-ACZ, or
190-LR conveyors. (Specify by sketch, location of slave connection). Minimum elevation 11 in.
SIDE MOUNTED DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor. Specify inside or outside.
Minimum elevation 11 1/8 in. MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 1 HP maximum.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing or reversible magnetic starters and push-button stations.
regular lubrication). AC variable frequency drive.
CATALOG | 08312018
190-LRS
Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
Live Roller
Spur Conveyor
The Model 190-LRS Live Roller Spur is used in diverging or • 12 Bed Widths
converging applications. It may be self-powered or can be • Reversible
slave driven from 190-ACC, LRC, or LRSS conveyors. • Right or Left Hand Units Available
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
V-BELT TAKE-UP
OPTIONAL MS
SUPPORT SHOWN
SECTION “X-X” SECTION “Y-Y”
"A" "A"
"B" 45˚ "B"
30˚
IDLER SHEAVE
(FLAT TYPE) "C"
"Y" "C"
TAKE-UP SHEAVE "Y" "E"
("V" TYPE) 12-1/4"
45˚
"E" 12-1/4" 60˚
"Y" 13" "Y"
18" 6-1/4"
13"
"R"
4" "R" 4" "D"
"X" "X"
"D"
"X" "X"
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 190-LRS
BED–Roller bed with 2 1/2 in. dia. tapered to 1 11/16 in. dia. roller x 14 ga. galvanized and 1.9 in. dia. MOUNTING BRACKET–Bracket is supplied to attach spur to side channels of 190-ACC, 190-ACZ,
roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube. Mounted in 6 1/2 in. x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel or 190-LR conveyors.
frame.
BUTT COUPLINGS–Standard for connecting 190-ACC, 190-LRC, 190-ACZ, or 190-LR conveyors.
END DRIVE–Mounted underneath bed section on outside radius.
SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear reducer driven by V-belt. No. 50 roller chain to drive
DRIVING BELT–Endless B-section V-Belt, industrial grade. sheave.
PRESSURE SHEAVES–2 1/2 in. dia. with 3/8 in. bore. MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 PH. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed.
IDLER SHEAVE–4 in. dia. x 5/8 in. bore V type or 5 1/2 in. dia. x 5/8 in. bore flat type. CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
TAKE-UP–Take-ups provided to maintain proper V-belt tension. Includes 4 3/8 in. dia. x 5/8 in. V CAPACITY–500 lbs. total distributed live load.
type take-up sheave.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
BEARINGS–Tread rollers have pre-lubricated ball bearings. Flange and pillow block bearings are
sealed, pre-lubricated with eccentric lock collar.
• SPUR APPLICATIONS Live Roller Spurs are used to transfer cartons, etc., onto and off of main conveyor lines. The illustrations below show the correct usage of
Plows and Turning Wheels with Spurs in Diverging and Converging applications.
DIVERGING CONVERGING
30° most desirable transfer angle Both 30° and 45° are desirable transfer angles
PLOW OR CORNER TURNING WHEEL
DEFLECTOR
PRODUCT
PRODUCT FLOW
FLOW
30˚
30˚ or 45˚
MOUNTING
BRACKET CONVEYOR
SIDE CHANNEL
RH LH
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments . Knee braces supplied.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds from 25 to 120 FPM. NOTE: Capacity
affected with speed change.
CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
rods available.
END DRIVE–Mounted on inside radius. Minimum elevation 18 7/8”.
SLAVE DRIVEN–Standard drive may be omitted and curve slave driven from 190-ACC, 190-ACZ, or
SIDE MOUNTED DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor. Minimum elevation–11
190-LR conveyors. (Specify by sketch, location of slave connection). Minimum elevation 11 in.
1/16 in.
MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 1 HP maximum.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
regular lubrication).
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing or reversible magnetic starters and push-button stations.
AC variable frequency drive.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, fixed channel, type A & B angle. (See
Accessory section.) NOTE: If product comes in contact with guard rails, product flow will be
affected.
CATALOG | 08312018
190-LRSS
The Model 190-LRSS Live Roller Straight Spur is used •
Live Roller Straight
Spur Conveyor
12 Bed Widths
in diverging or converging applications. It may be self- • Reversible
powered or can be slave driven from 190-ACC, LRC, or LRS • Right or Left Hand Units Available
conveyors. • Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
OVERALL
FRAME WIDTH DRIVING
1-1/2" V-BELT SHEAVE SNUB 1-1/4” DIA. DRIVE SHAFT BELT TAKE-UP
BETWEEN RAIL RETURN
ROLLER MOUNTING
TOTALLY WIDTH 1/4" END GUARD SHEAVE BED BRACKET
ENCLOSED
CHAIN GUARD
17-13/16"
10-1/4" 6-1/2" 2" PRESSURE
16" SHEAVE
17-13/16" 13-1/4"
29-1/4" ALLOW 16"
11-1/16"
END OPTIONAL MS SUPPORT SHOWN
GUARD
"A" "A"
"B" 45˚ "B" 30˚
49-11/16"
"Y"
"X" "Y"
55-11/32"
4-3/8" 99"
78"
"X"
4-3/8" OAW
55-5/32" 85-3/4"
OAW
"X" "X"
"Y" "Y"
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 190-LRSS
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube spaced every 3 in. Mounted in 6 1/2 MOUNTING BRACKET–Bracket is supplied to attach spur to side channels of 190-ACC, 190-ACZ,
in. x 12 ga powder painted formed steel channel frame. or 190-LR conveyors.
END DRIVE–Mounted underneath bed section. BUTT COUPLINGS–Standard for connecting 190-ACC, 190-LRC, 190-ACZ, or 190-LR conveyors.
DRIVE BELT–Endless B-section aramid core V-Belt drives each section of conveyor. SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive sheave.
PRESSURE SHEAVES–2 1/2 in. dia. with 3/8 in. bore. MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 PH. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed.
SNUB RETURN SHEAVE–3 1/4 in. dia. x 1/2 in. bore flat idler has seven position adjustment. CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
TAKE-UP–Take-ups provided to maintain proper V-belt tension. Includes 4 in. dia. x 5/8 in. bore V CAPACITY–500 lbs. total distributed live load.
type take-up sheave.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
BEARINGS–Tread rollers have pre-lubricated ball bearings. Flange and
pillow block bearings are sealed, pre-lubricated with eccentric lock collar.
• SPUR APPLICATIONS Live Roller Spurs are used to transfer cartons, etc., onto and off of main conveyor lines. The illustrations below show the correct usage
of Plows and Turning Wheels with Spurs in Diverging and Converging applications.
DIVERGING CONVERGING
30° most desirable transfer angle Both 30° and 45° are desirable transfer angles
PLOW OR
CORNER TURNING WHEEL
DEFLECTOR
PRODUCT
PRODUCT FLOW
FLOW
30˚ or 45˚
30˚
RH LH
SPUR CURVE CHANNEL
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. regular lubrication).
BED LENGTHS–57 in., 63 in., 69 in., 75 in., 81 in., and 87 in. Drive not available on all lengths and GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail–Fixed channel–Type A or B angle. See
widths. Contact factory. Accessory section. Note: If product comes in contact with guard rails, product flow will be affected.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds from 25 to 120 FPM. NOTE: Capacity CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully
affected with speed change. threaded. Other lengths and galvanized rods available.
SHAFT MOUNTED DRIVE – Motor reducer unit mounted on extended drive shaft. Can be mounted SLAVE DRIVEN–Standard drive may be omitted and spur slave driven from 190-ACC, 190-ACZ, or
with standard sheave retainer for 10 1/2 in. elevation (motor horizontal), or can be mounted with low 190-LR conveyors. (Specify by sketch, location of slave connection). Minimum elevation–11 in.
elevation sheave retainer for 8 3/4 in. elevation (motor vertical). Mounting bracket and torque arm
allows for multiple mounting positions. MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 1 HP maximum.
See chart page 47 (190-ACC) for speeds.
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing or reversible magnetic starters and push-button stations.
SIDE MOUNTED DRIVE–Motor-reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor. Minimum elevation–11 AC variable frequency drive.
1/2 in.
CATALOG | 08312018
190-ACZ
The Model ACZ accumulates cartons, boxes, etc. Basic
Horizontal Power Conveyor
(Accumulating Type)
• 12 Bed Widths
design eliminates complicated adjustments and allows a • 2% Minimum Back Pressure
minimum of 2% Back Pressure. • Finger Tip Snub Roller Adjustment, Both Sides
• Reversible
• Center Drive Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
Between
Rail Width 13" 15" 17" 19" 21" 23" 25" 27" 31" 33" 37" 39"
SIZE TO
ORDER Drive Belt
6" 8"
Overall Width
Length "A" Overall
Frame
Width 16" 18" 20" 22" 24" 26" 28" 30" 34" 36" 40" 42"
10’ 385 416 448 479 509 551 581 612 679 720 771 803
15’ 521 552 596 637 679 733 774 816 908 950 1033 1077
20’ 657 688 744 797 849 915 967 1020 1137 1190 1295 1351
25’ 793 824 898 956 1019 1097 1160 1224 1366 1430 1557 1625
30’ 929 960 1040 1115 1189 1279 1353 1428 1595 1670 1819 1899
35’ 1065 1096 1188 1274 1359 1461 1546 1632 1824 1910 2081 2173
40’ 1201 1232 1336 1433 1529 1643 1739 1836 2053 2150 2343 2447
45’ WEIGHTS 1337 1368 1484 1592 1699 1825 1932 2040 2282 2390 2605 2721
50’ (Lbs.) 1473 1504 1632 1751 1869 2007 2125 2244 2511 2630 2867 2995
Weights
55’ 1609 1640 1780 1910 2039 2189 2318 2448 2740 2870 3129 3269
Based on
60’ 3" Roller 1745 1776 1928 2069 2209 2371 2511 2652 2969 3010 3391 3543
65’ Centers 1886 1912 2076 2228 2379 2553 2704 2856 3198 3350 3653 3817
70’ 2017 2048 2224 2387 2549 2735 2897 3060 3427 3590 3915 4091
75’ 2153 2184 2372 2546 2719 2917 3090 3264 3656 3830 4177 4365
80’ 2289 2320 2520 2705 2889 3099 3283 3468 3885 4070 4439 4639
85’ 2425 2456 2668 2864 3059 3281 3476 3672 4114 4310 4701 4913
90’ 2561 2592 2816 3023 3229 3463 3669 3876 4343 4550 4963 5187
95’ 2697 2728 2964 3182 3399 3645 3862 4080 4572 4790 5225 5461
100’ 2833 2864 3112 3341 3569 3827 4055 4284 4801 5030 5487 5735
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 190-ACZ
BELT–Ultimate 140 BBS–Nitrile.
TAKE-UP–Take-ups in center drive. Provides 16 in. of belt take-up.
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube spaced every 3 in. and 1.9 in. dia.
pressure roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube spaced every 6 in. Mounted in 6 1/2 in. x 12 ga. powder BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive, tail, and take-up pulleys.
painted formed steel channel frame bolted together with butt couplings. Pre-lubricated ball bearings in tread and pressure rollers.
CROSS BRACING–Rods with turnbuckles are fastened to underside of bed to provide proper SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm C-Face gear reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive sheave.
alignment of bed rollers and insure correct product tracking. Supplied to section adjoining drive
and every other section, 20 ft bed lengths and over. Supplied on bed lengths 9 ft and over. MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 PH. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
CENTER DRIVE–Can be placed in any section of conveyor length. CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 7/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, fully lagged. CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 150 lbs. NOT TO EXCEED capacity in chart.
TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft at bearings,machine crowned. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, fixed channel, type A angle elevated to
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. allow for pop-out tread rollers. Type B angle not available. (See Accessory section.) NOTE: If product
comes in contact with guard rails, product flow will be affected. Fixed channel overlapping, one
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds from 20 to 90 FPM. V-belt drive supplied direction. Fixed channel non-overlapping, reversing.
under 46 FPM (2 HP) and with variable speeds. NOTE: Capacity and accumulation feature affected
with speed change. ROLLER CENTERS–Tread rollers spaced every 4 in., 6 in., or 8 in. (4 in. or 8 in. centers NOT AVAILABLE
in 7 ft. 6 in. bed).
SIDE MOUNTED LOW ELEVATION CENTER DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor.
Minimum low elevation16 in. POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
SIDE MOUNTED END DRIVE–Minimum elevation 12 1/4 in. (underside take-up required). CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
rods available.
V-BELT DRIVE–V-belt supplied between motor and reducer. Allow 65 in.
MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, brakemotor, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
regular lubrication). ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing or reversible magnetic starters and push–button stations.
AC variable frequency drive.
PACKAGE STOPS–Roller or pin type stops available, contact factory.
CATALOG | 07262019
ABLR
The Model ABLR is a horizontal belt driven live roller conveyor,
Live Roller Conveyor
• 11 Bed Widths
Conveyor shown in
standard Hytrol Blue.
Between
15" 17" 19" 21" 23" 25" 27" 31" 33" 37" 39"
Rail Width
Overall
18" 20" 22" 24" 26" 28" 30" 34" 36" 40" 42"
Frame Width
10'-0"
670 693 716 739 762 785 808 854 877 923 946
Base Weight
Weight
31 33 35 37 39 41 43 47 49 53 55
Per Foot
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
Total Weight = 10' Base Weight + per foot weight x extra length
6-1/2''
END
GUARD
21-5/8''
13-9/16''
2''
21'' 38-1/4''
ALLOW 12''
62''
1.9'' DIA.
TREAD ROLLER 6'' DIA.
4'' DIA. 2-1/8'' DIA.
TAKE-UP PULLEY
TAIL PULLEY SNUB IDLER
END
GUARD
END
GUARD
21-5/8''
14-7/8''
2''
ALLOW 12''
8'' DIA. DRIVE PULLEY
68-1/4''
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS ABLR
BELT–6 in. Black Ultimate 140 SD.
SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive shaft.
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube spaced every 3 in. Mounted in 6 1/2 in. x
12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame bolted together with butt coupling. MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
CROSS BRACING–Rods with turnbuckles are fastened to underside of bed to provide proper alignment CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
of bed rollers and insure correct product tracking. Supplied to section adjoining drive and every other
section, 20 ft bed lengths and over. Supplied on bed lengths 9 ft and over. CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 150 lbs. Total load NOT TO EXCEED capacity in
charts.
CENTER DRIVE–Can be placed in any section of conveyor 7’-6” or longer. Center drive is 18 in. OAW
on all widths. FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 7/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings. LOAD CAPACITY CHART @ 65 FPM
TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 7/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned. OVERALL FRAME OVERALL FRAME OVERALL FRAME
WIDTH WIDTH WIDTH
TAKE-UP PULLEY–6 in. dia. with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned. HP 18" TO 22" 24" TO 30" 34" TO 42"
TOTAL LOAD (LBS.) TOTAL LOAD (LBS.) TOTAL LOAD (LBS.)
SNUB IDLER–Adjustable 2 1/8 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings. UP TO 50' UP TO 100' UP TO 50' UP TO 100' UP TO 50' UP TO 100'
1/2 1100 200 600 – – –
RETURN IDLER–Adjustable 1.9 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings.
1 3300 2400 2800 1600 2200 –
TAKE-UP–Take-ups in center drive. Provides 16 in. of belt take-up. 2 7000 6000 6400 5200 5800 3300
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive and tail pulleys. Pre-lubricated
ball bearings in tread and pressure rollers.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail. See Accessory section. NOTE: If product
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. comes into contact with Guard Rails, product flow will be affected. Fixed channel overlapping-one
direction.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. FPM. V-belt drive supplied under 17 FPM.
Note: Capacity affected with speed change. PACKAGE STOPS–Angle and raised roller end stops.
HIGH PERFORMANCE UNDERSIDE CENTER DRIVE–Required on units over 100 ft long, maximim POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces required.
length 200’-0” (used with 2 HP, 3 HP or 5 HP motor and reducers).
CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated steel rods fully threaded. Other lengths and
SIDE MOUNTED LOW ELEVATION CENTER DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor. galvanized rods available.
Minimum low elevation16 in. with old style and 18 in. with new style.
MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
V-BELT DRIVE–V-Belt supplied between motor and reducer. Allow 65 in.
ELECTRICAL MOTOR CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starters and push-button stations. AC
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit variable frequency drive.
regular lubrication).
CATALOG | 07262019
NBLR
The Model NBLR is a horizontal narrow belt driven live
Live Roller Conveyor
• Endless Splice Belt
roller conveyor, designed to transport light to medium • Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
cartons. Applications vary from manufacturing to distribution • 1.9" Diameter Rollers with ABEC-1 Bearings
operations.
Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports
Between Rail
15" 21" 27" 33" 39"
Width
Overall Frame
18" 24" 30" 36" 42"
Width
Base Weight 574 634 694 754 814
Weight Per Foot 18 24 30 36 42
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
Note: Bed sections available in the following multiples:
Total Weight = 12' Base Weight + per foot weight x extra length
Base Weight - 12' Section w/Drive & Tails
OVERALL LENGTH
(12’-0” )
8 1/2
End Guard
13 1/4
Spring Take-up
4" Dia. Take-up Pulley
4" Dia. Drive Pulley 4" Dia. Snub Pulley
A
95 DRIVE LENGTH
OVERALL WIDTH
6 3/4
SET LOW SHOWN WITH STANDARD DRIVE T.O.R.
(Located in the first bed section 9' or longer from infeed end)
(Minimun elevation 20" Top of Roller)
20 3/32
T.O.R.
CATALOG | 07222019
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS NBLR
BED— Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. Rollers x 16 ga. Galvanized tube spaced every 3 in. Mounted in
8-1/2 in. x 12 ga. Powder painted formed steel channel frame bolted with ABEC-1 bearings and SET LOW CHANNEL– 8-1/2" deep "C" Channel.
with butt couplings.
CAPACITY— Maximum load per 35 lbs/ft.
BELT— 45MM wide polyurethane thermoplastic with aramid cords.
PRESSURE FRAME CARRIAGE— Contains two Delrin rollers to provide positive drive to four tread
CENTER DRIVE— Can be placed on any section of conveyor 9'-0" or longer with Spring take-up in rollers through the length of unit.
center drive provides 32 in. of belt take-up.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment.
Specify top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated steel rods fully threaded. Other lengths and
conveyor. Holes in feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. galvanized rods available.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail. See Accessory section. Note: If product ELECTRICAL MOTOR CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starters and push-button stations.
comes into contact with Guard Rails, product flow will be affected. Fixed channel overlapping- AC variable frequency drive.
one direction.
BELT SPLICE KIT - Includes press, finger cutter and guide rail.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces
required.
CATALOG | 07222019
ABEZ
The Model ABEZ is a horizontal belt driven live roller
Live Roller Conveyor
(Zero Pressure Accumulating Type)
• EZLogic® Accumulation System
conveyor, designed for applications that require accumulation • Singulation, Slug or Cascaded Slug Operation
of products without a build-up of line pressure. Product may • Dynamic Zone Allocation
be released in singulation or slug fashion. • 4 Brake Rollers in Each Zone Conveyor shown with
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available optional floor supports
8 7/16 9 13/32
End 2
Guard 13-9/16” End
22 3/4 Guard
21 38 1/4 Allow 12”
59
END 8-1/2”
GUARD
21-5/8''
14-7/8''
68-1/4''
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS ABEZ
BELT–6 in. Black Ultimate 140 SD. ACCUMULATION ZONES–12, 18, 24, 30 and 36 in. long air controlled. Includes 4 brake rollers to
stop package. Section lengths change with zone lengths. (See Note opposite page). Note: 51 or
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube spaced every 3 in. Mounted in 6 1/2 more zones will require an additional IOP, isolation cable and power supply T cable.
in. x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame bolted together with butt coupling.
EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER – Located in each zone. (Retro-reflective). NEMA 1, 2, IP 62. UL
CROSS BRACING–Rods with turnbuckles are fastened to underside of bed to provide proper Approved.
alignment of bed rollers and insure correct product tracking. Supplied to section adjoining drive
and every other section, 20 ft bed lengths and over. Supplied on bed lengths 9 ft and over. IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
input/output boards. Operates up to 50 zones (25 each side of IOP). Requires 120VAC or 230VAC
CENTER DRIVE–Can be placed in any section of conveyor 7’-6” or longer. Center drive is 18 in. single phase input.
OAW on all widths.
AIR REQUIREMENTS–Recommended working pressure 35 P.S.I. Free air consumption at 35
DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 7/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings. P.S.I.– .003 cu. ft. per sensor actuation.
TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 7/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned. FILTER, REGULATOR–One filter/regulator is supplied for the main air supply line. (3/8 inch NPT
port). Main air from compressor should be supplied to each filter/regulator.
TAKE-UP PULLEY–6 in. dia. with 1 3/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned.
SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive shaft.
SNUB IDLER–Adjustable 2 1/8 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings.
MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
RETURN IDLER–Adjustable 1.9 in. dia. pre-lubricated ball bearings.
CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
TAKE-UP–Take-ups in center drive. Provides 16 in. of belt take-up.
CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 150 lbs. Total load NOT TO EXCEED capacity
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings on drive and tail pulleys. Pre- in charts.
lubricated ball bearings in tread and pressure rollers.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
SET LOW CHANNEL– Added additional flanges to make the installation and removal of the
optional cover simple.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in regular lubrication).
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail. See Accessory section. Note: If product
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds. FPM. V-belt drive supplied under 17 FPM. comes into contact with Guard Rails, product flow will be affected. Fixed channel overlapping-one
Note: Capacity and accumulation feature affected with speed change. direction.
CENTER DRIVE WITH EXTENDED TAKE UP– Provides 36 in. of additional belt take up. PACKAGE STOPS–Angle and raised roller end stops.
HIGH PERFORMANCE UNDERSIDE CENTER DRIVE–Required on units over 100 ft long, maximim POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces required.
length 200’-0” (used with 2 HP, 3 HP or 5 HP motor and reducers).
CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated steel rods fully threaded. Other lengths and
SIDE MOUNTED LOW ELEVATION CENTER DRIVE–Motor reducer unit mounted to side of conveyor. galvanized rods available.
Minimum low elevation16 in. with old style and 18 in. with new style.
MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
PRESSURE SWITCH–Installed in air line after regulator unit. Kills conveyor drive when air pressure
drops below minimum working requirements. Requires restart controller (not supplied). ELECTRICAL MOTOR CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starters and push-button stations. AC
variable frequency drive.
V-BELT DRIVE–V-Belt supplied between motor and reducer. Allow 65 in.
EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 07262019
NBEZ
The Model NBEZ is a horizontal narrow belt driven live roller
A
Live Roller Conveyor
(Zero Pressure Accumulating Type)
• EZLogic® Accumulation System
conveyor, designed for applications that require accumulation • All Electric Accumulation
of products without a build-up of line pressure while providing • Dense Product Accumulation
conveyor solutions for high-throughput, high density and • Endless Splice Belt
utilizing 24VDC electro-magnet actuation to engage the • 1.9" Diameter Rollers with ABEC-1 Bearings Conveyor shown with
pressure carriage to drive the rollers. optional floor supports
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
O-Rings
Double-grooved Rollers
Belt Guards
6 3/4 8 1/2
T.O.R.
20 3/32
2 13 1/4 2
95 DRIVE LENGTH
CATALOG | 06182019
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS NBEZ
BED— Roller bed with 1.9in. dia. rollers x 16ga. Galvanized tube with ABEC-1 bearings spaced
every 3 in. mounted in 8-1/2 in x 12 ga. Powder painted formed steel channel frame bolted EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER – Located in each zone. Retro-reflective. NEMA 1,2, IP 62. UL
together with butt couplings. approved.
BELT— 45MM wide polyurethane thermoplastic with aramid cords and endless splice. IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
input/output boards. Operates up to 50 zones (25 each side of IOP). Requires 120VAC or 230VAC
CENTER DRIVE— Can be placed on any conveyor section 9ft – 0 in. or longer; spring take-up single phase input.
which provides 32 in. of belt take-up.
ACCUMULATION ZONES— 24 and 36 in. long electrically actuated. Note: Over 50 zones require
GEARMOTOR— Shaft-mounted hollow bore an additional IOP, isolation cable and power supply T cable.
BRAKE— Full zone at discharge. CAPACITY— Maximum load per zone 75 lbs.
SPEED RANGE— 51 – 275 FPM PRESSURE FRAME CARRIAGE— Located on 12 in. centers and contains two Delrin rollers to drive
four tread rollers when electrically actuated
SET LOW CHANNEL– 8-1/2” deep “C” channel.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment.
Specify top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated steel rods fully threaded. Other lengths and
conveyor. Holes in feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. galvanized rods available.
BRAKES–4-roller Electro-magnetic brakes located at the discharge of zone and can be placed ELECTRICAL MOTOR CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starters and push-button stations.
in any or all zones. AC variable frequency drive.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail. See Accessory section. Note: If product EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
comes into contact with Guard Rails, product flow will be affected. Fixed channel overlapping-
one direction. BELT SPLICE KIT– Includes press, finger cutter and guide rail.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces
required.
CATALOG | 06182019
NBEZA Live Roller Conveyor
(Zero Pressure Accumulating Type)
The Model NBEZ is a horizontal narrow belt driven live roller • EZLogic® Accumulation System
conveyor, designed for applications that require accumulation • Pneumatic Actuation
of products without a build-up of line pressure while providing • Endless Splice Belt
conveyor solutions for high-throughput, high density and • Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
utilizing pneumatic actuation to engage the pressure carriage Conveyor shown with
to drive the rollers. optional floor supports
OVERALL LENGTH
(12’-0” )
13 1/4
95 DRIVE LENGTH A
OVERALL WIDTH
6 3/4 8 1/2
T.O.R.
20 3/32
T.O.R.
CATALOG | 07222019
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS NBEZA
BED— Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. Rollers x 16 ga. Galvanized tube with ABEC-1 bearings spaced Approved.
every 3 in. Mounted in 8-1/2 in. x 12 ga. Powder painted formed steel channel frame bolted
together with butt couplings. IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
input/output boards. Operates up to 50 zones (25 each side of IOP). Requires 120VAC or 230VAC
BELT— 45MM wide polyurethane thermoplastic with aramid cords. single phase input.
CENTER DRIVE— Can be placed on any conveyor section 9ft – 0 in. or longer; spring take-up ACCUMULATION ZONES— 24, and 36 in. long pneumatically actuated. Note: Over 50 zones
which provides 32 in. of belt take-up. require an additional IOP, isolation cable and power supply T cable.
GEARMOTOR— Shaft-mounted hollow bore CAPACITY— Maximum load per zone 75 lbs.
BRAKE— Full zone at discharge. PRESSURE FRAME CARRIAGE— Contains two Delrin rollers to provide positive drive to four tread
rollers when actuated by air bag.
SPEED RANGE— 51 – 275 FPM
AIR REQUIREMENTS— Recommended working pressure 12 psi.
SET LOW CHANNEL– 8-1/2" Deep "C" channel.
FILTER, REGULATOR–One filter/regulator is supplied for the main air supply line. (3/8 inch NPT
EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER – Located in each zone. (Retro-reflective). NEMA 1, 2, IP 62. UL port). Main air from compressor should be supplied to each filter/regulator.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment.
Specify top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated steel rods fully threaded. Other lengths and
conveyor. Holes in feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. galvanized rods available.
BRAKES–4-roller air-operated brakes located at the discharge of zone and can be placed in any ELECTRICAL MOTOR CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starters and push-button stations.
or all zones. AC variable frequency drive.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail. See Accessory section. Note: If product EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
comes into contact with Guard Rails, product flow will be affected. Fixed channel overlapping-
one direction. BELT SPLICE KIT– Includes press, finger cutter and guide rail.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces
required.
CATALOG | 07222019
25-LREZ
The Model 25-LREZ is a belt driven live roller conveyor
Heavy Duty Accumulating Conveyor
• EZLogic® Accumulation System Conveyor shown with
optional floor supports and
designed for use where zero pressure accumulation, low • Compact Drive Diffuse EZLogic® Zone
elevation (12”) and close roller centers are required. • Low Elevation Controllers.
• Adjustable LRAS-Type Floor Supports Available
SIZE TO Between
39" 41" 43" 45" 47" 49" 51" 61"
ORDER Rail Width
Overall Overall U.S. Patent Numbers
Length "A" 42" 44" 46" 48" 50" 52" 54" 64"
Frame Width 7,243,781 • 7,591,366
10' 1261 1296 1331 1366 1400 1435 1470 1645 7,905,345
Other Patents Pending.
15' 1764 1815 1867 1918 1970 2021 2072 2329
20' 2267 2335 2403 2471 2538 2606 2674 3014
25' 2770 2854 2939 3023 3107 3192 3276 3698
WEIGHTS
30' 3272 3373 3474 3575 3675 3776 3877 4382
(Lbs.)
35' 3776 3893 4011 4128 4245 4363 4480 5067
40' 4279 4413 4547 4680 4814 4948 5082 5751
45' 4781 4931 5082 5232 5382 5533 5683 6435
50' 5284 5451 5618 5784 5951 6118 6285 7119
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
Overall lengths in chart are for 60" zones. Other zone lengths will affect overall length.
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 25-LREZ
BELT–14 in. black Ultimate 140 SD. TREAD ROLLER BRAKE–Friction type brake stops tread rollers to prevent coasting of product in
accumulation zone.
BED–Roller bed with 2 1/2 in. dia. x 11 ga. unplated tread rollers spaced every 3 in. and 1.9 in. dia.
x 16 ga. unplated pressure rollers spaced every 6 in. Mounted in 7 1/2 in. x 10 ga. powder painted EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone (Retro-reflective). NEMA 1, 2, IP 62. UL
formed steel channel frame. Bolted together with butt coupling. Approved.
END DRIVE–Located on infeed end of conveyor. IOP—Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
input/output boards. Requires 120VAC or 230VAC single phase input.
DRIVE PULLEY–8 in. dia. with 1 7/16 in. dia. shaft at bearings, machine crowned and fully
lagged. AIR REQUIREMENTS–Recommended working pressure 40 P.S.I. Free air consumption at 40
P.S.I.– .028 cu. ft. per sensor actuation.
TAIL PULLEY–4 in. dia. with 1 in. dia. shaft, machine crowned.
FILTER, REGULATOR–Supplied for main air supply line. (3/8 in. NPT port).
SNUB IDLER–Adjustable 2 5/8 in. dia. at drive pulley, 2 1/8 in. dia. at tail pulley. Pre-lubricated
ball bearings. SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed Helical–Bevel C-Face gear reducer. No.60 roller chain to drive
pulley.
RETURN IDLER–2 1/8 in. dia. at drive end, all others 1.9 dia. unplated. Pre-lubricated ball
bearings. MOTOR–1 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 PH. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning ball bearings on drive and tail pulley. Sealed, CAPACITY–Maximum load per linear foot of conveyor 1000 lbs. Maximum unit load 4000 lbs.
pre-lubricated ball bearings in tread and Total load NOT TO EXCEED capacity in charts.
pressure rollers.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–3 in. roller centers, 30 in. to 72 in. on 3 in. increments. 4 in. roller
centers, 32 in. to 72 in. on 4 in. increments. 6 in. roller centers, 30 in. to 72 in. on 6 in. increments.
Minimum length of infeed zone (drive) is 60 in. Frame length changes with zone length.
LOAD CAPACITY CHART (Accumulated) @ 30 FPM
OVERALL FRAME
OVERALL FRAME WIDTH OVERALL FRAME WIDTH
WIDTH
50" TO 64" 76" TO 88"
42" TO 48"
EZLOGIC® ACCUMULATION SYSTEM HP
TOTAL LOAD (LBS.) TOTAL LOAD (LBS.) TOTAL LOAD (LBS.)
Hytrol’s EZLogic®, or “Electronic Zero-pressure Logic” Accumulation System, combines the sensing
accuracy of photo-electronics with discrete electronic logic control without the use of a PLC or UP TO
UP TO 25' UP TO 25' UP TO 50' UP TO 25' UP TO 50'
pneumatic logic components. The EZLogic® Accumulation System provides many features including: 50'
1 16500 12900 15400 10800 13700 7500
Zero-Pressure Accumulation of Product 2 *20000 23000 *20000 20900 *20000 17600
*Limited to 4000# Per Accumulation Zone
Zone Stop function is built in. Any zone may be transformed into a workstation by connecting a dry
contact switching device to the auxiliary port of the EZLogic® Zone Controller. This feature is always
used at the discharge end of the conveyor line, and may be used at any other location where a zone NOTE: Operating 25-LREZ in slug mode is not recommended
stop is required.
NOTE: Product footprint may affect drive capacity.
Selectable Modes of Operation
Singulation Mode – Product separates while traveling down the conveyor and when it is released
from the conveyor - creating a zone-length gap between products.
Enhanced Slug Mode w/ Jam Protection – Product does not separate when traveling down the
conveyor or when it is released from the conveyor. This allows higher product
throughput at any given conveyor speed. Product will not separate on the conveyor
even when accumulation has been activated at the discharge end.
Cascaded Slug Release – Rather than releasing all zones simultaneously, this function introduces a
momentary delay in the release of each zone, from discharge upstream.
Dynamic Zone Allocation – Automatically adjusts the conveyor’s zone length to accommodate
the length of the product being conveyed. Improves conveyor efficiency and system
flexibility.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–LRAS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify TREAD ROLLERS–2 5/8 in. dia. x 7 ga. unplated steel, 11/16 in. hex spring loaded shaft.
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant speeds to 50 FPM. Note: Capacity and accumulation feature ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starter – push-button stations. AC variable
affected with speed change. frequency drive.
UNDERSIDE TAKE-UP–Provides 12 in. of belt take-up. Minimum elevation 12 in. (Required on units EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
40 ft. or longer.) Must be located in 4 ft. long intermediate section.
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit
regular lubrication).
CATALOG | 08312018
NBEZ
The Model NBEZ is a horizontal narrow belt driven live roller
Live Roller Conveyor
(Zero Pressure Accumulating Type)
• EZLogic® Accumulation System
conveyor, designed for applications that require accumulation • Electro-Magnetic Actuation - 24VDC
of products without a build-up of line pressure while providing • Singulation, Slug or Cascaded Slug Operation
conveyor solutions for high-throughput, high density and • Dynamic Zone Allocation
utilizing 24VDC electro-magnet actuation to engage the • Endless Splice Belt Conveyor shown with
pressure carriage to drive the narrow belt. optional floor supports
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
2 13 1/4 2
95 DRIVE LENGTH
OVERALL WIDTH
8 1/2
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 190-NSPEZ
BED–Roller bed with 1.9 in. dia. roller x 16 ga. galvanized tube spaced every 3 in. Mounted in 9 1/2
in. x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame bolted together with splice plates. EZLogic® ZONE CONTROLLER–Located in each zone. (Retro-reflective). NEMA1, 2, IP 62. UL
Approved.
CROSS BRACING–Rods with turnbuckles are fastened to underside of bed to provide proper
alignment of bed rollers and insure tracking. (1) supplied in first 50' of bed section lengths and (1) IOP–Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic® accumulation system - contains slots for 4
per 50' of bed section length thereafter. Supplied in approximate center of lengths. input/output boards. Operates up to 50 zones (25 each side of IOP). Requires 120VAC or 230VAC
single phase input.
DRIVE–Mounted underneath, placed near center of conveyor. Note: On conveyors less than 26 in.
OAW, motor extends beyond frame. Chain guard located on left hand side. AIR REQUIREMENTS–Recommended working pressure 35 P.S.I. Free air consumption at 35
P.S.I.– .002 cu. ft. per sensor actuation.
DRIVE SHAFT–1 in. dia. steel shaft extends full length of conveyor. Chain coupling at bed joints.
Located on left hand side. FILTER, REGULATOR–Supplied for main air supply line. (3/8 in. NPT port).
DRIVE SPOOLS–2 in. dia. Delrin spool held in place on drive shaft with spool spacers. SPEED REDUCTION–Sealed worm gear C-Face speed reducer. No. 50 roller chain to drive shaft.
DRIVE GUARD–Underside of drive shaft with spools and drive o-rings guarded full length of MOTOR–1/2 HP–208/230/460/575V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. Totally Enclosed C-Face.
conveyor. CONVEYING SPEED–Constant 65 FPM.
DRIVE O-RING–3/16 in. dia. polyurethane o-ring from drive spool to tread rollers. CAPACITY–Maximum load 15 lbs. per drive roller.
BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings with eccentric lock collar on drive FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
shaft. Pre-lubricated ball bearings in tread rollers.
ACCUMULATION ZONES–12, 18, 24, 30 and 36 in. long air controlled. Section lengths change
with zone lengths. (See Note opposite page). Note: 51 or more zones will require an additional
IOP, isolation cable and power supply T cable.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify REVERSING O-RING TRANSFER–See Accessory section.
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. PRESSURE SWITCH–Installed in air line after regulator unit. Kills conveyor drive when air pressure
drops below minimum working requirements. Requires restart controller (not supplied).
CONVEYING SPEED–Other constant and variable speeds from 30 to 120 FPM. Note: H.P. and
conveyor length affected by speed change. GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail. Note: If product comes in contact with
guard rails, product flow will be affected. Fixed channel overlapping-one direction.
SIDE MOUNTED DRIVE–with Hytrol Reducer.
POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces required.
SIDE MOUNTED DRIVE–with Gearmotor.
CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated steel rods fully threaded. Other lengths and
O-RING DRIVE CHAIN–With sealed in lubricant (Recommended for applications that do not permit galvanized rods available.
regular lubrication).
MOTORS–Energy efficient, single phase, other characteristics. 2 HP maximum.
LOW ELEVATION DRIVE–Gearmotor mounted inside of conveyor. Minimum elevation 11 1/4 in.
(Retro) or 13 1/4 in. (Diffuse). ELECTRICAL MOTOR CONTROLS–Non-reversing magnetic starters and push-button stations. AC
variable frequency drive.
ONE DIRECTION O-RING TRANSFER–See Accessory section.
EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 07262019
190-NSPEZC
The 190-NSPEZC Curves are designed to be slave driven • EZLogic® Accumulation System
Live Roller Conveyor
(Zero Pressure Accumulating Type)
from the 190-NSPEZ Conveyor. Curves are used where • Singulation, Slug or Cascaded Slug Operation
turns in the conveyor line are necessary. • Dynamic Zone Allocation
• Positive Brake on All Rollers
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
18"
6-1/4"
18"
DRIVE
"U" JOINT "U" JOINT SHAFT
"U" JOINT
30˚ 45˚
60˚
18" DRIVE 18" DRIVE
SHAFT SHAFT 6-1/4"
2"
DRIVE 6-1/2" REFLECTOR
SHAFT
"U" JOINT
PNEUMATIC
90˚ 9-1/2" BRAKE
DRIVE O-RING
6-1/4"
DRIVE SPOOL
SHAFT COUPLING "R" DRIVE SHAFT
GUARD
"X" "X"
SECTION “X-X”
CATALOG | 08312018
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS 190-NSPEZC
BED–Roller bed with 2 1/2 in. dia. tapered to 1 11/16 in. dia. x 14 ga. galvanized and 1.9 in. dia. roller x
16 ga. galvanized tube. Mounted in 9 1/2 in. x 12 ga. powder painted formed steel channel frame. BEARINGS–Sealed, pre-lubricated, self-aligning, ball bearings with eccentric lock collar on drive
shaft. Pre-lubricated ball bearings in tread rollers.
SLAVE DRIVEN–Curves and spurs are slave driven from drive shaft of Model 190-NSPEZ conveyor.
Shafts are coupled by chain coupling at bed joints. ACCUMULATION ZONES–24 in. long air controlled. 2 per curve.
DRIVE SHAFT–1 in. dia. steel shaft extends full length of conveyor, coupled with universal joints SPLICE ANGLE–Standard for connecting to 190-NSPEZ or 190-NSP.
(U joints) at necessary intervals.
CAPACITY–Maximum load see capacity chart below.
DRIVE SPOOLS–2 in. dia. Delrin spool held in place on drive shaft with spool spacers.
FLOOR SUPPORTS–Now supplied as optional equipment.
DRIVE GUARD–Underside of drive shaft with spools and drive o-rings guarded full length of
conveyor.
DRIVE O-RING–3/16 in. dia. polyurethane o-ring from drive spool to tread roller.
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
EZLogic ®
Module
OW
FL
OW
FL
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
FLOOR SUPPORTS–MS Type floor supports are available with a wide range of adjustment. Specify POLY-TIER SUPPORTS–36 in. to 120 in. support heights in 6 in. increments. Knee braces supplied.
top of belt or roller elevation. One support required at every bed joint and ends of conveyor. Holes in
feet for lagging to floor. Knee braces recommended above MS-6 support. CEILING HANGERS–5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. long unplated rods fully threaded. Other lengths and galvanized
rods available.
GUARD RAILS–Adjustable Universal Channel Guard Rail, fixed channel or type A or B angle. Note: If
product comes in contact with guard rails, product flow will be affected. EZLogic® – See EZLogic® Components Page.
CATALOG | 08312018
®
EZLOGIC COMPONENTS
Hytrol has once again created the most advanced zero-pressure accumulation system in the world.
While featuring the same EZLogic® familiarity, GEN3 incorporates new technologies for ease of
installation, operation, and maintenance.
The components listed are used on the following conveyors: 138-NSPEZ, 190-NSPEZ, 190-NSPEZC,
ABEZ, 190-PREZ, 190-PREZC, 25-LREZ, 199-CREZD, 25-CREZD, 36-CREZD, CCEZ, DCEZ-60,
DCEZ-63, DCEZ-82, DCEZ-83, and PLEZD.
TRANSDUCERS (SENSORS)
Remote Diffuse Transducer (Narrow Beam)
Has narrow beam for use with close roller centers. Attaches to any remote zone controller and allows transducer to be mounted separate
from controller.
032.513
CORDSETS
Zone Controller Cordset (Zone to Zone Communication)
Available for the following zone lengths:
12” .....................................................................032.551
18” .....................................................................032.552
24” .....................................................................032.553
30” .....................................................................032.554
36” .....................................................................032.555
48” .....................................................................032.556
60” .....................................................................032.557
72” .....................................................................032.558
Zone Controller Screw-On Cordset (NEMA 4X Zone to Zone Communication for Wash Down Application)
Available for the following zone lengths:
12” .....................................................................032.5515
18” .....................................................................032.5525
24” .....................................................................032.5535
30” .....................................................................032.5545
36” .....................................................................032.5555
48” .....................................................................032.5565
60” .....................................................................032.5575
72” .....................................................................032.5585
CATALOG | 08312018
NOTE: All GEN3 EZLogic® Components are List Price. EZLOGIC® COMPONENTS
CORDSETS (continued)
Infeed Zone Terminator
Terminates zone to zone communication at infeed zone.
032.550
Mounting Base
Use to mount any Zone Controller.
032.517
IOP
IOP
Provides 27VDC, 100 watt power for EZLogic“ accumulation system. Requires 120 VAC or 230 VAC single phase input.
Operates up to 50 zones (25 zones each side of IOP).– contains slots for 4 input/output boards. Requires enhanced
zone controllers to communicate with input/output boards.
032.582
I/O Board
Plugs into slot in IOP to provide two input/output connections. Requires enhanced controller to receive signal.
032.583
CONFIGURATION/DIAGNOSTIC COMPONENTS
Push Button Programmer
Plugs into auxiliary port of any controller to configure certain features of controller. Required for customization of
factory default settings.
032.535
CATALOG | 08312018
190-NSPEZC
The 190-NSPEZC Curves are designed to be slave driven • EZLogic® Accumulation System
Live Roller Conveyor
(Zero Pressure Accumulating Type)
from the 190-NSPEZ Conveyor. Curves are used where • Singulation, Slug or Cascaded Slug Operation
turns in the conveyor line are necessary. • Dynamic Zone Allocation
• Positive Brake on All Rollers
• Adjustable MS-Type Floor Supports Available
18"
6-1/4"
18"
DRIVE
"U" JOINT "U" JOINT SHAFT
"U" JOINT
30˚ 45˚
60˚
18" DRIVE 18" DRIVE
SHAFT SHAFT 6-1/4"
2"
DRIVE 6-1/2" REFLECTOR
SHAFT
"U" JOINT
PNEUMATIC
90˚ 9-1/2" BRAKE
DRIVE O-RING
6-1/4"
DRIVE SPOOL
SHAFT COUPLING "R" DRIVE SHAFT
GUARD
"X" "X"
SECTION “X-X”
CATALOG | 08312018
NOTE: All GEN3 EZLogic® Components are List Price. EZLOGIC® COMPONENTS
CABLE COMPONENTS (continued)
Nano Extension Cable
Used to extend auxiliary devices or remote transducer cable. Available in the following lengths:
1 ft ..........................................................032.565
2 ft. .........................................................032.566
3 ft. .........................................................032.567
6 ft. .........................................................032.568
Power Splitter
Used to connect two conveyors located side by side to one IOP. Requires 2 power supply T cables. Maximum total of 50
zones.
032.569
CATALOG | 08312018
POLY-TIER SUPPORT
Poly-tier supports provide sturdy support for multi-level conveyor lines. • Used In Place of LS or MS Supports Only
Heights available from 36 in. to 120 in. in 6 in. increments. 1 1/2 in. I.D. • Conveyor Widths 10 in. to 42 in. Wide
(1.9 in O.D.) crosspipe assembly mounted to 1 3/4 in. x 4 in. x 7 ga. steel • 36 in. to 120 in. Support Height
support legs. Capacity: 1500 lbs. per crosspipe–4500 lbs. per set of legs. • Sturdy Support for Multi-level Lines
Supplied for overall conveyor widths from 10 in. to 42 in. wide. Knee
• Available for Most Horizontal Power and Gravity Conveyors
braces are supplied to provide extra stability to support.
• Contact Factory for Specific Application and Available Sizes
SUPPORT LEG
KNEE BRACE
2-1/2"
CLEARANCE
36" TO 120"
ON 6"
INCREMENTS
CONVEYOR
U-BRACKET
SECTION
LOCK-BOLT
CROSSPIPE ASSEMBLY
KNEE BRACE
SUPPORT LEG
CEILING HANGERS
Ceiling Hangers provide safe and sturdy means of gaining high conveyor • 5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. Long Unplated Fully Threaded Rod
elevations. Used when maximum utilization of floor space is needed or • Sturdy Crosspipe Mounts to Underside of Bed Section
when required height exceeds floor support capability. 5/8 in. fully threaded • Contact Factory for Available Sizes
steel rod connects to 1 1/2 in. I.D. (1/9 in. O.D.) support which bolts to
underside of conveyor with “U” brackets. Ceiling Hangers can be supplied
with gravity or powered conveyors. It is recommended that guard rails be
used on conveyors that are ceiling hung.
1) Select support type. Refer to standard specifications on appropriate catalog page per model. MIN
RS, LS & MS supports rated for 1500 lbs. maximum. HS rated for 4000 lbs. maximum. MAX
Example: Model TA uses MS type supports per the specifications on page 5 of this catalog. On the TA model support chart below the dimension is 4 1/8”. The chart to the right shows MS-6 support minimum and
maximum elevations to be 23 5/8” to 35 5/8”. When the 4 1/8” dimension is added to the minimum and maximum elevations, total elevations on a Model TA with MS-6 supports is 27 3/4” to 39 3/4”.
MODELS Top of Belt or Roller Support MIN MAX Support MIN MAX
19GSR, GSRC, GSRS Ball Transfer 3 3/4 MSL-1 2 3 MS-05 19 5/8 25 5/8
TR 4 1/4 MSL-2 3 4 3/4 MS-06 23 5/8 35 5/8
TA 4 1/8 MSL-3 4 3/4 7 3/8 MS-07 33 5/8 45 5/8
TL, 190-LR, 190-ACC, LRC, LRS, LRSS, 190-ACZ, MS-01 7 8 3/4 MS-08 45 5/8 57 5/8
6 3/4
ABEZ-Intermediate, C, PC, R-Gear Red, Drive MS-01.2 8 9 3/4 MS-09 57 5/8 69 5/8
199-CRR, CRRC 3 3/4 MS-01.4 9 10 3/4 MS-10 69 5/8 81 5/8
TH 5 13/16 MS-02 10 13 MS-11 79 5/8 91 5/8
SB, RB 6 7/8 MS-03 12 5/8 15 5/8 MS-12 91 5/8 103 5/8
RB-8" End Drive 10 3/8 MS-04 15 5/8 21 5/8
SBI, RBI 7 1/16
190-NSP, NSPC, NSPS, NSPSS, 190-NSPEZ, NSPEZC 9 3/4 MODELS Top of Belt
SC-Intermediate 6 13/16 TA-8" END DRIVE; TL-8" END DRIVE, CRB 6 1/4
SC-Diverter, Center Leg 16 1/16
PSB, PSBC 7 3/4 Support MIN MAX Support MIN MAX
TW 7 3/8 MSD-0-10 3 3/4 3 3/4 MSD-03 15 13/16 18 13/16
CCEZ, CCAC 10 1/8 MSD-0-11 4 3/4 4 3/4 MSD-04 18 13/16 24 13/16
Prosort Induction 6 7/8 MSD-0-12 5 3/4 5 3/4 MSD-05 22 13/16 28 13/16
GAPPER, GAPPER L - INT|/TAIL 6 7/8 MSD-0-13 6 3/4 6 3/4 MSD-06 26 13/16 38 13/16
GAPPER, GAPPER L - DRIVE MODULE 19 3/8 MSD-0-14 7 3/4 7 3/4 MSD-07 36 13/16 48 13/16
190 PREZ 4 3/4 MSD-0-15 8 3/4 8 3/4 MSD-08 48 13/16 60 13/16
190 PREZC 4 3/4 MSD-0-16 9 3/4 9 3/4 MSD-09 60 13/16 72 13/16
ART 8 MSD-01 10 5/16 12 1/16 MSD-10 72 13/16 84 13/16
199-CREZD 3 3/4 MSD-01.2 11 5/16 13 1/16 MSD-11 82 13/16 94 13/16
CRB 4 1/8 MSD-01.4 12 5/16 14 1/16 MSD-12 94 13/16 106 13/16
MSD-02 13 5/16 16 5/16
CATALOG | 08312018
FLOOR SUPPORTS AND CASTERS
MODELS Top of Belt Support MIN MAX Support MIN MAX
190 NSP, NSPEZ 9 3/4 MSN-01 7 8 3/4 MSN-06 23 15/16 35 15/16
MSN-01.2 8 9 3/4 MSN-07 33 15/16 45 15/16
MSN-01.4 9 10 3/4 MSN-08 45 15/16 57 15/16
MSN-02 10 13 MSN-09 57 15/16 69 15/16
MSN-03 12 15/16 15 15/16 MSN-10 69 15/16 81 15/16
MSN-04 15 15/16 21 15/16 MSN-11 79 15/16 91 15/16
MSN-05 19 15/16 25 15/16 MSN-12 91 15/16 103 15/16
MODELS Top of Roller Support MIN MAX Support MIN MAX
25 / 26 SR, SRC - SET LOW 3 1/4 HSL-01 1/2 HS-05 16 5/8 19 5/8
25 / 26 SR, SRC, SRS - SET HIGH 4 3/8 HSL-02 1/2 HS-06 19 5/8 25 5/8
35 SR - SET LOW 4 1/4 HSL-03 1/2 HS-07 25 5/8 31 5/8
35 SR - SET HIGH 4 3/8 HSL-04 1/2 2 1/4 HS-08 31 5/8 43 5/8
25 / 26 CRR, CRRC, CRRCT 4 3/8 HSL-05 2 1/4 6 1/8 HS-09 43 5/8 55 5/8
PLEZD 8 HS-01 6 1/8 7 5/8 HS-10 55 5/8 67 5/8
HS-02 7 5/8 10 5/8 HS-11 67 5/8 79 5/8
HS-03 10 5/8 13 5/8 HS-12 79 5/8 91 5/8
HS-04 13 5/8 16 5/8
MODELS Top of Roller Support MIN MAX Support MIN MAX
25-CREZD 4 3/8 HSN-01 6 1/8 7 5/8 HSN-07 25 5/8 31 5/8
25 / 26 CRR, CRRC, CRRCT 4 3/8 HSN-02 7 5/8 10 5/8 HSN-08 31 5/8 43 5/8
HSN-03 10 5/8 13 5/8 HSN-09 43 5/8 55 5/8
HSN-04 13 5/8 16 5/8 HSN-10 55 5/8 67 5/8
HSN-05 16 5/8 19 5/8 HSN-11 67 5/8 79 5/8
HSN-06 19 5/8 25 5/8 HSN-12 79 5/8 91 5/8
MODELS Top of Belt Support MIN MAX Support MIN MAX
WC-DRIVE 8 1/8 RS-01 6 7/16 8 3/16 RS-06 22 15/16 34 15/16
WC-TAIL 5 3/8 RS-01.2 7 7/16 9 3/16 RS-07 32 15/16 44 15/16
19 GATES (GAS SPRING) 12 3/4 RS-01.4 8 7/16 10 3/16 RS-08 44 15/16 56 15/16
138 / SW GATES (SPRING BALANCED) 3 3/4 RS-02 9 7/16 12 7/16 RS-09 56 15/16 68 15/16
19 GATES (SPRING BALANCED) 4 3/4 RS-03 11 15/16 14 5/16 RS-10 68 15/16 80 15/16
RS-04 14 15/16 20 15/16 RS-11 78 15/16 90 15/16
RS-05 18 15/16 24 15/16 RS-12 90 15/16 102 15/16
OVERHEAD DRIVE
MODELS Top of Blet Support MIN MAX Support MIN MAX
PCA 2 9/16 PCAS-01 6 7/16 8 3/16 PCAS-06 22 15/16 34 15/16
PCAS-01.2 7 7/16 9 3/16 PCAS-07 32 15/16 44 15/16
PCAS-01.4 8 7/16 10 3/16 PCAS-08 44 15/16 56 15/16
PCAS-02 9 7/16 12 7/16 PCAS-09 56 15/16 68 15/16
PCAS-03 11 15/16 14 15/16 PCAS-10 68 15/16 80 15/16
PCAS-04 14 15/16 20 15/16 PCAS-11 78 15/16 90 15/16
PCAS-05 18 15/16 24 15/16 PCAS-12 90 15/16 102 15/16
UNDERSIDE DRIVE
Support MIN MAX Support MIN MAX
PCASU-04 14 15/16 20 15/16 PCASU-09 56 15/16 68 15/16
PCASU-05 18 15/16 24 15/16 PCASU-10 68 15/16 80 15/16
PCASU-06 22 15/16 34 15/16 PCASU-11 78 15/16 90 15/16
PCASU-07 32 15/16 44 15/16 PCASU-12 90 15/16 102 15/16
PCASU-08 44 15/16 56 15/16
MODELS Top of Channel Support MIN MAX Support MIN MAX
PCH 8 5/8 PCHS-01 6 1/8 7 5/8 PCHS-07 25 5/8 31 5/8
PCHS-02 7 5/8 10 5/8 PCHS-08 31 5/8 43 5/8
PCHS-03 10 5/8 13 5/8 PCHS-09 43 5/8 55 5/8
PCHS-04 13 5/8 16 5/8 PCHS-10 55 5/8 67 5/8
PCHS-05 16 5/8 19 5/8 PCHS-11 67 5/8 79 5/8
PCHS-06 19 5/8 25 5/8 PCHS-12 79 5/8 91 5/8
MODELS Top of Side Channel Support MIN MAX Support MIN MAX
PCX 7 1/4 PCXSL-01 2 3 PCXS-05 19 5/8 25 5/8
PCXSL-02 3 4 3/4 PCXS-06 23 5/8 35 5/8
PCXSL-03 4 3/4 7 3/8 PCXS-07 33 5/8 45 5/8
PCXS-01 7 8 3/4 PCXS-08 45 5/8 57 5/8
PCXS-01.2 8 9 3/4 PCXS-09 57 5/8 69 5/8
PCXS-01.4 9 10 3/4 PCXS-10 69 5/8 81 5/8
PCXS-02 10 13 PCXS-11 79 5/8 91 5/8
PCXS-03 12 5/8 15 5/8 PCXS-12 91 5/8 103 5/8
PCXS-04 15 5/8 21 5/8
CATALOG | 08312018
NOTE: All GEN3 EZLogic® Components are List Price. EZLOGIC® COMPONENTS
CABLE COMPONENTS (continued)
Nano Extension Cable
Used to extend auxiliary devices or remote transducer cable. Available in the following lengths:
1 ft ..........................................................032.565
2 ft. .........................................................032.566
3 ft. .........................................................032.567
6 ft. .........................................................032.568
Power Splitter
Used to connect two conveyors located side by side to one IOP. Requires 2 power supply T cables. Maximum total of 50
zones.
032.569
CATALOG | 08312018
POLY-TIER SUPPORT
Poly-tier supports provide sturdy support for multi-level conveyor lines. • Used In Place of LS or MS Supports Only
Heights available from 36 in. to 120 in. in 6 in. increments. 1 1/2 in. I.D. • Conveyor Widths 10 in. to 42 in. Wide
(1.9 in O.D.) crosspipe assembly mounted to 1 3/4 in. x 4 in. x 7 ga. steel • 36 in. to 120 in. Support Height
support legs. Capacity: 1500 lbs. per crosspipe–4500 lbs. per set of legs. • Sturdy Support for Multi-level Lines
Supplied for overall conveyor widths from 10 in. to 42 in. wide. Knee
• Available for Most Horizontal Power and Gravity Conveyors
braces are supplied to provide extra stability to support.
• Contact Factory for Specific Application and Available Sizes
SUPPORT LEG
KNEE BRACE
2-1/2"
CLEARANCE
36" TO 120"
ON 6"
INCREMENTS
CONVEYOR
U-BRACKET
SECTION
LOCK-BOLT
CROSSPIPE ASSEMBLY
KNEE BRACE
SUPPORT LEG
CEILING HANGERS
Ceiling Hangers provide safe and sturdy means of gaining high conveyor • 5/8 in. dia. x 8 ft. Long Unplated Fully Threaded Rod
elevations. Used when maximum utilization of floor space is needed or • Sturdy Crosspipe Mounts to Underside of Bed Section
when required height exceeds floor support capability. 5/8 in. fully threaded • Contact Factory for Available Sizes
steel rod connects to 1 1/2 in. I.D. (1/9 in. O.D.) support which bolts to
underside of conveyor with “U” brackets. Ceiling Hangers can be supplied
with gravity or powered conveyors. It is recommended that guard rails be
used on conveyors that are ceiling hung.
TRIPOD STAND
Height
Weight
Model No. Width (Top of Roller/Wheel)
(Lbs.)
Min. Max.
TS-12-18 12” 18” 5 1/2
Adjustable Tripod Stands are used with straight or curved sections TS-12-30 18” 30” 8 1/2
of gravity skatewheel and 1 3/8 in. dia. roller conveyor. Optional leg TS-12-40 24” 40” 10 1/2
angles can be supplied to fasten stand to floor. 12"
TS-12-52 30” 52” 13 1/2
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. TS-12-72 40” 72” 19 1/2
Accessories, crating, etc., are not included. TS-12-110 60” 110” 23 1/2
TS-15-18 12” 18” 6
• 4 widths
TS-15-30 18” 30” 9
• Portable applications TS-15-40 24” 40” 11
15"
• Easily Adjusted TS-15-52 30” 52” 14
TS-15-72 40” 72” 20
CAPACITY DATA:
TS-15-110 60” 110” 24
350 lbs. with 180 in./lbs. of torque on locking screw. (No
Shock Loading). TS-18-18 12” 18” 6 1/2
TS-18-30 18” 30” 9 1/2
TS-18-40 24” 40” 11 1/2
18"
TS-18-52 30” 52” 14 1/2
TS-18-72 40” 72” 20 1/2
TS-18-110 60” 110” 24 1/2
TS-24-18 12” 18” 7
TS-24-30 18” 30” 10
TS-24-40 24” 40” 12
24"
TS-24-52 30” 52” 15
TS-24-72 40” 72” 21
TS-24-110 60” 110” 25
ROLLER STAND
Adjustable Roller Stands are made of heavy gauge pipe with WIDTH HEIGHT Weight
MODEL NO.
a 1.9 galvanized, ball bearing roller mounted on top. They are BR MIN. MAX (Lbs.)
used for feeding work to a punch press, saw, drill press, brake ARS-13-18 12 3/8” 18” 9
press, or anywhere some extra support is required.
ARS-13-30 13” 18 3/8” 30” 12
• 3 widths ARS-13-40 24 3/8” 40” 14
• Portable applications ARS-17-18 12 3/8” 18” 10
• Easily Adjusted ARS-17-30 17” 18 3/8” 30” 13
ARS-17-40 24 3/8” 40” 15
ARS-21-18 12 3/8” 18” 12
ARS-21-30 21” 18 3/8” 30” 15
ARS-21-40 24 3/8” 40” 17
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only.
Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
CATALOG | 08312018
PACKAGE STOPS
DEAD TYPE TERMINATING END STOP
Dead type Package Stops are simply placed on bed sec- Terminating End Stops mount to
tion of gravity wheel and 1 3/8 in. roller conveyor. Styles end of conveyor for stopping boxes, 1-3/4"
A, B, or C can be used to lift or stop cartons or boxes. cartons, etc. Bolts to top flange of
Easily attached to conveyor. conveyor channels. Available in all
• 3 Styles- 4 Widths STYLE C standard conveyor widths. 3-1/2"
SHOWN FRAME
• 12 ga. Steel
Between Overall Frame Package
DEAD STOP
Rail Width Width Stop Width OAW
10" 12" 9"
13" 15" 12"
16" 18" 15"
22" 24" 21"
1-3/4"
STYLE “A” STYLE “B” STYLE “C”
16-1/2" 19" 19"
3-1/2"
FRAME
5/8" 9" 1"
4"
2" 2"
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
CAPACITY–Blade 50 lbs. for 1 3/8 in. roller and 150 lbs. for 1.9 in. roller. 1 3/8 in. dia. roller 50 lbs., 1.7
in. dia. roller 150 lbs. All are live load STOP–7 ga. formed angle 1 in. x 1 1/2 in. for 1 3/8 in. conveyors, 1 1/2 in. x 1 1/2 in. for 1.9 in. & 2.0 in.
capacities at 65 FPM. conveyors. Roller 1 3/8 in. dia. x 18 ga. galvanized steel for 1 3/8 in. conveyors. 1.7 in. dia. x 13 ga.
unplated steel roller for 1.9 in. conveyors.
BEARINGS–Cam roller bearings to absorb impact.
STROKE–1 7/8 in. above rollers.
OPERATION–Hand operated lever to raise or lower stop. Can be used in normally up or down posi-
tions.
CATALOG | 08312018
OAW
PACKAGE STOPS
FOOT OPERATED BLADE/ROLLER
Foot Operated Stops are used where manual line control is required such as assembly work stations,
shipping areas, etc. Can be mounted to underside of SSR & 19SR Conveyors.
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
CAPACITY–Blade 50 lbs. for 1 3/8 in. roller and 150 lbs. for 1.9 in. roller. 1 3/8 in. POSITION–Supplied normally down. Can be supplied normally up, specify.
dia. roller 50 lbs., 1.7 in. dia. roller 150 lbs. All are live load capacities at 65 FPM.
STROKE–2 in. above roller.
OPERATION–Foot operated lever to raise or lower stop.
STOP–Blade 1/4 in. steel plate, roller 1 3/8 in. dia. x 18 ga. galvanized steel for 1 3/8
in. conveyors. 1.7 in. dia. x 13 ga. unplated steel roller for 1.9 in. conveyors.
TURNING WHEEL
Turning Wheels are used in converging 30˚ and 45˚ spur applications.
Also used at 90˚ (right angle) transfers where Traffic Cops, Package Stops
and other product flow controlling devices are used. Wheel is mounted
on adjustable bracket to insure proper package orientation through
transfer. Can be mounted to slider bed or side channels of powered and
gravity conveyors–specify model where applicable.
2" 6"
2" "A" "A"
CATALOG | 08312018
GUARD RAILS
SOLID SIDE GUARDS UNIVERSAL ADJUSTABLE CHANNEL
ADJUSTABLE RAIL
• 1 1/2 in. x 1 1/2 in. powder painted steel for 1.9 • 3 1/2 in. x 1 1/2 in. x 12 ga. painted steel channel other side • 3 1/2 in., 6 1/2 in., 10 in., or 13 in. heights x 1 1/2 in. x 14 ga.
conveyors powder painted steel channel for 1.9 in. conveyors
BETWEEN
RAIL SEAL
5/16"
FOR SKATEWHEEL BALL STANDARD
1/4" CENTERS
LENGTHS
1/4" 1-1/2" FOR 138 ROLLER 1" AVAILABLE
IN 12 IN. 1-3/8"
FRAME INCREMENTS
3-1/2" 2-1/2"
BALL CENTERS 3/4"
3-1/2" CHANNEL 2-1/2" CHANNEL "A" "A"
VIEW "A-A"
1-3/4"
CATALOG | 08312018
SWING ARM DIVERTER
The Swing Arm Diverter is a precisely timed flat faced, pivot arm
diverter for use with the Model SB belt conveyor to deflect cartons
across the conveyor belt. Its unique cylinder arrangement allows it
to divert cartons at very high rates across the conveyor belt onto
the divert chute.
13 1/32
13 1/32
10 7/8 REF
10 7/8 REF
LH ASSEMBLY
LH ASSEMBLY
30° REF
30° REF
CHART 2
ITEM 14 ITEM 15 TYPE CODE
DG-001279-D DG-001235-D 24 VOLT DC D CHART 2
DG-001279-A DG-001235-A 120 VOLT AC A
B
REF CHART 1
ITEM 14 Chute Size
TYPEChartCODE
ITEM 15
DG-001279-D DG-001235-D
24 VOLT DC D
OAW BR
18"
B
15" 48 13/32"
OAW 18"
DG-001279-A
24"
DG-001235-A
120 VOLT AC
30"
A
36"
REF CHART 1
B 24"
28"
30"
21"
25"
27"
54 13/32"
54 13/32"
54 13/32"
"A" 42"
OAW BR
48" B
54" 60"
22 5/16 REF
36" 33" 60 13/32"
15" 15"
18"
24" 21"
15"
48 13/32"
54 13/32"
15" 15"
15 REF
18"
28"
30"
36"
27" 18"
25"
33"
54 13/32"
54 13/32"
60 13/32"
18" 18"
OAW
15 REF
22 5/16 REF 21" 21" 21" 21"
BR
24" 24" 24" 24"
"B"
6 1/2
OAW 27" 27" 27" 27"
BR
30" 30" 30" 30"
33" 33" 33" 33"
7 1/4 7 6 1/2
36" 36" 36" 36"
7 1/4 7
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
PAINT–Powder painted AIR VALVE–24 volt DC double solenoid air valve.
AIR FILTER, REGULATOR–Supplied with safety soft start valve with manual and 24 volt solenoid
DIVERT ARM–Painted steel channel with 48 in. long x 15 in. wide x 3/16 in. thick aluminum face. lock out, 1/2 inch NPT inlet port.
CAPACITY–1 lb. minimum carton weight, 50 lb. maximum carton weight, 36 in. maximum carton AIR CYLINDER–Two 2 1/2 in. bore x 4 in. stroke.
length, 1 in. minimum carton height
AIR REQUIREMENTS–80 P.S.I. working pressure, free air consumption at 80 psi-0.14 cubic feet per
CYCLE RATE–Up to 60 cycles per minute. cycle. Note: Include safety factor when calculating compressor size. (1 1/4 in. minimum air supply line
recommended).
RIGHT HAND OR LEFT HAND DIVERTS–Please specify. PROX SWITCH - 24 volt DC Home Prox and 24 volt DC Retract Prox.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
AIR VALVE–120 volt AC double solenoid valve.
PROX SWITCH - 120 volt AC.
AIR FILTER, REGULATOR–Supplied with safety soft start valve with manual and 120 volt solenoid
lock out, 1/2 inch NPT inlet port.
CATALOG | 08312018
SWING ARM PLOW ASSEMBLY
The Swing Arm Plow Assembly is a precisely timed plow arm • Right hand or left hand diverts available
diverter designed for use with the Model SB belt conveyor. • Up to 40 cartons per minute
The plow is specifically designed for diverting totes onto • For 30º or 45º diverting
powered spurs. It also features a flat-faced plow option for
carton diverting.
13 1/32
10 7/8 REF
“A”
OAW 30º 45º
18” 50” 38”
24” 56” 44”
LH ASSEMBLY
30” 68” 50”
”
“A
36” 80” 62”
30° REF
OAW
6 1/2
BR
13 13/16 REF
6 1/2
7
7 1/4
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
PAINT–Powder painted
AIR FILTER, REGULATOR–Supplied with safety soft start valve with manual and 24 volt solenoid
CAPACITY–1 lb. minimum carton weight, 50 lb. maximum carton weight, 36 in. maximum carton lockout, 1/2 inch NPT inlet port.
length, 1 in. minimum carton height.
AIR CYLINDER–Two 2 1/2 in. bore x 2 in. or 3 in. stroke.
CYCLE RATE–Up to 40 cycles per minute.
AIR REQUIREMENTS–80 P.S.I. working pressure, free air consumption at 80 psi-0.14 cubic feet per
RIGHT HAND OR LEFT HAND DIVERTS–Please specify cycle. Note: Include safety factor when calculating compressor size. (1 1/4 in. minimum air supply line
recommended).
AIR VALVE–24 volt DC single solenoid air valve. 30º or 45º Diverting - Please specify.
PLOW ARM–Steel construction with dogbone wearstrip face.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
AIR VALVE–120 volt AC single solenoid valve.
CATALOG | 08312018
EXTENDA PUSHER
The Extenda Pusher is a dual-stage 90° pusher designed • Right hand or left hand diverts available
Dual-Stage 90° Pusher
for use on slider and roller bed conveyors where sorting of • Up to 30 cartons per minute
cartons or totes is required. The small dual-stage design • 4 stroke lengths available
requires less space for mounting compared to existing 90°
pushers available today, plus the operating cycle rate is
increased.
24"
26 7/16"
A STROKE LENGTH
8"
Actual Stroke
OAW "A" "B"
B
Length
16"- 18" 16" 21 19/32" 20"
20" - 24" 22" 24 19/32" 23"
26" - 30" 28" 27 19/32" 26"
34" - 36" 34" 30 19/32" 29"
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
PAINT–Powder painted AIR VALVE–120 volt AC double solenoid air valve.
STROKE LENGTH–Available in 16, 22, 28, & 34 in. ranges. Duration of divert pulse to air valve will AIR FILTER, REGULATOR–Supplied with safety shut off valve, 1/2 in. NPT inlet port.
determine exact stroke length within range.
AIR REQUIREMENTS–80 P.S.I. working pressure, free air consumption at 80 psi
PUSHER FACE–8 in. x 24 in. x 3/8 in. Aluminum. 0.63 cubic feet per cycle for 16 in. stroke
0.87 cubic feet per cycle for 22 in. stroke
SUPPORTS–(2) HS Floor Supports. 1.11 cubic feet per cycle for 28 in. stroke
1.34 cubic feet per cycle for 34 in. stroke
CAPACITY–1 lb. minimum carton weight, 75 lb. maximum carton weight, 36 in. maximum carton Note: Include safety factor when calculating compressor size. (1 1/4 in. minimum air supply line
length, 1 in. minimum carton height. recommended).
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
AIR VALVE–24 volt DC double solenoid valve.
CATALOG | 08312018
POWERED TURNTABLE
The Powered Turntable is used when two parallel conveyor lines must be close together with
a 180˚ turn at one (or both) ends. The turning radius is held to a minimum, less than would be
available with gravity or powered curve sections. Turntable Plow and Guard Rails insure product safety while
negotiating 180˚ turn. Unit is reversible and all bearings are sealed. Table top speed at drive wheel is 190 FPM.
"A"
GUARD RAILS TABLE TOP SKATEWHEEL INFEED
AND DISCHARGE
6"
Weight Size "X" Speed at
"A" "B" "C" Radius
INFEED AND DISCHARGE
"X"
(lbs.) Dia. "C"
TRANSITION AND ADJUSTMENT
28" TO 40" NO. 50
SCREW
635 4' 50 1/2" 32 1/2" 21"
ADJUSTMENT CHAIN PLOW
TOP OF TABLE 799 5' 62 1/2" 42 1/2" 27" 190 FPM
TOTALLY ENCLOSED
REDUCER WITH EXPANDED METAL "C" 945 6' 74 1/2" 47 1/2" 33"
MOTOR V-BELT 8" DIA.
DRIVE DRIVE WHEEL
"B"
• Spring-loaded Handle to position and lock table at 3' Long 4' Long
90˚ intervals
Between Rail Width
• 30˚ plow angle • Valve–Single solenoid 4-way valve–1/4 in.–20NPT valve ports. Electrical requirements: 120V.–1
Ph.–60 Hz.–current draw, .09 amps.
• Pneumatic Only
• Air cylinder–2 in. bore double acting 6 in. stroke (10 in. to 18 in. OAW conveyors), 10 in. stroke
(20 in. to 42 in. OAW conveyors)
CATALOG | 08312018
GATES
MANUAL GATE
Manual Gates are available for use with a variety of conveyors. Gates
provide a passageway for personnel, lift trucks, and other equipment.
*NOTE: Maximum width and length determined by roller centers and type of roller. Inquire.
3SW-SBG GRAVITY DIE SPRING GATE ASSEMBLY 3AW-SBG GRAVITY DIE SPRING GATE ASSEMBLY
Between Rail Width Between Rail Width
SIZE TO 10" 13" 16" 22" SIZE TO 10" 13" 16" 22"
ORDER Overall Frame Width ORDER Overall Frame Width
12" 15" 18" 24" 12" 15" 18" 24"
5' 87 92 97 108 5' 67 72 77 88
4' 80 84 88 97 4' 64 68 72 81
• Painted Steel Frame (3SW-SBG) or Aluminum Frame (3AW-SBG) • Hinge Mechanism With Die Springs and Gravity Section
• 16 Wheels Per Foot On 12" OAW • Latch Mechanism
• 16 Wheels Per Foot On 15" OAW • Lift Handles On Both Sides
• 20 Wheels Per Foot On 18" OAW • Less Floor Supports
• 28 Wheels Per Foot On 22" OAW
SSR-SBG GRAVITY DIE SPRING GATE ASSEMBLY SAR-SBG GRAVITY DIE SPRING GATE ASSEMBLY
3” Roller Centers 3” Roller Centers
Between Rail Width Between Rail Width
SIZE TO 10" 13" 16" 22" SIZE TO 10" 13" 16" 22"
ORDER Overall Frame Width ORDER Overall Frame Width
12" 15" 18" 24" 12" 15" 18" 24"
5' 87 92 97 108 5' 67 72 77 88
4' 80 84 88 97 4' 64 68 72 81
SSR-SBG GRAVITY DIE SPRING GATE ASSEMBLY SAR-SBG GRAVITY DIE SPRING GATE ASSEMBLY
1 1/2” Roller Centers 1 1/2” Roller Centers
Between Rail Width Between Rail Width
SIZE TO 10" 13" 16" 22" SIZE TO 10" 13" 16" 22"
ORDER Overall Frame Width ORDER Overall Frame Width
12" 15" 18" 24" 12" 15" 18" 24"
5' 105 112 122 141 5' 79 83 88 98
4' 94 100 108 123 4' 74 77 81 89 RED
PREFER OW
FL
RED
PREFER
FLOW
Photo shown is Spring
Balanced Gate for 1 3/8 in. dia.
roller conveyor.
CATALOG | 08312018
GATES
190-E24G - POWERED GATE WITH DIE SPRINGS
• 1.9” Dia. x 16 Ga. Galvanized O-Ring-Slaved Rollers in a 6 1/2” x 12 Ga. Channel Frame
• (2) 24 Volt DC Motors with Control Cards on 4’ and 5’ Gate or (1) 24 Volt DC Motor with Control Card on 3’ Gate
• Power Supply - 27 VDC 4 AMP (Requires 120 VAC or 230 VAC Single Phase Input Voltage)
• Non-Reversing
• Hinge Mechanism with Die Springs
• 65 FPM Constant Conveying Speed
• Less Floor Supports
SIZE TO Between Rail Width
ORDER 13” 15” 17" 19" 21" 23" 25" 27" 31" 33" 37" 39"
Overall Overall Frame Width
Length "A" 16” 18” 20" 22" 24" 26" 28" 30" 34" 36" 40" 42"
5' 210 220 230 240 250 260 270 280 300 310 330 340
4' 184 194 204 214 224 234 244 254 274 284 304 314
3’ 158 168 178 188 198 208 218 228 248 258 278 288
IMPORTANT NOTES
• WHEN ORDERING: Please specify section to which Gate Hinge Assembly will be attached.
• NOTE: Gate is ONE DIRECTION ONLY. Contact factory for Reversing Application.
• 3 ft. OAL Gates with 2 in. roller centers require TWO motors.
• 4 ft. and 5 ft. OAL Gates with 2 in. roller centers require THREE motors.
• OPTIONAL EQUIPMENT
24 volt 5amp 460 volt Input Power Supply
CATALOG | 08312018
GATES
GRAVITY DIE SPRING BALANCED GATE ASSEMBLY
Spring Balanced Gates can be used with several types of gravity wheel and roller conveyor. Gates
provide a passageway for personnel, lift trucks, and other equipment. Tension springs are easily
adjusted to provide minimum weight lift.
19GSR-SBG GRAVITY DIE SPRING GATE ASSEMBLY
3” Roller Centers
Between Rail Width
SIZE TO 13" 15" 17" 19" 21” 23” 25” 27” 31” 33” 37” 39”
ORDER Overall Frame Width
16" 18" 20" 22" 24” 26” 28” 30” 34” 36” 40” 42”
5' 133 139 145 151 157 163 169 175 187 193 205 211
4' 117 122 127 132 137 142 147 152 162 167 177 182
19GSR-SBG GRAVITY DIE SPRING GATE ASSEMBLY
2” Roller Centers
Between Rail Width
SIZE TO 13" 15" 17" 19" 21” 23” 25” 27” 31” 33” 37” 39”
ORDER Overall Frame Width
16" 18" 20" 22" 24” 26” 28” 30” 34” 36” 40” 42”
5' 161 168 175 182 187 196 203 210 224 231 245 252
4' 144 151 158 165 172 179 186 193 207 214 228 235
• Painted Steel Frame
• 1.9" dia. Galvanized Rollers on 2" or 3" centers
• Hinge Mechanism With Die Springs and Gravity Section
• Latch Mechanism
• Lift Handles On Both Sides
• Less Floor Supports
RED
PREFER
FLOW
CATALOG | 08312018
CHAIN TRANSFER
Chain Transfers are used to move products at right angles to adjacent or parallel
conveyor lines. Air bags lift the transfer mechanism while powered chains transfer
BR, CC, & Extended Types
the product. Two or three strands of chain are available in either between rail
(BR), conveyor to conveyor (CC), or Extended types. Chains run on UHMW poly-
ethylene wearstrips to reduce friction. Can be used with Models 25-CRR, 26-CRR
& 25-CREZD chain driven roller conveyors.
"E" CONVEYOR
"X" "X" CHAIN
"X" "X"
CONVEYOR CONVEYOR
"B" "B" AIR BAGS
TREAD ROLLERS TREAD ROLLERS
C C
L L
"D" "D"
"E"
AIR BAG
VIEW “X-X”
CATALOG | 08312018
EXTENDED CHAIN TRANSFERS
"C"
"C"
"D" "D"
8" 8"
EXTENDED TYPE TWO STRAND TRANSFER EXTENDED TYPE THREE STRAND TRANSFER
Chart #1
Strand Centers
"A" Roller "D"
Model Transfer Chain Size "B" "C" "E" Min./Max. BR's
Centers
Two Strand Three Strand Two Strand Three Strand
5" 2 1/2" 30" 20" 15" 10" 37"-67"
25-CRR 24" 18"
6" 3" 18" 12" 37"-67"
2060 (CT-3000) 36" 12" 12"
24" 18"
25-CREZD 6" 3" 18" 12"
36" 12"
25-CRR 5" NOT AVAILABLE
24" 18"
2080 (CT-4000) – – 43"-67"
25-CRR 6" 3" 36" 12" 14"
– 18" – 12" 47"-67"
NOTE: Contact factory for transfers to be mounted in 4 in. roller centers.
Chart #2
OAW
FREE AIR CONSUMPTION PER CYCLE TRANSFER
H.P. Transfer Chain Size Max. Unit Load (Lbs.) BR CHAIN
"BR" & Extended Type Conveyor to Conveyor 1" MAX. LIFT
ABOVE ROLLERS CONVEYING SURFACE
.22 SCF @ 100 P.S.I.* .44 SCF @ 100 P.S.I.*
3/4 C-2060H 3000
(4-airbag system) (8-airbag system)
"E" CONVEYOR
.22 SCF @ 100 P.S.I.* .44 SCF @ 100 P.S.I.* CHAIN
1 1/2 C-2080H 4000
(4-airbag system) (8-airbag system)
AIR BAG
* Consumption ratings at mean sea level (14.7 P.S.I.). 8"
MIN.
CATALOG | 08312018
SYSTEMS ACCESSORIES
“Y” SWITCH
Y Switch provides simple method of diverting or converging products from one line to another. Normal flow is to left curve looking
from handle end. Transfer mechanism is raised to transfer products to other curve. Unit mounts on three stationary supports.
Furnished with manual or pneumatic controls. Guard rails can be supplied–optional.
• 4 Widths Weight
• Hand or Air Operated "R" Width Degre Model No.
(lbs)
• 45˚ and 90˚ Curves Available 45° SYS-12-45 106
12"
90° SYS-12-90 142 15-1/2" STRAIGHT SECTION
45° SYS-15-45 120
4'-0" 15" ON 45˚ CURVE ONLY
90° SYS-15-90 156
45° SYS-18-45 131
18"
90° SYS-18-90 169 WIDTH
45° SYS-24-45 145
5'-0" 24"
90° SYS-24-90 185
90˚ "R"
All weights in catalog are conveyor weights only. 45˚
Accessories, crating, etc., are not included.
MANUAL SWITCH LEVER
PRODUCT
FLOW
"OAW"
CATALOG | 08312018
SYSTEMS ACCESSORIES
LIGHT DUTY PUSHER
Hytrol’s LD Pusher is a light duty pusher designed to easily mount to the side on many conveyor
models. The LD Pusher provides an economical solution for pushing lightweight products off at a right
angle to product flow. Ideally used for reject or inspection stations. The LD Pusher is not designed for
high cycle applications.
• 7”, 10”, or 15” Stroke (Specify)
• Aluminum Pusher Face
• 15 lb. Maximum Carton Weight
• Mounting Hardware
(Specify Conveyor Model & Overall Width)
• Less Electrical Controls Required To Actuate Pusher
14-3/16" WIDTH
RAM FACE
STROKE LENGTH "A"
4-1/8"
14” TO 18” 45" Specify conveyor model, overall width and STROKE
elevation for proper mounting kit.
"A" LENGTH
COVER
18” TO 24” 51"
4-1/8"
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS *SPACER *MOUNTING
MS ANGLE
CAPACITY–75 lbs. maximum package weight. SUPPORT FILTER, REGULATOR (FR)
FILTER, REGULATOR, LUBRICATOR (FRL)–Filter, dual regulator, lubricator with safety shut-off
CYCLES–Up to 45 times per minute. Cycle rate varies with package weight. valve, 3/8 in. NPT inlet port.
STROKE LENGTH–Available in 14 in. to 18 in., 18 in. to 24 in., or 24 in. to 30 in. ranges. May be AIR CYLINDER–1 1/2 in. bore double acting.
adjusted for any length within each range.
AIR VALVES–Double solenoid and single solenoid 4-way valves.
RAM FACE–12 in., 18 in., or 24 in. wide, with 1 in. thick cushioned pad.
AIR REQUIREMENTS–40 to 80 P.S.I.. Free air consumption at 60 P.S.I. -.190 cu. ft. per cycle for 14 in.
ELECTRICAL REQUIREMENTS–120 VAC power supply, 120 VAC Pulse actuation signal. NOTE: 24 Volt to 18 in. stroke, .247 cu. ft. per cycle for 18 in. to 24 in. stroke, .304 cu. ft. per cycle for 24 in. to 30 in.
DC solenoids and switches available. stroke. NOTE: Include safety factor when calculating compressor size.
OVERHEAD PUSH-OFF
The Overhead Push-Off provides high speed automatic product diversion. Product may be diverted 90˚
onto another conveyor, chute, etc. or changed from one lane to another in parallel lines. Overhead design
conserves space next to conveyor.
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
CAPACITY–150 lbs. maximum package weight. AIR CYLINDER–2 in. bore double acting.
PACKAGE HEIGHT–Min. 4 1/2 in. (20 in. stroke), 6 in. (30 in. stroke)–max. 24 in. AIR VALVE–Double solenoid 4-way valve, 1/4 in.–20 NPT valve ports. Electrical requirements
120V–1 Ph. 60 Hz., current draw is .09 amps.
CYCLES–Up to 20 times per minute.
AIR REQUIREMENTS–Min. pressure 60 P.S.I., max. 125 P.S.I. free air
consumption at 60 P.S.I.–.105 cu. ft. per cycle for 20 in. stroke, .176 cu. ft. for 30 in. stroke.
PUSHER STROKE–20 in. or 30 in.
NOTE: To eliminate contaminants in air supply line, a filter-regulator should be installed prior to
PUSHER FACE–18 in. long 1.9 in. dia. roller. the air valve (not supplied as standard).
30˚
FLOW
R.H. L.H.
SPUR SPUR "ACC" DRIVE BELT
MIN. TO DISCHARGE MIN. TO INFEED
END OF SECTION END OF SECTION
21" 21" FLOW
L.H. R.H.
DIVERTER DIVERTER
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
CAPACITY–75 lbs. maximum package weight.
DRIVE–1/2 HP motor with AC type variable speed controller. Select 230V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. or 115V–1 Ph.
PACKAGE SIZE–Minimum 6 in. wide x 9 in. long, maximum 12 in. wide x 21 in. long. NOTE: Small 60 Hz. power.
packages must not be top heavy.
AIR CYLINDER–1 1/4 in. dia. bore x 1 in. stroke, double acting with internal rubber bumpers both
DIVERTER SPEED–AC Drive 42-420 FPM. ends.
DIVERTER MECHANISM–Two rows of 3 1/8 in. dia. wheels with AIR VALVE–Single solenoid 4-way valve with speed controls,1/4 in. NPT valve ports. Requires
urethane treads driven by 3/8 in. dia. urethane belts. maintained electrical signal of 115V–1 Ph. 60 Hz. from photo cell, limit switch, etc. (not supplied).
Diverter will stay in diverted position until signal is broken. Current consumption is .09 amps holding.
MOUNTING–Complete unit bolts to 138-ACC 13 in. to 22 in. BR only or 190-ACC 13 in. to 21 in. BR,
RH or LH diversion 30˚ spur discharge (spur not included). Minimum elevation 15 in. (138-ACC) or 16 AIR REQUIREMENTS–Minimum pressure 60 P.S.I., maximum 125 P.S.I., free air consumption at 60
in. (190-ACC). NOTE: ACC belt must be opposite discharge side. Widths over 22 in. BR contact Factory. P.S.I., .014 cu. ft. per cycle.
NOTE: To eliminate contaminants in air supply line, a filter-regulator should be installed prior to the
CYCLES–Up to 40 times per minute. air valve (not supplied as standard).
30˚
FLOW
L.H. R.H.
DIVERTER DIVERTER
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
CAPACITY–75 lbs. maximum package weight. CYCLES–Up to 40 times per minute.
PACKAGE SIZE–Minimum 6 in. wide x 9 in. long maximum 34 in. wide x 46 in. long. NOTE: Small DRIVE–1/2 HP motor with AC type variable speed controller. Select 230V–3 Ph. 60 Hz. or 115V–1 Ph.
packages must not be top heavy. 60 Hz. power.
DIVERTER SPEED–AC Drive 42-420 FPM. AIR CYLINDER–1 1/4 in. dia. bore x 1 in. stroke, double acting with internal rubber bumpers both
ends.
DIVERTER MECHANISM–Four rows of 3 1/8 in. dia. wheels with
urethane treads driven by 3/8 in. dia. urethane belts. AIR VALVE–Single solenoid 4-way valve with speed controls. 1/4 in. NPT valve ports. Requires
maintained electrical signal of 115 V–1 Ph. 60 Hz. from photo cell, limit switch, etc. (not supplied).
MOUNTING–Complete unit bolts to 138-ACC 13 in. to 22 in. BR only or 190-ACC 13 in. to 39 in. BR, Diverter will stay in diverted position until signal is broken. Current consumption is .09 amps holding.
RH or LH Diversion 30˚ spur discharge (spur not included). Minimum elevation 15 in. (138-ACC) or
16 in. (190-ACC). NOTE: ACC belt must be opposite discharge side. Widths over 22 in. BR, contact AIR REQUIREMENTS–Minimum pressure 60 P.S.I., maximum 125 P.S.I. Free air consumption at
Factory. 60 P.S.I., .028 cu. ft. per cycle. NOTE: To eliminate contaminants in air supply line, a filter-regulator
should be installed prior to the air valve (not supplied as standard).
CATALOG | 08312018
SYSTEMS ACCESSORIES
E24 SINGLE POWERED PIVOT DIVERTER
The Powered Pivot Diverter is designed for use with Models 190- E24 & 190-E24EZ
Conveyor. Products are automatically diverted onto adjacent 30˚ spur lines.
LH Diverter
THIS DRAWING CONTAINS CONFIDENTIAL
DESIGNS AND INFORMATION WHICH ARE
THE PROPERTY OF HYTROL CONVEYOR
C
HYTROL
RH Diverter THE PROPERTY OF
DWG NO
THIS DRAWING CONTAINS CONFIDENTIAL C
DESIGNS AND INFORMATION WHICH ARE
Catalog-Int
HYTROL CONVEYOR
COMPANY INC. THIS DRAWING AND THE
HYTROL
DWG NO
Catalog-Int
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
HYTROL
COMPANY INC. THIS DRAWING AND THE HYTROL INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN MAY CONVEYOR CO., INC.
INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN MAY CONVEYOR CO., INC.
NOT BE DISCLOSED OR DUPLICATED IN JONESBORO, ARKANSAS MODELS
NOT BE DISCLOSED OR DUPLICATED IN JONESBORO, ARKANSAS MODELS ECN
ECN
WHOLE OR PART, UTILIZED IN ANY OTHER
WHOLE OR PART, UTILIZED IN ANY OTHER DESIGNED BY kchurchill DATE 8/18/2011
STANDARD TOLERANCES DESIGNED BY kchurchill WORK, OR USED FOR
DATEMANUFACTURE
8/18/2011 STANDARD TOLERANCES
OF UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED
WORK, OR USED FOR MANUFACTURE OF DRAWN BY kchurchill DATE 8/19/2011
kchurchill DESIGNS WITHOUT THE8/19/2011
PRIOR WRITTEN
UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED FRACTIONS ±1/64
DESIGNS WITHOUT THE PRIOR WRITTEN FRACTIONS ±1/64 DRAWN BY DATE DECIMALS ±.005
DECIMALS ±.005
PERMISSION OF HYTROL CONVEYOR ANGLES ±1°
CHECKED BY DATE
PERMISSION OF HYTROL CONVEYOR ANGLES ±1°
CHECKED BY DATE INC.
COMPANY
COMPANY INC. SPARE PART PAINT CLASS MFG CLASS REVISION
SPARE PART PAINT CLASS MFG CLASS REVISION
DIVERTER MECHANISM–One row of 3 1/8 in. dia. wheels with urethane treads driven by 3/8 in. dia. AIR VALVE–Single solenoid 4-way valve with speed controls,1/8 in. NPT valve ports. Requires
NOT BE DISCLOSED OR DUPLICATED IN
WHOLE OR PART, UTILIZED IN ANY OTHER main-
kchurchill
JONESBORO, ARKANSAS MODELS ECN
tained electrical signal of 24VDC watt from photo cell, limit switch, etc. (not supplied). Diverter will
DESIGNED BY DATE 8/18/2
urethane belts.
STANDARD TOLERANCES
WORK, OR USED FOR MANUFACTURE OF UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED
DESIGNS WITHOUT THE PRIOR WRITTEN kchurchill FRACTIONS ±1/64 DRAWN BY DATE 8/19/2
stay in diverted position until signal is broken. Current consumption is .32 amps holding.
DECIMALS ±.005
PERMISSION OF HYTROL CONVEYOR ANGLES ±1°
CHECKED BY DATE
COMPANY INC.
SPARE PART PAINT CLASS MFG CLASS REVISION
MOUNTING–Complete unit bolts to 190-E24 15 in. to 21 in. BR, RH or LH diversion 30˚ spur dis-
charge (spur not included). Minimum elevation 14 in. NOTE: O-rings must be opposite discharge AIR REQUIREMENTS–Minimum pressure 60 P.S.I., maximum 125 P.S.I., free air consumption at 60
side. Widths over 39 in. BR contact factory. P.S.I., .032 cu. ft. per cycle.
NOTE: To eliminate contaminants in air supply line, a filter-regulator should be installed prior to the
CYCLES–Up to 40 times per minute. air valve (not supplied as standard).
Catalog
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
HYTROL
INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN MAY CONVEYOR CO., INC. COMPANY INC. THIS DRAWING AND THE HYTROL
NOT BE DISCLOSED OR DUPLICATED IN JONESBORO, ARKANSAS MODELS INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN MAY CONVEYOR CO., INC.
ECN
NOT BE DISCLOSED OR DUPLICATED IN JONESBORO, ARKANSAS MODELS
WHOLE OR PART, UTILIZED IN ANY OTHER ECN
DESIGNED BY kchurchill WHOLE OR PART,DATE 8/18/2011IN ANY OTHER
UTILIZED
WORK, OR USED FOR MANUFACTURE OF STANDARD TOLERANCES
UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED STANDARD TOLERANCES DESIGNED BY kchurchill DATE 8/18/2011
DESIGNS WITHOUT THE PRIOR WRITTEN FRACTIONS ±1/64 DRAWN BY kchurchill WORK, OR USED FOR
DATE MANUFACTURE OF
8/18/2011 UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED
DECIMALS ±.005
DESIGNS WITHOUT THE PRIOR WRITTEN FRACTIONS ±1/64 DRAWN BY kchurchill DATE 8/18/2011
PERMISSION OF HYTROL CONVEYOR ANGLES ±1°
CHECKED BY DATE DECIMALS ±.005
CAPACITY–75 lbs. maximum package weight. MOTOR–24 VDC motor, 3 amps per motor, one each Divert Bank.
PACKAGE SIZE–Minimum 4 in. wide x 6 in. long, maximum 26 in. wide x 36 in. long. MOTOR CONTROLLER– Controls and Protects Motor, one each Divert Bank.
NOTE: Small packages must not be top heavy. THIS DRAWING CONTAINS CONFIDENTIAL C DWG NO
NOTE: Product must be justified to divert side. DESIGNS AND INFORMATION WHICH ARE
AIR CYLINDER–1 1/4 in. dia. bore x 2 in. stroke, double acting with internal rubber bumpers both
THE PROPERTY OF HYTROL CONVEYOR
COMPANY INC. THIS DRAWING AND THE
HYTROL
HYTROL
Catalog60inch-Int
STANDARD TOLERANCES
MODELS
DESIGNED BY kchurchill
ECN
DATE 8/18/2011
WORK, OR USED FOR MANUFACTURE OF
AIR VALVE–Single solenoid 4-way valve with speed controls,1/8 in. NPT valve ports. Requires main-
DIVERTER MECHANISM–Two rows of 3 1/8 in. dia. wheels with tained electrical signal of 24VDC watt from photo cell, limit switch, etc. (not supplied). Diverter will
stay in diverted position until signal is broken. Current consumption is .32 amps holding.
urethane treads driven by 3/8 in. dia. urethane belts.
AIR REQUIREMENTS–Minimum pressure 60 P.S.I., maximum 125 P.S.I., free air consumption at 60
MOUNTING–Bolts to 190-E24 15 in. to 39 in. BR, RH or LH diversion 30˚ spur discharge (spur not P.S.I., .064 cu. ft. per cycle.
included). Minimum elevation 14 in. NOTE: O-rings must be opposite discharge side. Widths over 39 NOTE: To eliminate contaminants in air supply line, a filter-regulator should be installed prior to the
in. BR contact factory. air valve (not supplied as standard).
CYCLES–Up to 40 times per minute.
CATALOG | 08312018
SYSTEMS ACCESSORIES
E24 ELECTRIC POWERED
PIVOT DIVERTER
e24
TM
The E24 Powered Pivot Diverter is designed for use with Models E24 & E24EZ Accumulating Conveyor.
Products are diverted onto adjacent 30˚ spur lines. The electric linear actuator rotates the diverter
sheave assembly to divert at a 30˚ angle. The vertical lift of the sheave assembly allows the diverter to
have more control of the package which provides a more positive divert.
RH DIVERTER LH DIVERTER
30 30
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
CAPACITY–75 lbs. maximum package weight. CYCLES–Up to 30 cases per minute.
PACKAGE SIZE–Minimum 4 in. wide x 6 in. long, maximum 26 in. wide x 36 in. long. MOTOR–24VDC motor, 3 amps per motor.
NOTE: Small packages must not be top heavy.
CONTROLS INPUT–18-24V at 1.9-4.2mA
DIVERTER SPEED–24VDC, 35-155 FPM.
DRIVE CURRENT REQUIREMENTS–20-28V DC 4 AMP
DIVERTER MECHANISM–Row of 2 3/4 in. dia. wheels with urethane treads driven by 3/16 in. dia.
urethane belts. AVAILABLE WIDTHS –22”, 24”, 26”, 28”, 30” OAW
CATALOG | 08312018
SYSTEMS ACCESSORIES
O-RING TRANSFER (BR TYPE)
O-Ring Transfers are used to move products at right angles to adjacent or parallel conveyor lines.
An air bag lifts the transfer mechanism while powered O-Rings transfer the product. Linear
bearings are used to guide transfer as it is raised and lowered. Can be used with Models 138 and
190-NSP/NSPEZ line shaft conveyors.
36"
190-NSP
18"
OAW BR
CL TRANSFER 16"
18"
13"
15"
20" 17"
22" 19"
24" 21"
TRANSFER
26" 23"
O-RING
28" 25"
30" 27" 138-NSP
34" 31" OAW BR
36" 33" 15" 13"
40" 37" 18" 16"
42" 39" 24" 22"
DRIVE SHAFT
Note: No accumulation in transfer section
4-1/4" 6-3/4" 4-1/4"
1/4 HP per transfer must be included in conveyor
HP requirement.
OAW
1-1/2" 3" 4" 4" 4" 3" 4" 4" 4" 3" 1-1/2" 1/4" TOP BR 1" FOR138-NSP
OF ROLLER 1-1/2" FOR 190-NSP
4-1/4" 6-3/4" 4-1/4"
11-7/32" 9-1/2"
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
CAPACITY–75 lbs. maximum unit load.
ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Not furnished as standard equipment.
TRANSFER O-RING–3/8” dia. polyurethane o-ring.
PNEUMATICS–Air bag (controlled by single solenoid valve) lifts transfer. Requires maintained
TRANSFER SPEED–Not to exceed speed of conveyor. electrical signal of 115V–1 Ph. 60 Hz. from photo cell, proximity switch, etc. (not supplied). Transfer
will stay in raised position until signal is broken. Current consumption is .09 amps holding.
DRIVE–Transfer is driven from line shaft of conveyor.. Maximum of 4 transfers per drive.
AIR REQUIREMENTS–Minimum pressure 60 P.S.I., maximum 100 P.S.I. Free air consumption at
60 P.S.I., .033 cu. ft. per cycle.NOTE: To eliminate contaminants in air supply line, a filter-regulator
MOUNTING–Mounted in 36 in. long section of 138-NSP, 190-NSP, should be installed prior to the air valve (not supplied as standard).
138-NSPEZ, 190-NSPEZ with 3 and 4 in. roller centers.
CATALOG | 08312018
SYSTEMS ACCESSORIES
REVERSING O-RING TRANSFER (BR TYPE)
Reversing O-Ring Transfers are used to move products at right angles to adjacent or parallel conveyor
lines. An air bag lifts the transfer mechanism while powered O-Rings transfer the product. Linear
bearings are used to guide transfer as it is raised and lowered. A gearmotor is utilized to operate the
reversing mechanism to reverse transfer flow. Can be used with Models 138 and 190 NSP/NSPEZ line
shaft conveyors.
Note: No accumulation in transfer section.
190-NSP 138-NSP
16”
OAW BR OAW BR 13”
1/4”
16" 13" 15" 13"
F S ON F S ON F S ON
ELEVATION
24" 21"
LINEAR BEARING
CL TRANSFER
26" 23" 13” - 19” BR
24”
and
28" 25" 138-NSP
48”
30" 27" 24” 1-1/2" 3" 3" 4" 4" 4" 3" 4" 4" 4" 4" 3" 3" 3" 1-1/2"
21” 4-1/4" 6-3/4" 4-1/4"
34" 31" 1/4”
36" 33" F S ON F S ON F S ON
E
F S ON
• STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
CAPACITY–75 lbs. maximum unit load. ELECTRICAL CONTROLS–Not furnished as standard equipment.
TRANSFER O-RING–3/8 in. dia. polyurethane o-ring. PNEUMATICS–Air bag (controlled by single solenoid valve) lifts transfer. Requires maintained
electrical signal of 115V–1 Ph. 60 Hz. from photo cell, proximity switch, etc. (not supplied).
TRANSFER SPEED–Not to exceed speed of conveyor. Transfer will stay in raised position until signal is broken. Current consumption is .09 amps
holding.
DRIVE–Transfer is driven from 230/460/3/60, 1/2 HP shaft-mounted gearmotor.
AIR REQUIREMENTS–Minimum pressure 60 P.S.I., maximum 100 P.S.I. with .038 cu.ft. of free
MOUNTING–Mounted in 48 in. long section of 138-NSP, 190-NSP, air per cycle at 60 P.S.I. NOTE: To eliminate contaminants in air supply line, a filter-regulator
138-NSPEZ, 190-NSPEZ with 3 and 4 in. roller centers. should be installed prior to air valve (not supplied as standard).
Chain Transfers are used to move products at right angles to adjacent or parallel conveyor lines. One
air cylinder lifts the transfer mechanism while powered chains transfer the product. Chains run on 6-1/2
UHMW polyethylene wearstrips to reduce friction. Complete unit mounts in Models ABEZ, 190-ACZ
or 190-LR.
12-1/2
STRAND STRAND STRAND
CODES QTY CENTERS A B C D
A 2 6 06” N/A N/A 18-1/2”
B 2 9 09” N/A N/A 21-1/2”
C 2 12 12” N/A N/A 24-1/2”
D 3 6, 6 12” 6” N/A 24-1/2” A 3 MIN INT
OAW 24” THRU 42”
18 MIN TAIL
E 2 15 15” N/A N/A 27-1/2” B C B 2-3/4 BR 21” THRU 39”
F 2 18 18” N/A N/A 30-1/2”
G 3 9, 9 18” 9” N/A 30-1/2”
6-1/2
H 4 6, 6, 6 18” 6” 6” 30-1/2”
J 2 21 21” N/A N/A 33-1/2”
K 4 6, 9, 6 21” 6” 9” 33-1/2”
L 2 24 24” N/A N/A 36-1/2”
M 3 12, 12 24” 12” N/A 36-1/2”
12-1/2
N 4 6, 12, 6 24” 6” 12” 36-1/2”
P 4 9, 6, 9 24” 9” 6” 36-1/2”
CATALOG | 08312018
SYSTEMS ACCESSORIES 10"
Nominal
"A"
35 ROLLER TRANSFER
1-1/2"
STRAND EFFECTIVE
The 35 Roller Transfer is mounted in a Model DC-60 or DCEZ-60 and is used to transfer product CENTERS OAL
from one DC-60 to another DC-60. The 35 Roller Transfer uses 3 1/2” dia x 9 ga. rollers mounted on
6” centers. Air bags lift the transfer mechanism. The 35 Roller Transfer uses a 1/3 HP gearmotor
to provide constant 30 FPM. GEARMOTOR
1-1/2"
"A" 3-1/2" DIA
10"
ROLLER
Nominal 5-1/2" CONVEYING SURFACE Shown
1-3/4"with Optional 2-Strand Drag Chain.
1-1/2"
OAW See DC-60 or DCEZ-60 for Drag Chain Specifications.
#C-2060-H CHAIN
FROM DRAG CHAIN CONVEYOR CONVEYING
STRAND EFFECTIVE OAW
SURFACE
DIM “A”
CENTERS OAL
41” 33 3/4” 51”
44” 36 3/4” 54”
GEARMOTOR 47” 39 3/4” 57”
1-1/2" MAXIMUM LOAD 3000 LBS. AT 30 FPM 50” 42 3/4” 60”
3-1/2" DIA 53” 45 3/4” 63”
ROLLER STRAND
5-1/2" CONVEYING SURFACE 1-3/4"
EFFECTIVE OAL
CENTERS 56” 48 3/4” 66”
OAW 42” 18” 59” 51 3/4” 69”
NOTE: Extended Type &#C-2060-H
Conveyor toCHAIN
Conveyor Type available, contact factory. 48” 24” 62” 54 3/4” 72”
FROM DRAG CHAIN CONVEYOR 54” 30” 65” 57 3/4” 75”
60” 36” 68” 60 3/4” 78”
66” 42” 71” 63 3/4” 81”
72” 48” 74” 66 3/4” 84”
OAW
BR
CS
POWERED
TRANSITION
ROLLERS 16"MIN.
MAXIMUM LOAD 4000 LBS.
OAW
CATALOG | 08312018
BR
CS
SYSTEMS ACCESSORIES
POWER ROTATED TURNTABLE
The turntable is used to rotate products up to 180°. The turntable is powered by a chain
drive that is located underneath the table top. It has proximity switches mounted on the
base to sense position and control rotation of product. Turntable speed is approximately
3 revolutions per minute. A chain cable carrier keeps wires neat and out of the way. Any
chain roller conveyor such as; 25-CRR, 26-CRR, 36-CRR, can sit on the table top. Due
to sprocket sizes, only the 26-CRR or the 36-CRR is available with powered transition
rollers; the others are only available with gravity transition rollers.
GEARMOTOR
CS
15 11/16 MIN
CONVEYOR 11 1/4 MIN
HEIGHT* DECK HEIGHT
GEARMOTOR/
CHAIN DRIVE
BR
CS
16 MIN
CONVEYOR
HEIGHT* 13 1/4 MIN
DECK HEIGHT
CATALOG | 08312018